Avid Pinnacle Studio Ultimate Collection 14.0 Instructions

Add to my manuals
461 Pages

advertisement

Avid Pinnacle Studio Ultimate Collection 14.0 Instructions | Manualzz

Pinnacle Studio

Version 14

Including Studio, Studio Ultimate and Studio Ultimate Collection

Your Life in Movies

Documentation by Nick Sullivan

Copyright ©1996-2009 Pinnacle Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.

Please respect the Rights of Artists and Creators. Content such as music, photos, video and celebrity images are protected by the laws of many countries. You may not use other people’s content unless you own the rights or have the permission of the owner.

This product or portions thereof are protected under one or more of the following United States patents: 5,495,291; 5,946,445 6,469,711;

6,532,043; 6,678,461; 6,901,211; 6,907,191 7,124,366; 7,165,219;

7,286,131; 7,301,092; and 7,467,244. Other patents are pending.

Mpegable DS 2.2 ©2004 Dicas Digital Image Coding GmbH. Œ Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. This product contains one or more programs protected under international and U.S. copyright laws as unpublished works. They are confidential and proprietary to Dolby

Laboratories. Their reproduction or disclosure, in whole or in part, or the production of derivative works therefrom without the express permission of

Copyright 1993-2005 by Dolby

Œ

MPEG Layer-3 audio coding technology licensed from Fraunhofer IIS and Thomson Multimedia. Œ

Portions of this product were created using LEADTOOLS ©1991-2006,

LEAD Technologies, Inc. All rights reserved. ΠPortions utilize Windows

Media Technologies ©1999-2005 Microsoft Corporation.

Œ

Real Producer

SDK ©1995-2005 Real Networks Inc. Œ This product contains portions of imaging code owned and copyrighted by Pegasus Imaging Corporation,

Tampa, FL. All rights reserved. ΠMPEG Layer II Audio by QDesign

Corp.

Œ

This product contains a YouTube API.

No part of this manual may be copied or distributed, transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system, or translated into any human or computer language, in any form by any means, electronic, mechanical, magnetic, manual, or otherwise, without the express written permission of

Pinnacle Systems, Inc.

Pinnacle Systems, Inc.

280 North Bernardo Avenue

Mountain View, CA 94943

Printed in the USA.

Table of contents

BEFORE YOU START .................................................. XI

Equipment requirements ........................................................................ xii

Abbreviations and conventions ............................................................. xiv

On-line help .......................................................................................... xvi

CHAPTER 1: USING STUDIO ....................................... 1

Undo, Redo, Help, Support and Premium ............................................... 2

Setting options ......................................................................................... 3

Edit mode .................................................................................................... 4

The Player ................................................................................................ 5

Playback controls ..................................................................................... 8

Further editing topics ............................................................................. 11

Expanding Studio .................................................................................. 12

CHAPTER 2: CAPTURING AND IMPORTING MEDIA 17

The Studio Import Wizard ..................................................................... 18

Import Wizard panels .............................................................................. 19

The Import From panel .......................................................................... 20

The Import To panel .............................................................................. 23

The Mode panel ..................................................................................... 27

The Compression Options window ....................................................... 30

The Scene Detection Options window ................................................... 31

The Filename panel ............................................................................... 32

Table of contents iii

Selecting media for import ...................................................................... 34

Import from file-based media ................................................................ 35

Import from DV or HDV camera .......................................................... 42

Import from analog sources ................................................................... 47

Import from DVD or Blu-ray Disc ........................................................ 48

Import from digital cameras .................................................................. 49

Stop motion ........................................................................................... 49

Snapshot ................................................................................................ 52

CHAPTER 3: THE ALBUM .......................................... 57

The Videos section .................................................................................... 63

Opening a video file .............................................................................. 67

Viewing video ....................................................................................... 71

Selecting scenes and files ...................................................................... 72

Displaying scene and file information ................................................... 73

Comment view ....................................................................................... 74

Combining and subdividing scenes ....................................................... 75

Redetecting scenes ................................................................................. 77

The Transitions section ............................................................................ 78

The Montage

®

Themes section ................................................................ 80

The Titles section ...................................................................................... 81

The Still Images section ........................................................................... 82

The Disc Menus section ............................................................................ 83

The Sound Effects section ........................................................................ 84

The Music section ..................................................................................... 85

The Project Bin ......................................................................................... 86

CHAPTER 4: THE MOVIE WINDOW ........................... 91

Movie Window views................................................................................ 95

Storyboard view ..................................................................................... 95

Timeline view ........................................................................................ 96

Text view ............................................................................................. 102

The toolboxes .......................................................................................... 102

The Video toolbox ............................................................................... 104

The Audio toolbox ............................................................................... 106

CHAPTER 5: VIDEO CLIPS ...................................... 109

Video clip basics ..................................................................................... 110

Adding video clips to your movie ....................................................... 110

Working with multiple capture files .................................................... 111

The project video format ..................................................................... 112

Interface features ................................................................................. 115

Trimming video clips .............................................................................. 117

Trimming on the Timeline using handles ............................................ 117

Clip-trimming tips ............................................................................... 121

Trimming with the Clip properties tool ............................................... 122

Resetting trimmed clips ....................................................................... 124

Splitting and combining clips ................................................................ 125

Advanced Timeline editing .................................................................... 126

Insert editing ........................................................................................ 128

Split editing ......................................................................................... 130

The SmartMovie music video tool ......................................................... 134

CHAPTER 6: THEMES AND THEME EDITING ........ 139

Using themes ........................................................................................... 141

The Themes section of the Album ....................................................... 143

Creating theme clips ............................................................................ 143

Working with theme clips on the Timeline ......................................... 145

Anatomy of a theme ............................................................................ 147

Opening the Theme Editor tool............................................................ 150

Using the Theme Editor tool ................................................................ 151

CHAPTER 7: VIDEO EFFECTS ................................. 155

Working with the effects list................................................................ 156

Changing effect parameters ................................................................. 158

Keyframing .......................................................................................... 160

Using keyframing ................................................................................ 163

Previewing and rendering .................................................................... 166

Table of contents v

Video effects library ............................................................................... 166

Standard effects ...................................................................................... 168

Auto color correction ........................................................................... 169

Dream glow ......................................................................................... 169

Noise reduction .................................................................................... 170

Rotate ................................................................................................... 170

Stabilize ............................................................................................... 170

Speed ................................................................................................... 171

Ultimate effects ....................................................................................... 172

Blur ...................................................................................................... 173

Emboss ................................................................................................ 173

Old film ............................................................................................... 173

Soften ................................................................................................... 174

Stained glass ........................................................................................ 174

Luma key ............................................................................................. 175

2D Editor ............................................................................................. 175

Earthquake ........................................................................................... 175

Lens flare ............................................................................................. 176

Magnify ............................................................................................... 176

Motion blur .......................................................................................... 176

Water drop ........................................................................................... 177

Water wave .......................................................................................... 177

Black and white ................................................................................... 177

Color correction ................................................................................... 177

Color map ............................................................................................ 178

Invert ................................................................................................... 178

Lighting ............................................................................................... 179

Posterize .............................................................................................. 179

RGB color balance............................................................................... 179

Sepia .................................................................................................... 180

White balance ...................................................................................... 180

CHAPTER 8: TWO-TRACK EDITING ....................... 181

Introducing the overlay track ............................................................... 181

A/B editing .......................................................................................... 183

The Picture-in-picture tool ................................................................... 184

The Chroma key tool ........................................................................... 190

Selecting colors ................................................................................... 196

CHAPTER 9: TRANSITIONS ..................................... 199

Transition types and their uses ............................................................ 201

Previewing transitions in your movie .................................................. 204

Audio transitions ................................................................................. 204

The Ripple Transition command ......................................................... 205

Trimming transitions ............................................................................. 206

Trimming with the Clip properties tool ............................................... 207

CHAPTER 10: STILL IMAGES .................................. 209

Editing still images ................................................................................. 211

Editing image clip properties ............................................................... 212

The Frame Grabber ............................................................................... 219

The Frame grabber tool ....................................................................... 219

CHAPTER 11: DISC MENUS ..................................... 221

Disc authoring in Studio ...................................................................... 223

Using menus from the Album .............................................................. 224

The DVD Player Control ..................................................................... 226

Editing menus on the Timeline ............................................................ 228

Editing with the Clip properties tool ................................................... 230

The Disc menu tool .............................................................................. 235

CHAPTER 12: THE CLASSIC TITLE EDITOR .......... 237

Launching the Classic Title Editor ...................................................... 238

The Classic Title Editor controls ........................................................... 239

Title-type buttons ................................................................................. 239

Object toolbox ..................................................................................... 240

Editing-mode selection buttons ........................................................... 243

Object layout buttons ........................................................................... 245

Clipboard and delete buttons ............................................................... 247

Text-styling controls ............................................................................ 247

The Classic Title Editor Album ............................................................. 249

The Looks Browser ............................................................................. 249

The Backgrounds section ..................................................................... 251

The Pictures section ............................................................................. 253

The Buttons section ............................................................................. 254

Table of contents vii

CHAPTER 13: THE MOTION TITLER ....................... 257

Launching (and leaving) the titler ........................................................ 259

File operations ..................................................................................... 261

The Motion Titler Album ...................................................................... 262

The Videos section .............................................................................. 264

The Photos section ............................................................................... 265

The Objects section ............................................................................. 266

The Looks section ................................................................................ 267

The Motions section ............................................................................ 272

Creating and editing Motion Titles ....................................................... 275

The Background Panel ......................................................................... 277

The Edit window ................................................................................. 279

Working with text ................................................................................ 282

Working with the Layer List................................................................ 286

Working with layer groups .................................................................. 293

CHAPTER 14: SOUND EFFECTS AND MUSIC ........ 297

The Timeline audio tracks ................................................................... 300

The CD audio tool ............................................................................... 302

The Background music tool ................................................................. 303

The Voice-over tool ............................................................................. 305

Trimming audio clips ............................................................................. 308

Trimming with the Clip properties tool ............................................... 308

Audio volume and mixing ...................................................................... 310

Anatomy of an audio clip .................................................................... 311

Adjusting audio on the Timeline ......................................................... 313

Transitions on the audio tracks ............................................................ 315

The Volume and balance tool .............................................................. 316

CHAPTER 15: AUDIO EFFECTS .............................. 323

Noise reduction .................................................................................... 324

Ultimate effects ....................................................................................... 326

ChannelTool ........................................................................................ 326

Chorus ................................................................................................. 326

DeEsser ................................................................................................ 327

Equalizer .............................................................................................. 327

Grungelizer .......................................................................................... 328

Leveler ................................................................................................. 329

Reverb ................................................................................................. 329

Stereo Echo .......................................................................................... 330

Stereo Spread ....................................................................................... 330

CHAPTER 16: MAKING YOUR MOVIE ..................... 331

Output to disc media .............................................................................. 334

Output to file ........................................................................................... 338

Output to tape ......................................................................................... 346

Configuring the camera or video recorder... ........................................ 346

Output your movie to videotape .......................................................... 348

Output to the web ................................................................................... 349

APPENDIX A: SETUP OPTIONS .............................. 351

Project preferences .............................................................................. 352

Video and audio preferences ............................................................... 355

Make Disc settings .............................................................................. 360

Make File settings ................................................................................ 365

Make Real Media file settings ............................................................. 369

Make Windows Media file settings ..................................................... 372

Make tape settings ............................................................................... 374

APPENDIX B: TIPS AND TRICKS ............................ 377

Hardware ............................................................................................. 377

Graphics card settings .......................................................................... 379

Studio and computer animation ........................................................... 380

APPENDIX C: TROUBLESHOOTING ....................... 381

Technical help on-line ............................................................................ 382

Top support issues .................................................................................. 384

Errors or crashes during installation .................................................... 385

Studio crashes in Edit mode ................................................................ 386

Table of contents ix

Studio hangs when rendering ............................................................... 391

Studio hangs on launch or does not launch .......................................... 394

“Burning failed” error appears in Make Movie ................................... 396

DVDs created by Studio do not play back, or appear blank. ............... 398

APPENDIX D: VIDEOGRAPHY TIPS ........................ 399

Creating a shooting plan ...................................................................... 399

Editing ................................................................................................. 400

Rules of thumb for video editing ......................................................... 404

Soundtrack production ......................................................................... 406

Title ..................................................................................................... 407

APPENDIX E: GLOSSARY ........................................ 409

APPENDIX F: KEYBOARD SHORTCUTS ................ 427

INDEX ........................................................................ 431

Before you start

Thank you for purchasing Pinnacle Studio. We hope you enjoy using the software.

This manual covers all versions of Studio, including

Studio Ultimate and Studio Ultimate Collection.

Differences between versions will be noted as applicable. Most of the time, the word “Studio” will be used generically to refer to all versions. Similarly, references to “Studio Ultimate” apply also to Studio

Ultimate Collection unless otherwise stated.

If you have not used Studio before, we recommend that you keep the manual handy for reference even if you don’t actually read it all the way through.

In order to ensure that your Studio experience gets off on the right foot, please review the three topics below before continuing to Chapter 1: Using Studio .

Also highly recommended to new users is the Studio

Tutorial. To launch the Tutorial, click its link on the

“splash” screen when you start Studio, or use the Help

¾

Guided Tour menu command within the application itself.

Before you start xi

Equipment requirements

In addition to your Studio software, an efficient Studio editing system requires certain levels of hardware performance as noted in this section. Remember too that while specifications are important, they do not tell the whole story: the proper functioning of hardware devices can also depend on manufacturer-supplied driver software. Checking the maker’s web-site for driver updates and support information can often be helpful in solving problems with graphics cards, sound cards and other devices.

Note: Some features mentioned here require free or paid “activation” via the Internet, depending on your version of Studio.

Computer

Intel Pentium or AMD Athlon 1.8 GHz or higher

(2.4 GHz or higher recommended). Intel Core™ 2 or i7 2.4 GHz required for AVCHD editing (2.66 GHz for AVCHD 1920)

• 1 GB system memory recommended, 2 GB required for AVCHD editing

• Windows® 7, Windows Vista® with SP2, or

Windows XP with SP3

DirectX 9 or 10 compatible graphics card with 64

MB (128 MB or higher recommended); 256 MB for

HD and AVCHD editing

DirectX 9 or higher compatible sound card

3.2 GB of disk space (plug-ins extra)

DVD-ROM drive to install software.

The following items are optional:

• CD-R(W) burner for creating VideoCDs (VCDs) or

Super VideoCDs (SVCDs).

• DVD-/+R(W) burner for creating DVD, HD DVD and AVCHD discs.

• Blu-ray burner for creating Blu-ray discs (Studio

Ultimate).

Sound card with surround-sound output for preview of surround-sound mixes.

The hard drive

Your hard drive must be capable of sustained reading and writing at 4 MB/sec. Most drives are capable of this. The first time you capture, Studio will test your drive to make sure it is fast enough. Video in the DV second, so just four and a half minutes of DV video will consume a full gigabyte on the drive.

Tip: For capture from video tape, we recommend using a separate hard drive in order to avoid competition between Studio and other software, including

Windows, for use of the drive during capture.

Video capture hardware

Studio can capture video from a variety of digital and analog sources. Please see “The Import From panel” on page 20.

Video output hardware

Studio can output video to:

• Any HDV, DV or Digital8 camcorder or VCR. This requires an OHCI-compliant IEEE-1394 (FireWire)

Before you start xiii

port (as provided by Pinnacle Studio DV). The camcorder must be set up to record from DV Input.

• Any analog (8mm, Hi8, VHS, SVHS, VHS-C or

SVHS-C) camcorder or VCR. This requires Pinnacle

Studio USB-700, PCI-500, PCI-700, or another

Pinnacle device with analog outputs. Output to analog camcorders or VCRs is also possible using a

Pinnacle Studio DV or other OHCI-compliant 1394 port if your DV or Digital8 camcorder or VCR can pass a DV signal through to its analog outputs (see your camcorder manual and Chapter 16: Making your movie , for more information).

Abbreviations and conventions

This guide uses the following conventions to help organize the material.

Terminology

AVCHD: A video data format used by some highdefinition camcorders, and for creating DVD discs that can be read on Blu-ray players. Successful editing of

AVCHD files requires more computing power than other formats supported by Studio.

DV: The term “DV” refers to DV and Digital8 camcorders, VCRs and tapes.

HDV: A “high-definition video” format that allows video in frame sizes of 1280x720 or 1440x1080 to be recorded in MPEG-2 format on DV media.

1394: The term “1394” refers to OHCI-compliant

IEEE-1394, FireWire, DV or i.LINK interfaces, ports and cables.

Analog: The term “analog” refers to 8mm, Hi8, VHS,

SVHS, VHS-C or SVHS-C camcorders, VCRs and tapes, and to Composite/RCA and S-Video cables and connectors.

Buttons, menus, dialog boxes and windows

Names of buttons, menus and related items are written in italics to distinguish them from the surrounding text, whereas window and dialog names are written with initial capital letters. For example:

Click the Edit menu button to open your menu in the

Classic Title Editor.

Choosing menu commands

The right arrowhead symbol (

¾

) denotes the path for hierarchical menu items. For example:

Select Toolbox

¾

Generate Background Music .

Keyboard conventions

Key names are spelled with an initial capital and are underlined. A plus sign denotes a key combination. For example:

Press Ctrl+A to select all the clips on the Timeline.

Mouse clicks

When a mouse click is required, the default is always a left-click unless otherwise specified:

Right-click and select Go to Title/Menu Editor .

Before you start xv

On-line help

Two kinds of immediate help are always available while you are working in Studio:

• Help file: Click the help button in the Studio main menu bar, or select the Help

¾

Help topics menu, or press F1 to open Studio’s help file.

Tool tips: To find out what a button or other Studio control does, pause your mouse pointer over it. A

“tool tip” appears explaining its function.

CHAPTER 1:

Using Studio

Creating movies with Studio is a three-step process:

1. Import: Import source video material – your “raw footage” – to your PC hard drive. Possible sources include analog videotape (8mm, VHS etc.), digital videotape (HDV, DV, Digital8), memory cards and other file-based media, and live video from a video camera, camcorder or webcam.

Import mode is covered in Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media .

2. Edit: Arrange your video material as desired by reordering scenes and discarding unwanted footage.

Add visuals, such as transitions, titles and graphics, and supplementary audio, such as sound effects and background music. For DVD, Blu-ray Disc and VCD authoring, create interactive menus that give your audience a customized viewing experience.

Edit mode is the arena for most of your work in Studio.

See “Edit mode” later in this chapter (page 4) for a fuller introduction.

Availability: Blu-ray Disc authoring is supported in Studio Ultimate and Studio Ultimate Collection only.

Chapter 1: Using Studio 1

3. Make movie: When your project is complete, generate a finished movie in your choice of format and storage medium: tape, VCD, S-VCD, DVD, AVI,

MPEG, RealVideo, Windows Media and more.

Make Movie mode is covered in Chapter 16: Making your movie .

Setting the mode

Select which step of the movie-making process you want to work on by clicking one of the three mode buttons at the top left of the Studio window:

When you switch modes, the Studio screen changes to display the controls needed for the new mode.

Undo, Redo, Help, Support and Premium

The Undo, Redo, Help,

Support and Premium buttons are always to be found in the top right corner of the Studio window, no matter which of the three modes you are currently working in.

• Undo allows you to back out of any changes you have made to your project during the current session, one step at a time.

• Redo reinstates the changes one by one if you undo too far.

The Help button launches Studio’s built-in help system.

The Support button opens Studio’s technical support site in your web browser.

• The Premium button lets you expand Studio by purchasing and installing premium content. (See page 12 for details.)

All other controls on the Studio screen are dedicated to tasks within the current mode.

Setting options

Most options in Studio are set using two tabbed dialog boxes.

The first lets you control options related to Edit mode.

It has two tabs:

The other dialog box is concerned with options relating to Make Movie mode. It has three tabs, one for each of the three movie output types:

Each panel of both dialog boxes can be opened individually with a corresponding command on the

Setup menu (e.g. Setup

¾

Project preferences ). Once either dialog box is open, however, all of its panels are available through the tabs.

Chapter 1: Using Studio 3

For simplicity, we generally refer to the different options panels independently, as in “the Project preferences options panel”.

Detailed explanations of the options in both dialog boxes are contained in Appendix A: Setup Options .

Additional options for importing are provided on the

Mode panel of the Import Wizard. The options available depend on the type of media you plan to import, as explained under “The Mode panel” on page

27.

™

E

DIT MODE

Studio opens in Edit mode each time it is launched, because that is the mode you use most often. The Edit mode display includes three main areas.

The Album stores resources you will use in your movies, including your captured video scenes.

The Movie Window is where you create your edited movie by arranging video and sound clips, and by applying transitions and effects.

The Player provides playback and previewing for whichever item is currently selected in Studio. That may be an Album resource – such as a video scene, title or sound effect – or your edited movie, complete with transitions, titles, effects and several audio tracks. The

Player is covered below.

See Chapter 3: The Album and Chapter 4: The Movie

Window for detailed information on those topics.

Studio in Edit mode with n

the Album, o

the Player, and p

the Movie Window, shown here in its

Storyboard view.

The Player

The Player displays a preview of your edited movie, or of the item currently selected in the Album.

It consists of two main areas: a preview window and playback controls . The preview window displays video images. The playback controls allow you to play the video, or go to an exact position within it. These controls come in two formats: standard and DVD .

Standard mode

The standard playback controls are similar to those on a camcorder or VCR. They are used for viewing ordinary video.

Chapter 1: Using Studio 5

DVD mode

The DVD playback controls emulate the navigation controls on a DVD player or remote control. Use them for previewing your DVD or other disc productions, including menu interaction.

The preview window

This is a point of focus in Studio because you use it so often, especially for previewing your movie. It can also be used to display:

Any type of Album content.

Still images or titles from your movie.

Changes to video effects in real time while you adjust the parameter controls for the effects.

Still frames from your video. While viewing a still frame, you can step by as little as a single frame in either direction with the “jog” controls.

Resizing the video preview

If your screen dimensions permit, Studio lets you enlarge the Player – and therefore the video preview – by means of the

Player size slider. This control appears above the Player to the left of the Undo button when reorganizing the display is possible.

Drag the control knob rightwards to increase the Player size, or leftwards to decrease it. The leftmost knob position corresponds to the smallest (and default) size.

Resizing the Player optimizes your use of screen “real estate” to obtain a larger video preview.

Chapter 1: Using Studio 7

The DVD toggle button

Switch between the two playback modes with the DVD toggle button at the bottom right-hand corner of the Player. This button is only available when your edited movie contains at least one menu.

Playback controls

The Player presents either of two sets of playback controls depending on the playback mode you choose.

When you play your movie back as ordinary video, you will be using the standard playback controls . If your movie uses disc menu navigation, you can play it back as an optical disc with interactive on-screen menus by using the DVD playback controls . Both groups of controls are covered below.

The full-screen preview button: This button, just above the top right-hand corner of the preview window, switches to a full-screen preview. It is available in both playback modes. On a single-monitor system, the full-screen display ends when your movie ends, or you double-click the screen or press the Esc key. See the Video preview options in the Video and

Audio Preferences panel (page 355) for settings that apply to multiple-monitor systems.

The Video preview options on the Video and audio preferences options panel let you direct the full-screen preview to the secondary monitor on your system if there is one. In Studio Ultimate, you can simultaneously send your preview to an external device, if desired.

Standard playback controls

These buttons control playback in the Player.

Play / Pause : The Play button previews the movie from the current position. Once preview begins, Play becomes Pause . When playback is paused, the Album scene or Movie Window clip at which previewing stopped remains selected. The

[Space] key can also be used to start and stop playback.

Go to beginning: This button halts playback and skips back to the first frame of the material being previewed.

Fast reverse, Fast forward: These buttons let you preview your movie at two, four or ten times the normal speed, in either direction. Use them to scan for a particular piece of video you want to work with. Click the buttons repeatedly to loop through the speed factors.

Loop: This button causes the currently-selected clips in the Movie Window to play back repeatedly. This feature is especially convenient whilst selecting and editing add-on effects and transitions.

Click any playback button to halt looping. The loop button lights up while looping is active. Looping is maintained even if you switch playback speeds.

Jog buttons: This pair of controls normally steps your movie forward and backward by one frame at a time. To step by seconds, minutes or hours instead of frames, select the corresponding field in the counter

(see below), then use the jog buttons to modify it.

The Player scrubber

Use the Player scrubber to quickly traverse your captured video or edited movie in either direction. The

Chapter 1: Using Studio 9

scrubber position corresponds to the position of the current frame in the captured video file ( not just the current scene) or in the edited movie ( not just the current clip). Thus the scrubber bar always represents the entire length of the content being viewed.

As you move the scrubber, the preview window shows the current frame. If you have activated the audio scrubbing button in the Movie Window, you will also hear snatches of your movie’s audio as you scrub. See page 92 for details.

The ability of the preview to keep up with the scrubber depends on the speed of your computer. If you move the Player scrubber slowly, the preview display responds smoothly. As you increase the rate at which you move the scrubber, the preview will jump frames.

The point at which it does so depends on your hardware. The smoothness of the preview also diminishes as the overall length of the material being scrubbed increases.

The counter

The counter displays the current playback position in hours, minutes, seconds and frames. You can directly modify the counter fields to select an exact frame to view or at which to start playback. Simply click on the number you wish to change and type a new value. To move to a different field, click again or use the Left and Right arrow keys.

You can also modify the value in a selected field by using the jog buttons beside the counter or the Up and

Down arrow keys.

The master volume slider

This control sets the overall audio volume during preview playback. It is equivalent to turning up the master volume on your sound card using the system volume tool. It does not affect the volume of the final movie Studio creates in Make Movie mode.

The small loudspeaker icon at the right of the control serves as a master mute button during playback.

DVD playback controls

These controls include the four standard transport buttons detailed above

( Play/Pause , Fast reverse , Fast forward ,

Go to beginning ) plus the DVD Player

Control , which is described under “The DVD Player

Control” on page 226.

Further editing topics

Please see the following for details on specific editing topics:

Chapter 5: Video clips

Chapter 6: Themes and theme editing

Chapter 7: Video effects

Chapter 8: Two-track editing

Chapter 9: Transitions

Chapter 10: Still images

Chapter 11: Disc menus

Chapter 1: Using Studio 11

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music

Chapter 15: Audio effects

Expanding Studio

One way to add pizzazz to your productions is to use a variety of video and audio filters, animated transitions, titles, VCD and DVD menus, themes and sound effects.

Studio includes an extensive selection of hundreds of content items and special effects, but it’s also designed to grow along with your needs. When you want a particular filter, transition, menu or effect that isn’t part of the basic set, an easy-to-use upgrade mechanism lets you find, purchase and install the materials you need without even leaving the program.

New tools, new media, new frontiers

You can purchase additional media and filters in any of three ways from within Studio:

With the Help

¾

Purchase activation keys menu command (or the premium shortcut button at the top right of the Studio screen).

This opens a special browser window in which you can access a catalog page for any type of premium content that interests you.

• With the Album commands More transitions , More themes , More sound effects and More menus .

These commands are found on the dropdown lists in the corresponding sections of the Album. They will enable you to download, try out and purchase additional premium content that was not included with the program installation.

By clicking the activate buttons found in some parts of Studio.

These buttons can be found whenever premium content is on display within Studio. The one above, when seen in the Audio effects tool and the Video effects tool, would let you activate a pack of audio or video filters. You may encounter similar buttons in the Album that let you purchase all the media on a particular Album page as a theme pack.

How activation works

“Activating” premium content for Studio means to obtain a license allowing you unrestricted use of the content on the single machine where Studio is installed.

The licensing mechanism employs two distinct but mutually related codes:

• An activation key for each premium content item you purchase;

Your Passport , which is a number generated the first time you install Studio on your computer. You can view your Passport by selecting the Help

¾

My

Passport menu command.

Because the Passport is specific to one computer, you will need to obtain new activation keys if you install

Studio on a different machine. These will be provided

Chapter 1: Using Studio 13

at no charge, but your user licenses for both Studio and any premium content you have obtained then apply to the new machine only.

Note: Although your Passport is specific to an individual computer, it is not affected by ordinary hardware modifications such as adding or removing expansion cards, drives or memory.

If you don’t have an Internet connection...

You can purchase and apply premium content activation keys even if you don’t have an Internet connection on the computer where Studio is installed.

When you click one of the unlock links within Studio, a dialog will be displayed showing information needed for ordering the specific content you want, including:

An Internet URL where you can activate the content

Numeric identifiers for the Studio program and the item you want to activate

• Your Passport and your Serial Number

Navigate to the given URL from another computer, enter the information, and complete the purchase as directed. You will then be given an activation key with which you can activate the content on the original computer by using the Help

¾

Enter Activation Keys menu command.

Hiding and showing premium content

If you would prefer not to view the premium content and features available in Studio, open the Project preferences options panel and uncheck either or both of

Show premium content and Show premium features .

(See page 352.)

Importing content from past Studio versions

If you are an owner of a past version of Studio, the chances are that you already own content items, whether on a “Bonus Content” or “Premium Pack” disc, or on a hard drive attached to your system. The

Studio “Transfer Content” wizard walks you through the process of locating all such materials that are available to you, and importing them for use in the current version of the software. Among the item types handled by the wizard are:

Titles

Disc menus

Sound effects

Hollywood FX 3D transitions

RTFx video effects

To launch the wizard, look in the Studio group on your

Start ¾ All Programs menu, and select Tools ¾

Transfer Content .

Chapter 1: Using Studio 15

CHAPTER 2:

Capturing and importing media

Studio lets you incorporate many kinds of media in your video productions. When these are stored externally to your computer – on a camcorder tape, say, or a memory stick from your digital camera – they must be transferred to local storage before you can use them.

This transfer process is called “capturing” or

“importing”. A distinction has long been made between

“capturing” from tape and “importing” from file-based sources, but it is less significant nowadays when most audiovisual recordings are stored in digital form throughout their lifetimes. Only when recording from analog sources (such as VHS or Hi8) is there still a

“capture” process involving conversion to digital form.

We will most often use the terms “import” and

“importing” to signify all methods of bringing images and sound into Studio for use in your productions.

The next step

After Studio has finished importing your media, you will be able to access the imported files for use in your productions. See Chapter 3: The Album for details.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 17

The Studio Import Wizard

The very first step in capturing is to open the Studio

Import Wizard by clicking the Import button at the top left of the screen.

The Import Wizard consists of a large central area surrounded by a number of smaller panels.

One of these, the Import

From panel at the top left of the display, has a pivotal role.

It provides a list of device types that can serve as the source of your import operation. Your choice of input source in turn determines the rest of the Import Wizard display. Above all, the set of controls offered in the central area for preview, browsing and selecting material depends on the chosen import type.

Importing can be regarded as a four-step process:

1.

Select the import source on the Import From panel.

2.

Confirm or adjust the settings on the other panels.

3.

Select material to import from the chosen source.

4.

Initiate the import operation.

Studio then begins transferring the requested audio, video and pictorial material from the source device to your hard drive, using the locations set in the Import To

panel. Once the import operation is complete, the

Import Wizard closes and returns control to Studio, where you can access the imported files through the

Album. (See Chapter 3: The Album .)

Here the Import Wizard is configured for importing material from DVD. For disc sources, the central area lists the ‘chapters’ available for importing.

™

I

MPORT

W

IZARD PANELS

The actual selection of material to be imported takes place in the central area of the Import Wizard. Each import source uses the central area somewhat differently.

Depending on the input source, the central area shares the Import Wizard interface with up to four auxiliary panels with standardized functions.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 19

The Import From panel

This is the top left panel of the Import Wizard, a position that reflects its vital role in setting up the import operation.

The photos, music and video footage you want to import may reside on a variety of device types and technologies. The supported import sources include:

All types of auxiliary file-based storage media, including optical drives, memory cards and USB sticks (see “Import from file-based media”, page 35).

Click Other devices in the Import From panel to start.

DV or HDV video cameras using an IEEE-1394

(FireWire) connection (see “Import from DV or

HDV camera”, page 42). Devices are listed by name in the Import From panel by their device names (e.g.

“DV Device”). Select the applicable one.

Analog video cameras and recorders (see “Import from analog sources”, page 47). Any analog capture hardware on your system is listed by name (e.g.

“Pinnacle Systems MovieBox”).

• DVD and Blu-ray discs (see “Import from DVD or

Blu-ray Disc”, page 48).

• Digital still cameras (see

“Import from digital cameras”, page 49).

Some sources in the Import

From panel are chosen from a sub-list of actual devices that is appears when you click the

main source entry. In the illustration, DVD / Blu-Ray has been clicked. The user can now choose between the two DVD drives installed on this particular system.

Single-frame import

Studio provides two special modes for importing single frames, rather than continuous footage. These modes are:

Stop motion: Create an animated film by importing one frame at a time from a live video source (see

“Stop motion”, page 49).

Snapshot: Import individual images from tape or from a live source like a webcam (see “Snapshot”, page 52).

Adjusting analog audio and video levels

Analog capture hardware may provide additional controls for modifying parameter levels of the audio and video signals.

Such a capability is useful for correcting exposure problems and the like in the source material, and when you need to compensate for differences in video from multiple sources.

To access the controls, click the more button beside the source name. This opens the Analog Input Levels window.

Although you can also adjust these levels with the appropriate V ideo effects in Edit mode, setting them correctly for capture can save you from having to worry about color correction later on.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 21

The Analog Input Levels window lets you adjust a number of video and audio parameters. The Hue slider (fourth from left) is not used with PAL sources.

Setting your audio options correctly as you capture will help in achieving consistent volume levels and quality.

Particular capture devices may offer fewer options than are shown and discussed here. For instance, with hardware that doesn’t support stereo captures, an audio balance control will not appear.

Video: Choose the type of video you are going to digitize by clicking the appropriate s ource button

( Composite or SVideo ). The five sliders allow you to control the brightness (video gain), contrast (ratio of lightest to darkest), sharpness, hue and color saturation of the incoming video.

• The hue slider can be useful for correcting unwanted color shifts in NTSC material; it is not available when capturing from a PAL source.

• The saturation slider regulates the “color saturation”

– the amount of color – in the image. (An image with zero saturation has only black, white and gray tones.)

Audio: The sliders on the right side of the panel let you control the input level and stereo balance of the incoming audio.

The Import To panel

After importing, your media items will be accessible as files on your computer. The Import To panel of the

Import Wizard lets you specify where those files will be stored. Separate folders are available for video, audio and picture items, but the Import To panel only lists those that are relevant to the current import source, as set in the Import From panel.

As the number of media files on your system grows, it becomes increasingly useful to give some thought to how best to organize the material into folders and subfolders such that in the future you can most readily retrieve any desired item. The controls on the Import

To panel are designed to automate this process to whatever degree you choose.

Working with import folders

Until you specify otherwise, the Import Wizard uses the standard document folders for video, music and pictures within your Windows user account. The illustration shows a typical setup in

Windows Vista. To change an import folder, click either the small folder button or the current folder path. (See

“Selecting an import folder” below.)

The folders you choose for each media type, whether default or custom, serve as base locations for your imported files. In order to manage your media

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 23

collection effectively, you can also specify either a custom subfolder name or a method of automaticallygenerating a name based on either the current date or the creation date of the imported material. Click either s“set subfolder” or the more button for the media type to access the subfolder options. (See “Setting a subfolder” below.)

For example, if you set your main video folder to

“c:\vid”, and your subfolder naming method to

“Current month”, any video you import will be placed in a folder with a name like “c:\vid\2009-10”.

Fill level indicator: This bar graph shows for each import destination how much room is left on the storage device. The first part of the bar represents space zzalready occupied on the device. The colored extension shows how much room any currentlyselected media files awaiting import will require.

Available storage space display

Note: If a destination device reaches 98 per cent full during import, the operation is halted at that point.

Selecting an import folder

To choose a different base folder for a given media type, click the corresponding folder button or folder name on the

Import To panel. This opens a folder selection box where you can navigate to, and if necessary create, the folder you want to use.

Folders that contain subfolders are indicated with a plus icon to the left of the folder icon if they are currently closed, and a minus icon if they are open. Clicking the icon reverses the state of the folder.

Click the plus icon to view the contents of a folder.

To create a subfolder within the currently-selected folder, click “New Folder” at the bottom of the file selector, type a name for the folder, then press Enter.

To rename a folder, select it then either click it once with the left mouse button, or press the F2 key. An inplace edit box opens, allowing you to type over the old name with a new one of your choice. Finally, press

Enter to accept or Esc to cancel the name change.

Renaming the selected folder.

After locating and selecting the folder you want to serve as the base folder, click the OK button to approve the choice and return to the Import Wizard window.

Setting a subfolder

To designate a subfolder of the base folder as the actual import destination for the media type, click either “set subfolder” button or the more button . These buttons

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 25

open a dialog window that represents an expanded version of the Import To panel, one that includes controls needed to set the subfolder name or naming method for each media type supported by the currentlyselected import source.

The expanded Import To dialog window for filebased media. Since files can be of any media type, controls for all three types are provided. Most other sources import only video media, and don’t show the

Audio and Photo controls.

The row of controls for each media type includes a dropdown list of naming options:

• No subfolder: With this option, the files you import will be stored in the base folder.

• Custom: When you choose this option, an in-place edit box appears. Enter the name of the subfolder in which to store your next import or imports of the media type.

Today: Your imports will go to a subfolder named with the current date, in the format “2009-10-25”.

Creation date: Each imported file will be stored in a subfolder named with the creation date of the media, in the same format as above. When multiple media items are brought in as part of a single import operation, this may entail creating or updating multiple subfolders.

• Current month: This is the same as the Today option but without the day portion, e.g “2009-10”.

After making your choice, click the button at the top right of the dialog window to return to the Import

Wizard.

The Mode panel

The Mode panel of the Import Wizard provides a place to adjust the options offered by several import sources.

DV / HDV import options

The options for DV and HDV import are in three groups on the Mode panel.

Presets: The Presets group offers two standard configurations for video and audio compression, and a custom setting that lets you fine-tune compression parameters in the Compression Options window, which opens when the upper more button is clicked. (See

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 27

“The Compression Options window” on page 30.) The fixed presets are:

• DV: This provides full-quality DV capture, using about 200 MB of disk space per minute of video.

• MPEG: MPEG compression produces smaller files than does DV, but requires more computational horsepower to encode and decode. This could result in slower performance on older computers.

Scene detection: When the scene detection feature is enabled, your footage is divided up on import into

“scenes” that can be displayed and manipulated separately in the Studio Album. This greatly simplifies the task of locating material of interest during editing.

Click the lower more button to open the Scene

Detection Options window. (See “The Scene Detection

Options window” on page 31.)

Stop at tape end: This option tells Studio whether to automatically stop capturing if a blank area of tape is encountered. A blank area – one without timecode striping – indicates virgin tape. Provided you have avoided leaving any blank spots during shooting (by slightly overlapping neighboring shots), this option allows for unattended capture.

Import options for analog media

The options for analog import are similar to those just discussed for digital sources.

See below for explanations of the Compression Options and

Scene Detections Options windows.

Stop when no signal is the analog equivalent of the

Stop at tape end option described above. When set,

Studio will automatically end capture when the signal from the source device is interrupted.

Import options for file-based media

The Mode panel provides two options affecting importing from file-based media.

Delete original: When this option is enabled, the original copies of the files you import will be deleted after copying. This option is handy if you are using the

Import Wizard to consolidate your media and don’t want your hard drive cluttered with redundant copies.

Ignore duplicates: This option helps you deal with redundant media files you already have, by telling the

Import Wizard not to import extra copies of files that may be differently-named but are apparently identical.

Import options for stop-motion capture

In stop-motion animation, a series of individual frames is captured from a live video source. Depending on your plans for the stop-motion sequence, you can instruct the

Import Wizard to integrate the individual frames into a movie, or simply import each frame as a picture, or both.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 29

The Compression Options window

The options provided in the Mode panel for both DV /

HDV and analog import include access to this window for fine-tuning compression preferences. If you select either of the DV and MPEG presets, you can use this window to review the actual settings used. Editing the settings here automatically selects the “Custom” preset.

The Compression Options window for digital and analog video import.

Because some options are contingent on others, not all will be visible simultaneously.

Video settings

Compression Codec: Use this dropdown list to select the codec you want to use.

Framesize: This line shows the dimensions of the captured video.

Quality, Data rate: Some codecs present quality options in terms of a compression percentage ( Quality ), and others in terms of the required data transfer rate in

KB/sec ( Data rate ).

Audio settings

Compression: This dropdown shows the codec that will be used to compress the incoming audio data.

Record audio: Clear this checkbox if you are not planning to use the captured audio in your production.

The Scene Detection Options window

The options provided in the Mode panel for both DV /

HDV and analog import include access to this window for configuring scene detection preferences.

The Scene Detection Options window for DV or HDV import. When importing from analog sources, only the the last two options are supported.

Automatic scene detection is a key feature of Studio when working with DV and HDV sources. As video capture proceeds, Studio detects natural breaks in the video and divides it up into scenes . A new icon is created in the Video Scenes section of the Album for each scene detected.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 31

Depending on which capture device you are using, automatic scene detection is carried out either in real time during capture, or as a separate step immediately after capture is completed.

The four scene detection options are:

• Automatic based on shooting time and date: This option is available only when you are capturing from a DV source. Studio monitors the time stamp data on the tape during capture, and starts a new scene whenever a discontinuity is found.

• Automatic based on video content: Studio detects changes in the video content, and creates a new scene wherever there is a large change in the images.

This feature might not work well if the lighting is not stable. To take an extreme example, a video shot in a nightclub with a strobe light would produce a scene each time the strobe flashed.

Create new scene every X seconds: Studio creates new scenes at an interval you choose. This can be useful for breaking up footage that contains long continuous shots.

No automatic scene detection: Select this option if you want to monitor the entire capture process and decide for yourself where scene breaks should occur.

Press the [Space] key each time you want to insert a scene break during capture.

The Filename panel

This panel of the Import Wizard is where you specify the names under which your imported media files will be stored.

Each type of input source has a default filename assigned by

Studio. For instance, the default filename when importing a Snapshot is “Snapshot”. To change it, click in the space and type the name you want.

The Import Wizard never overwrites an existing file when importing. If a file with the same name as the target name already exists, a sequence number is added to the name of the incoming file.

When importing from filebased media, additional file naming features are available.

By default the naming formula for a file-based input is given symbolically as

“[original].[ext]”, meaning that the original filename and extension are used.

If you want a custom name, enter it into the edit box as usual; however, in the case of file-based media the target filename has two parts: a stem , which you supply, and a tail , which is generated by one of three simple rules at the time of import. The default rule adds a unique sequence number to every filename. While you are entering your custom name, the edit box shows only the stem. But when the name is displayed at other times, the rule for the tail part of appears as well.

To select a different rule for the tail part, click the more button . This opens a dialog window with two dropdown lists. The first lets you choose between

“original” and “custom” for the stem. You can use this if you ever want to revert to importing files under their original names. The second dropdown, which is

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 33

displayed only for custom names, gives the available rules for generating the tail part:

Number: This is the same rule used by other media types to avoid name collisions. If your stem is

“Parade”, the first file copied will be named

“Parade” (plus the original file extension), the second will be named “Parade_001”, and the numbers then continue in sequence.

• Creation time: The time of day when the file was created, in hours, minutes, and seconds, is used to generate file names like “Parade_20-30-00” for a file that was created at exactly 8:30 in the evening.

Time of day: This is like the previous option, but the time of importing the file is used.

The Import Filename Configuration window.

™

S

ELECTING MEDIA FOR IMPORT

Each source supported by the Import Wizard has its own appropriate set of controls for selecting the material. When you click the source name in the Import

From panel, the central area of the wizard configures itself appropriately with the controls you need.

Import from file-based media

Select Other devices in the Import From panel of the

Import Wizard to prepare for importing from file-based storage media other than local hard drives, including optical drives, memory cards and USB sticks.

The job of selecting the files to import belongs to the folder and media file browser in the central area of the display.

When importing from file-based media, the Import

Wizard provides a folder and file browser in the central area. This is flanked on the left by the Import

From and Import To panels, and on the right by the

Mode and Filename panels. The Start Import button at bottom right sets things in motion after the desired media files have been selected.

A single import operation can take in multiple types of media file from multiple source folders. Each selected file will be copied to the correct folder for its media type (as specified in the Import To panel).

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 35

The folder and media file browser

The left hand column of the browser is a hierarchical view of all folders on all filestorage devices attached to your computer. These devices include hard drives, optical disc drives, memory cards and USB sticks.

Navigation in this “folder tree” is similar to that in

Windows Explorer and other programs. Folders containing other folders are indicated by a plus sign to the left of the name when they are closed and by a minus sign when they are open. Click the sign to open out (“expand”) or close down (“collapse”) a folder’s list of subfolders.

Only one entry in the folder tree can be highlighted at a time. Any media files contained in that folder are immediately listed in the larger, right-hand division of the browser. You can preview files on the spot, and earmark those you intend to import by checking the box at the top right of corner of each file icon.

Previewing media files

Previewing audio and video: The media file browser includes built-in previewing for all supported media types. Click the play button in the center of video and audio file icons to preview the media they represent. For

quick viewing, video files play back within the icon frame itself. Click anywhere on the icon to halt playback; otherwise the entire file is previewed.

Here, the folder video\current is open, revealing eight video files. To select (or unselect) a file for import, click the checkbox in the top right corner of its icon. In the illustration, three files have been selected.

Full-screen preview: During video playback, a full-screen viewing button is displayed at the top left of the file icon. This button works similarly to the Player’s full-screen preview button in Studio’s Edit mode (see page 8).

Full-screen previewing closes automatically at the end of the video. To close it manually, press the Esc key or double-click the display during preview.

To view a digital photos or other picture file at fullscreen resolution, double-click its icon.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 37

Scrub preview: Audio and video clips both provide a scrubber control immediately below the file icon. Click and drag the scrubber knob to manually review any part of the file.

The mouse pointer changes to a twoheaded horizontal arrow when it is correctly positioned for scrubbing.

Selecting media files for import

To select media files one at a time for importing, click the selection box at the top right corner of the file icon.

Click the selection box to check or uncheck the file.

Multiple selection: The browser also provides a method of selecting (or unselecting) simultaneously a group of highlighted files. To highlight an individual file, simply click on its name or its icon; the highlighted state is indicated by an orange border. To highlight additional files, click icons in conjunction with either of the Shift and Ctrl keys, as follows:

Click while pressing Ctrl to add or remove the highlighting from one file without affecting the others in the group.

• Click while pressing Shift highlights the clicked icon and all those between it and the previously clicked icon, inclusive. Highlighting is removed from any icons not within the range.

You can also highlight a range of icons directly with the mouse, by dragging out a rectangle that intersects the icons you want to include. Click the first icon and move to the last one before releasing the mouse button.

Having highlighted some icons you want to import, click the selection box of any one of them to select or unselect the entire group at once.

A group of four highlighted video file icons.

Selecting or unselecting any one will affect the whole group.

Select all and Unselect all : Click these buttons along the bottom of the media file browser to select for importing either all or none of the media files listed in the current folder. They do not affect any files currently selected in other folders.

Use the Select all button to select all the media files in the current folder.s

Each time a file is added to or removed from the list of those to be imported, the media browser updates the selection status indicator at the bottom of the display.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 39

Customizing the browser

Several controls allow you to configure the media file browser appropriately for your display hardware and requirements.

Close the folder tree: To maximize the space for viewing files, click the left-pointing double-arrow icon at the top of the folder tree scroll bar. This collapses the folder tree to a vertical bar down the left-hand side. At the top of the bar is the right-pointing double-arrow that will reopen the tree. The name of the current folder is also shown.

Filter the file list: Another way to optimize your use of the file area is to limit the files shown to include only one media type.

This is the function of the media filter dropdown at the bottom left of the browser. By default, all supported media file types appear in the browser, but you can limit the view to picture files, audio files or video files by your selection here. To see exactly which file types are included in a selection, hover on the item for a second or two to pop up the list.

Hovering over the Audio files option brings up a list of file types from which audio import is supported.

Set preview size: A final tool for managing screen real estate is the preview size slider at the bottom right of the browser.

Move the slider leftwards to reduce, or rightwards to increase, the size of the preview images in the file browser. There are three ways of moving this slider with the mouse:

• Click on the slider knob and drag to the left or right.

• Click beside the slider knob to nudge itin the appropriate direction.

• Click the minus/plus buttons at the ends of the slider scale to move the knob by a larger amount.

Set preview volume: To set the playback volume of audio and video clips for previewing, hover the mouse pointer in the area of the audio/mute button in the bottom bar of the media file browser. A volume slider will appear beside the button. Drag the knob up and down to control the volume. Click the audio/mute button itself to toggle audio muting.

Adjusting the import file date and time

The internal clocks of the recording devices are often set incorrectly, resulting in incorrectly timestamped media files. The Import Wizard can correct this kind of problem by setting the date and time of the imported files according to your specifications.

To correct the file time or date:

Use the more button on the “Selected Files” lines to open a window that offers two options for adjusting the timestamps:

• Correct time zone: This slider changes the file timestamp of any media files you import by up to 12

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 41

hours in either direction. You can use this adjustment to compensate for the time difference when you bring home video from your travels.

• Set date/time: These fields lets you enter an exact date and time of your choice. The file time of any media files you import will be changed to this.

Import from DV or HDV camera

To prepare for importing digital video, switch on your

DV or HDV device in play mode and select it in the

Import From panel of the

Import Wizard.

You will also need to make sure that your destination folder, compression presets, and other options are set up in the other panels the way you want them. (See

“Import Wizard panels”, page 19.)

Previewing video

The video currently playing on the source device should now be visible in the preview area at the central area of the display. Along the right edge of the video preview is a scale showing the moment-bymoment audio level. Above that scale, by the top right corner of the preview frame, is a small button that switches to full-screen previewing.

When a DV or HDV source is selected, the central area of the Import Wizard provides controls for previewing and importing the taped material.

Below the preview image is a row of controls for automating capture by setting mark-in and mark-out points. See “Recording video and audio” on page 45 for more information.

Another row of controls, the transport bar , serves as your navigation console for the source device.

The transport bar for DV and HDV import, with

(from left) jog controls and timecode readout, transport buttons, a shuttle control, and an audio button with a pop-out slider for controlling the preview volume.

The current timecode indicator shows your playback position according to the timecode recorded onto the tape when

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 43

it was shot. The four fields represent hours, minutes, seconds and frames respectively. To the left of the indicator is a pair of arrow buttons; use these to jog the position one frame back or frame forward at a time.

From left to right, the transport buttons are play / pause , stop , rewind and fast forward . These buttons relay commands to your camera. Using them is equivalent to using the camera’s onboard controls, but typically more convenient.

Drag the orange needle on the shuttle control to the left or right to change the playback position in the reverse and forward directions respectively. The motor speed increases as you drag the needle further off center. When you release the needle, it homes to the center position and pauses playback.

Set preview volume: To set the playback volume for previewing, hover the mouse pointer in the area of the audio/mute button in the bottom bar of the media file browser. A volume slider will appear beside the button. Drag the knob up and down to control the volume. Click the audio/mute button itself to toggle audio muting.

Mark-In/Out: Mark In and Mark Out indicate the planned starting point and ending point of a video capture. See page 45 for further information.

Note: DV and HDV sources are also suitable for snapshots; see page 52 for details.

Recording video and audio

The Import Wizard supports two approaches to selecting a range of video to be imported.

In the manual approach, you simply watch the preview playback and press Start Capture at the start of the desired footage. When you reach the end of the segment, press Stop Capture . If you have continuous timecode on the source footage, and have set Stop at tape end to “Yes” in the Mode panel, you can walk away and leave the Import Wizard to switch off when the input is exhausted.

The automatic method of capture is good for setting the endpoints of your capture (the “mark-in” and “markout”) points with single-frame precision, and for unattended importing that should halt before the end of the recorded material.

Sometimes you may want to use set the mark-in time and leave mark-out blank. When you click Start

Capture the Import Wizard will locate your start time then capture until you tell it to stop (or at tape end).

You can also set a mark-out time and leave the mark-in time blank. When you click Start Capture import will begin immediately, and end automatically at the markout point. Entering a duration and entering a mark-out time are equivalent. Whichever you specify, the Import

Wizard calculates and displays the other one automatically.

Note: Before starting the import operation, verify that the settings on the Import To panel and other panels

(see page 19) have been configured correctly.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 45

To capture manually with the Start Capture and

Stop Capture buttons:

1.

Make sure that the mark-in and mark-out points are not set. If needed, use the

button associated with the field to clear it with one click.

2.

Manually start playback of the source tape before the desired starting point of the capture.

3.

Click the Start Capture button when the starting point is reached.

The button caption changes to Stop Capture .

4.

At the end of the segment click the button again.

The captured material is stored in the Album.

5.

Manually halt playback (unless automatic shutoff is in effect as noted above).

To capture automatically by setting mark-in and mark-out points:

1.

Use the time counter controls to set the mark-in and mark out values – the start and end points of the desired footage.

To set the mark-in point, either enter a value directly into the start field, or navigate to the desired point and click the Start button. A similar approach can be used to set the mark-out point.

2.

Click Start Capture . Studio positions the source device to the mark-in point and automatically begins recording.

3.

When the mark-out point is reached, import is terminated and the source device is stopped.

4.

The captured material is stored in the Album.

Import from analog sources

To record analog video (e.g. VHS or Hi8) you need a converter that you can connect to your computer and that has the appropriate video and audio connections.

This is also the case when recording from analog sound sources, such as a record player.

Currently supported devices include Pinnacle and

Dazzle products such as USB 500/510, USB 700/710 and DVC 100, and webcams based on DirectShow technology.

To prepare for importing from an analog source, switch on the device and select it by name in the Import From panel of the Import Wizard.

Also choose the applicable input (e.g. “Video

Composite” or “Video

SVideo”). If you wish to tweak the incoming analog signal prior to digitization, click the more button , which provides access to the

Analog Input Levels window. (See page 21 for more information.)

Before starting the capture, make sure that your destination folder, compression presets, and other options are set up in the other panels the way you want them. (See “Import Wizard panels”, page 19.)

To capture from an analog source:

1.

Verify that the correct input is connected (e.g.

“Video S-Video”).

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 47

2.

3.

4.

5.

Start the playback device just before the point at which you would like capture to begin.

Video and audio previewing should now be active.

(If not, check cabling and converter installation.)

Click the Start Capture button to start recording.

The button caption changes to Stop Capture .

At the end of the segment click the button again.

The captured material is stored in the Album.

Halt the source device.

Import from DVD or Blu-ray Disc

The Import Wizard can import video and audio data from

DVDs and BDs (Blu-ray discs). To begin, insert the source disc in its drive and select it in the Import From panel of the Import Wizard. If you have more than one optical drive, choose the correct device among those listed.

Before starting the capture, make sure that your destination folder and file name are set up in the other panels the way you want them. (See “Import Wizard panels”, page 19.)

Because large files can be involved when importing from optical discs, selecting the correct import directory is important. In particular, ensure that the designated storage location has sufficient space available (see page 23).

Note: Copy-protected media cannot be imported.

Previewing the disc files

The media on optical discs are accessed through the computer’s file system. For this reason, the previewing controls in the central area, the methods for selecting files, and the procedure for importing, are the same as for ordinary file-based media (except that the unneeded folder view starts in the closed position). Please see page 35 for further information.

Import from digital cameras

Like optical disc drives, the media on digital cameras is accessed through the computer’s file system. The camera may appear on the source list as a removable disk drive. Previewing, selecting and importing are the same as for ordinary file-based media (except that the folder view starts in the closed position). Please see page 35 for further information.

Stop motion

The Stop Motion function of the Import Wizard allows you to create animated films by stitching together individual frames grabbed from a live video source, such as an analog video camera or webcam. The result of your Stop Motion import will be either a movie at 8

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 49

or 12 frames per second, the collection of still images you grabbed, or both, depending on your Mode panel settings.

To prepare for Stop Motion import, make sure the source device is switched on, then select it by name under the

Stop Motion heading in the

Import From panel of the

Import Wizard. (See page 21 for more information.)

Before starting the capture, make sure that your destination folder, options and file name are set up in the other panels the way you want them. (See “Import

Wizard panels”, page 19.)

If your source equipment is functioning correctly, you should have a live preview in the central area of the Import Wizard window. For a full-screen preview, click the button at the top right of the embedded preview. To terminate the full-screen mode, press Esc or click the close button at the top right of the screen.

When you are ready to capture an image, click the Capture Frame button. A thumbnail of the grabbed frame is added to the Image Tray at the bottom of the window. (See “Using the Image Tray” on page 54 for more information.)

Since this is a stop motion sequence, after each image is grabbed you will generally make small changes to the scene you are shooting in order to create the illusion of motion from frame to frame.

To make your task of visualization easier, the Stop

Motion preview includes an “onion skin” effect,

whereby successive frames are shown simultaneously in translucent layers so that the differences can be clearly seen. This feature can be configured on the control bar.

The number of images shot so far and the duration of the film (based on the number of images, rounded off) are displayed to the right below the control bar.

The Stop Motion control bar

This bar provides transport and other functions for Stop

Motion import.

From left to right:

Live and File indicators: These let you switch between previewing the live video feed and previewing the captured frames in the Image Tray.

You can review – and if necessary replace – particular frames without having to undo other work.

Counter: This readout shows your current position within the animation in hour, minutes, seconds and frames. The counter value depends on the number of frames you have grabbed and the animation speed in frames per second. The up and down arrow buttons to the left of the counter provide single stepping when previewing your animation.

• Navigation buttons: These buttons are for previewing your animation. A loop button lets you cycle the animation continuously for easy checking.

Frame rate: This rate, in frames per second, determines how many frames you will have to create in order to amass one second of movie time. This rate influences the apparent speed of the animation.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 51

• Onion skin settings: Click the more button to open a small window where the onion skin feature can be configured. The first slider shows the difference in transparency between successive frames, while the second controls the number of frames, in addition to the current one, that will take part in the effect. Experiment with both settings until you find the levels that work best for your movie.

Importing the animation

When you have added all the frames you want to the animation, click the Start Import button. The Import

Wizard adds your animated movie, and/or the individual frames you captured, to the appropriate sections of the Studio Album.

Snapshot

The Snapshot function of the

Import Wizard is used to record individual frames (still images) from cameras or players connected to the system. To prepare, make sure the source device is switched on, then select it by name under the Snapshot heading in the Import From panel of the Import Wizard. (See page

21 for more information.)

Before starting the capture, make sure that your destination folder and file name are set up in the other panels the way you want them. (See “Import Wizard panels”, page 19.)

Now start your camera, or roll your tape, and start monitoring the embedded preview display in the central area of the Import Wizard window.

For a full-screen preview, click the button at the top right of the embedded preview. To terminate the full-screen mode, press Esc or click close at the top right of the screen.

Capturing snapshots in the Import Wizard. While previewing live or taped video in the central area of the window, use the Capture Frame button to grab still images. Grabbed frames accumulate in the

Image Tray at the bottom of the window until you click the Start Import button to transfer them to the

Studio Album.

When you want to capture an image as it goes by, click the

Capture Frame button. A

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 53

thumbnail of the grabbed frame is added to the Image

Tray at the bottom of the window.

Capture as many additional frames as are required. The

Import Wizard adds each one in turn to the collection growing in the Image Tray. In the course of capturing, you can change tapes, re-aim your camera, and so on as you see fit. The source video doesn’t need to be uninterrupted as long as there is signal present when you actually click the Capture Frame button.

Using the Image Tray

For on-the-spot review of a frame you have already grabbed, click the thumbnail of any but the most recent frame in the Image Tray. This switches the preview display from the video source to the captured file, and activates the File indicator. You can also activate the indicator by clicking it directly.

Click the File indicator or any thumbnail in the

Image Tray to review images already grabbed. Here, thumbnail 3 has been clicked, and the mouse is poised over the trashcan icon to delete it. The heavy line to the right of the selected thumbnail indicates where the next grabbed frame would be inserted.

To delete a captured frame, select it in the Image Tray, then click the trashcan icon that appears in the top right corner of the thumbnail.

To switch back to previewing video after reviewing files in the Image Tray, click the Live indicator beneath the preview display.

Importing the frames

When you have grabbed all the frames you want from the video source, click the Start Import button. The

Import Wizard adds the grabbed images to the still images section of the Studio Album.

Chapter 2: Capturing and importing media 55

CHAPTER 3:

The Album

The Videos section of the Album in Scenes mode. The icons shown here represent the scenes within a particular movie file. Controls are provided (top) for accessing other movie files anywhere on your system.

Click the tabs down the left side of the Album to access the materials in the other sections.

With the current explosion of digital media technologies, it is easier now than ever before to obtain high-quality media items and incorporate them in your productions.

Many types of media and resource can serve as ingredients in Studio movies in addition to just video.

Starting with visual elements, you can include digital photographs and art, fancy titles and animated transitions. As for audio, you can spice up, or even

Chapter 3: The Album 57

replace, the source video’s own soundtrack with music, sound effects and voice-overs.

Then there are the special items. For a DVD disc you will want to include attractive navigation menus, while for polish and pizzazz in any production you can turn to

Studio’s Montage

®

theme templates, which let you recombine other resources into dynamic and creative video layouts.

Your Studio software installation already includes an extensive collection of professionally-authored resources, and numerous bonus packs are available as well. Further afield there are practically limitless possibilities for using all kinds of additional media, whether of your own creation or from other sources.

Managing your media

Keeping track of this abundance of riches could easily become a challenging task in itself, but Studio provides two key management tools that let you navigate and access your media assets with ease.

The Album provides intelligent browsing of your entire media collection. It lets you quickly locate and preview any desired item, then introduce it into your production simply by dragging its icon into the Movie Window.

All your projects share and make use of the Album, which is a permanent feature of Studio’s Edit mode.

The Project Bin is a special version of the Album dedicated to handling the resources needed by the current project. Media items you add to your movie, are included in the Bin automatically, but you can also add items directly so that they will be handy later on. The

Bin lets you collect and file all the materials you need for a production, and keep them at your fingertips

throughout the editing process, ready to use whenever your project is loaded.

In this chapter we first cover the Album proper, but most of the concepts and operations described apply equally to the Bin, which is described beginning on page 86.

Accessing Album media

The source materials you need for making a movie are stored in the various sections of the Album, each of which is accessed by its own tab as follows:

Video: This section contains video footage you have shot or otherwise obtained. The supported video file formats are: avi , mpg , mpeg , mod , mp2 , mp4 , m2ts , mt2 , m2t , tod , m1v , m2v , mpv , 3gp , wmv , mov and skm . You can access and preview files directly, or you can open an individual file to access its contained scenes, which are represented by thumbnail icons. To use some of the scenes in your movie, just drag their icons into the Movie Window. See “The

Videos section”, page 63.

Transitions: This Album section contains fades, dissolves, slides, and other transition types, including the elaborate Hollywood FX transitions. To use a transition, position it next to or between video clips and graphics in the Movie Window. See “The

Transitions section”, page 78.

Montage

®

Themes: A Theme in Studio is a set of matching templates. You can use the templates to create effective sequences that combine your video and still images with built-in animations

® and effects. See “The Montage Themes section”, page

80.

Chapter 3: The Album 59

Titles: This section contains editable titles, which you can use as overlays or as full-screen graphics. You can create your own titles from scratch, or use or adapt the supplied ones. Studio supports rolls, crawls, animated motions, and many typographical effects. See “The Titles section”, page 81.

Photos and Frame Grabs: This is a section of photographs, bitmaps and grabbed video frames.

You can use these images full-screen or as overlays on the main video. Most standard image file formats are supported: bmp , dtl , gif , jpg , jpeg , pcx , png , psd , tga , tif and wmf . See “The Photos and Frame Grabs section”, page 82.

Disc Menus: Studio has an extensive collection of chapter menus to use in DVD, VCD and

S-VCD authoring. You can use these as they are, modify them, or create your own. See “The Disc

Menus section”, page 83.

Sound Effects: Studio comes ready with a wide range of high-quality sound effects. You can also use files that you have recorded yourself or obtained from other sources. The formats supported are: wav , mp3 , mpa , m4a , wma , avi and ac3 . See “The Sound

Effects section”, page 84.

Music: In this Album section you can locate and use music files stored on your hard drive. The formats supported are the same as those for sound effects. See “The Music section”, page 85.

Using the Album

A dropdown list of folders is displayed in all Album sections. In some, like the Photos and Frame Grabs section, where the folders represent actual directories

on your hard drive, additional navigation controls are also provided.

A dropdown list of folders in the Photos and Frame

Grabs section. Here the current folder contains both image files and subfolders, one of which has been designated a ‘favorite’ (starred). Favorite folders can be quickly retrieved by clicking My Favorite

Folders in the list.

The resources in each folder are represented by icons.

If there are more than will fit the display, a scroll bar provides access to the rest. At the top right of each

Album page, Studio shows the total number of items in the folder, and the range that is currently visible.

The readout above the scroll bar shows that the first

18 of 19 icons are currently on display.

All types of Album content can be previewed simply by clicking on the icons.

Chapter 3: The Album 61

This chapter introduces each of the Album sections in turn, beginning with a detailed discussion of the allimportant Videos section. Actually using the contents of the Album to create your edited movie will be the subject of chapters 4 through 15.

Source folders for Album content

Most Album sections contain ordinary media files of various types, but there are three exceptions. The scene icons in the Scenes mode of the Videos section represent segments within a particular video file, while the icons in the Transitions and Themes sections represent special resources associated with the Studio program.

The other five sections, however, and the Files mode of the Videos section, present the files contained in some particular disk folder.

The icons in the Titles section represent files stored in a selected source folder on your hard drive. The dropdown list at the top of the Album page lets you select from any of several installed folders of titles.

The folder button beside the list lets you access titles in folders other than those listed if required. The

Disc Menus section works similarly.

The source folder for each section’s content is listed in the dropdown list at the top left of the Album, next to a

small folder button . To change the source of the current section, either select a folder from the dropdown list, or click the button, browse to another folder on your system, and select any file. The file you select will be highlighted in the repopulated Album section.

Some Album sections also provide a parent folder button to facilitate moving around within a group of folders containing media of the same type.

File-based media in the Album provide a context menu command, Open Containing Folder , that opens a

Windows Explorer window with the given file selected.

™

T

HE

V

IDEOS SECTION

This is where the editing process really begins – in the Videos section of the Album with your captured raw footage and other video source materials.

In a typical production, your first step will probably be to drag some scenes from the Album down into the

Movie Window (see Chapter 5: Video Clips ).

In the Album, scenes are displayed in the order in which they occur in the video. This order cannot be changed, since it is determined by the underlying file, but scenes can be added to your movie in any order you choose. Similarly, while you can’t trim (edit) Album scenes themselves, you can use any desired portion of a scene when it appears as a clip in your movie.

Chapter 3: The Album 63

Files mode and Scenes mode

Choosing a particular video scene to use in a movie is a two-step process. First, you must select the video file containing the required scene by browsing for it on a storage device – usually a hard drive – attached to your system. Second, you choose the scene you want from amongst those the selected file contains.

To browse for a video file in the Videos section of the

Album, select the Files radio button.

Browse folders and video files on your computer by selecting Files mode in the Videos section of the

Album. Double-click a video file or select the Scenes radio button to switch into Scenes mode.

View options

Both the Files and Scenes modes support multiple view options that let you tailor the display to your needs by showing more or less information about each Album item.

Studio provides several methods of accessing these view options:

• Through commands on the View menu.

• Through the Album’s right-button context menu.

Through the pop-up menu button that appears when you click the View button.

In Files mode, the Videos section supports three views at varying levels of detail: n

Icon view, o

Details view and p

Thumbnail view.

The two view options available in Scenes mode are: n

Thumbnail view and o

Comment view.

Interface features

The Videos section offers several special interface features:

Scenes that have been added to the Movie Window are distinguished in the Album by a checkmark in the top right corner of the scene icon. The checkmark remains as long as any clip in the Movie Window originates with that scene. A colored background square in the same corner of the icon indicates that it has been explicitly added to the Project Bin. Both indicators can occur together (see below).

Chapter 3: The Album 65

To see how a particular Album scene is used in your current project, use the Album

¾

Find Scene in

Project menu command. Studio highlights any clips in the Movie Window that originate in the selected scene (or scenes). To go the other way, use the Find

Scene in Album command, which is on the rightclick menu for Movie Window clips.

The symbol in the top-right corner of an icon in the

Album or the Project Bin reveals its status: n unused (no symbol); o

used in project; p

added to

Bin; q

both used in project and added to Bin.

Nearly all menu commands that apply to scenes are available both on the main Album menu, and on the pop-up menu that appears when you right-click a selected scene. When this documentation calls for a menu command like Album

¾

Combine Scenes , remember that an equivalent command is usually available on the pop-up “context” menu as well. Many commands are also available in the Project Bin.

Summary of operations

Because of its central role, the Videos section of the

Album provides an extensive set of operations. These are covered below in the following topics:

Opening a video file

Viewing video

Selecting scenes and files

Displaying scene and file information

Comment view

Combining and subdividing scenes

Redetecting scenes

Opening a video file

The default locations for your video files are the

Windows public video folder and the matching folder in your user account. When you are viewing the Videos section in Files mode, both of these locations always appear on the dropdown list at the top of the Album.

You can also choose other hard drive folders to access stored video files. Studio lets you navigate to the folder where your files are located by clicking the icons in the

Files mode. You can also select a file directly by clicking the Browse for file button in either Files or

Scenes mode. Both the current and previous folders are also listed, if they are different from the two standard locations, making four different folders that may appear in the list at any one time.

The final entry on the dropdown list is “My Favorite

Folders”. If you are working with several different video folders, Studio’s “favorites” feature makes navigation easy. To designate any folder a favorite, use the right-button menu command Set as Favorite folder .

Favorite folders are displayed with a star graphic in the

Album. To return to a favorite, select “My Favorite

Folders”, then the particular folder you have in mind.

Selecting ‘My Favorite Folders’. The folder at right has been designated a favorite, as shown by the star.

See “The Videos Section” (page 63) for details about modes and view options when working with video scenes in the Album.

Chapter 3: The Album 67

Opening a folder

Folder contents are displayed in Files mode. Both the subfolders and the digital video files within the current folder are shown.

Three ways to open a folder:

• With the Videos section in Files mode, select the folder name on the dropdown list, or double-click any listed folder.

Click the parent folder button in either Files or

Scenes mode.

Click the browse for file button and use the Open dialog to locate a digital video file in either Files or

Scenes mode. When Studio opens the video file, switch to Files mode to display the contents of its parent folder.

Opening a file

When you open a video file, icons are displayed that represent the scenes in the file:

Three ways to open a digital video file:

• Select the file name on the dropdown list when the

Videos section is in Scenes mode.

Double-click a file listed in Files mode.

Click the browse for file button and use the Open dialog to locate a digital video file of any supported type on your hard drive.

Scene detection and thumbnails

When you open a video file, the Album fills with the file’s detected scenes. Each scene is denoted by a thumbnail frame – an icon of the scene’s first frame. It may be that the first frame doesn’t make a good icon for the scene, so Studio lets you pick a different one if desired.

To change thumbnails in the Album:

1.

Select the scene to be changed.

2.

3.

Use the Player to find the frame you want used for the thumbnail.

Click the Album

¾

Set Thumbnail menu command.

Video aspect ratios

Most digital video files provide format information that allows Studio to detect the frame aspect ratio of 4:3 or

16:9 automatically. If the file does not provide aspect ratio information, Studio defaults to the standard 4:3 format.

The Aspect Ratio 4:3 and Aspect Ratio 16:9 commands on the Album menu let you manually set whichever

Chapter 3: The Album 69

ratio you need. These commands also appear on the right-button context menu for video in the Album.

Their method of operation is to stretch the original frames to the new frame size. If you set the ratio of a

4:3 movie to 16:9, for example, people and objects will appear widened relative to their height.

This is different from the frame-size conversion that occurs when you add a scene to a movie project with the “opposite” aspect ratio. In that case, the scene is scaled in both dimensions equally to fit within the target frame, and excess area appears as black.

The Aspect Ratio commands become available after the

Studio has opened the file for the first time and indexed its scenes. Until then the menu items are disabled.

(L) Original 4:3 frame; (C) Same frame with black sidebars on adding to 16:9 project; (R) Same frame after Aspect ratio 16:9 command is used. Aspect ratio mismatches can also be handled in the Movie

Window with the context menu commands ‘Show full picture’ and ‘Zoom picture to fill frame’.

Note: The movie project’s frame format, which cannot be changed after the project is created, can be set for new projects in the Project preferences options panel.

See page 352 for more information.

Viewing video

Individual or multiple scenes in an open video file can be viewed at any time.

To view video starting at a selected scene:

1.

Click on the scene’s icon in the Album.

The Player displays the first frame of the selected scene.

2.

Click the Play button in the Player.

The Player now plays the selected scenes and any subsequent ones. Progress is indicated in three ways.

• The scenes highlight successively as they are played.

• The Player scrubber shows the current point of play relative to the entire movie.

• Scene thumbnails display a progress bar during preview. As you continue to view your captured video, the progress bar moves from one thumbnail to the next.

Chapter 3: The Album 71

Previewing digital video files

When a video file is selected in Files mode, you can use the Player to preview the video without actually opening the file into Scenes mode.

Selecting scenes and files

Studio offers a variety of ways to select scenes, files and folders in the Videos section of the Album.

Selected video scenes are indicated by a highlighted border. Selected folders and video files are shown with text highlighting.

Selected scenes have a highlighted border (center).

Selection techniques follow standard Windows conventions. Use any of the following, separately or in combination:

• Choose the Edit

¾

Select All menu command or press Ctrl+A to select all the scenes (or files and folders) currently displaying in the Album, including those on other pages.

Shift-click to select a range of neighboring items.

• Ctrl-click to add or remove individual items from the selection.

• Starting with the mouse pointer over a blank area of the Album page, click and drag to “marquee” an area, selecting all the items that intersect the area.

• Use the arrow keys to navigate the Album grid. Use the arrows in combination with Shift to select items as you go.

Selected folders and video files have highlighted text.

Note the star on the folder ‘2008’, indicating that it has been designated a favorite.

Displaying scene and file information

As you move the mouse pointer over video scenes, the pointer changes to a grabber symbol. If you pause momentarily on the scene, the start time and length is displayed in a pop-up box.

If you leave the grabber on the scene, the display persists for several seconds. The start time shown is the timecode from the original source video, in minutes, seconds, and frames.

Chapter 3: The Album 73

For information regarding video files when the Videos section is in folder view mode, select

Details view in the Album’s right button context menu. The file name, resolution, aspect ratio, duration and frame rate are displayed.

Switch back to a more compact listing with Icon view .

Comment view

In the default view for the Scenes mode of the Videos section, known as Thumbnail view , each scene is represented by a thumbnail frame icon. To see more information about each scene, switch to Comment view using any of the methods described on page 64.

In comment view, editable captions are displayed for

Album scenes. The usage of these captions is up to you: they might be search keywords, or scene names, or text comments describing the scene content. The default caption is generated from the scene’s sequence number and duration (e.g. “Scene 3, 7:21”).

If you click on a video scene, an in-place text field lets you enter a custom name or comment.

Selecting scenes by name

A related option lets you select video scenes by scanning for keywords in the comments. Use Album

¾

Select By Name to open this dialog box:

Enter a keyword into the text field and click OK to highlight all Album scenes whose caption contains the keyword. The default captions are not searched – only the ones you have customized.

Combining and subdividing scenes

After previewing your scenes, you might want to combine or subdivide some into larger or smaller units.

Such adjustments are easily made.

To combine scenes in the Album:

1.

2.

Select the scenes to be combined.

Select Album

¾

Combine Scenes .

The selected scenes are combined into one.

Only selected adjacent scenes can be combined.

Furthermore, they are joined in the order in which

Chapter 3: The Album 75

they appear in the Album, regardless of the order in which they were selected. (Album order proceeds across rows and then down the page.) To revert, press Ctrl+Z, or click the undo button.

If the scenes you selected were not all neighbors, each set of adjacent scenes is combined, but the different sets are not combined with each other.

Several selected scenes (black) are merged into two longer scenes. Having no neighbors, scene 4 is unaffected, even though it was part of the selection.

To subdivide scenes in the Album:

1.

2.

Select the scenes to be subdivided.

Select Album

¾

Subdivide Scenes .

The Subdivide Selected Scenes dialog box appears.

3.

Choose the length of the subdivided scenes by typing in a value.

The smallest allowed subdivision is one second.

Any video remaining after subdivision is added to the last scene.

4.

Click OK .

A progress bar appears, the scene is subdivided, and new scenes are added to the Album. To revert, press Ctrl+Z, or click the undo button.

You can subdivide these scenes still further, if desired, down to the minimum duration of one second.

Three selected scenes are subdivided to a duration of five seconds. The vertical stripes indicate fivesecond divisions within each scene. The uneven clip timings at right occur because time left after subdivision is added to the final divided scene; that is also why scene 2 is ultimately unaffected by the subdivision operation.

Redetecting scenes

If you combine or subdivide scenes and later decide that you’d prefer to restore them to their original state, you may redetect any scene or selection of scenes. The detection results are identical to those originally obtained, provided the same scene detection technique is used.

If you have subdivided scenes, you must first recombine them. Even if you cannot exactly recall the

Chapter 3: The Album 77

initial state and so recombine more than is necessary, the detection process will restore the original scene sequence.

To redetect scenes:

1.

2.

3.

If you need to recombine any scenes, first select the subdivided scenes, then apply the Album

¾

Combine Scenes menu command.

Select the scenes you wish to redetect.

From the Album menu, select either Detect Scenes by Video Content or Detect Scenes by Shooting

Time and Date .

A progress window appears as Studio detects the scenes and repopulates the Album.

™

T

HE

T

RANSITIONS SECTION

The Transitions section of the Album provides a large set of drag-and-drop clip transitions. To keep things manageable, the transitions are divided into groups. Use the dropdown list to select which group of transitions you want to view.

To learn about transitions, and how you can use them in your movies, see Chapter 9:

Transitions .

Studio’s transitions collection includes 74 standard transitions, over 100 Alpha

Magic transitions, and a starting set of unrestricted

Hollywood FX 3-D transitions.

Obtaining more transitions

Besides those installed with Studio, additional packs of

Hollywood FX transitions are available for purchase through the Pinnacle web-site.

For more information about purchasing premium content for Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

Displaying the transition name

As you move the mouse pointer over the transition icons in the Album, the pointer changes to a grabber symbol (indicating that the transition can be dragged from the Album to the Movie Window). If you pause momentarily on the icon, the name of the transition is displayed. The display persists for several seconds or until your mouse pointer moves off the transition.

Previewing transition effects

When you click on a transition icon, the Player demonstrates the transition using the convention that

“A” represents the original clip and “B” the new clip.

The demonstration cycles for as long as the icon remains selected.

To see a detailed view, stop the Player and use the jog buttons ( Frame reverse and Frame forward ) to step through the transition one frame at a time.

Chapter 3: The Album 79

™

T

HE

M

ONTAGE

®

T

HEMES SECTION

Editing based on Montage

®

Themes is a powerful feature unique to Studio. Each theme consists of a set of matching templates. Use the dropdown list to select the Theme whose templates you want to view.

The templates available for each theme provide slots for your own video, photos, captions and settings. When you create a theme clip from the template (by dragging it to the Movie Window), the Theme Editor opens to accept your customizations. It can be reopened at any later time by double-clicking the clip.

Templates give you a fast, easy way to craft visually effective sequences that combine your own materials with built-in animations and effects.

For information on using themes in your movies, see

Chapter 6: Montage® themes and theme editing .

Obtaining more themes

Besides those installed with Studio, additional themes are available for purchase through the Pinnacle website. For more information about purchasing premium content for Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

™

T

HE

T

ITLES SECTION

This section of the Album contains a collection of text and graphic titles in a variety of styles.

They can be used in your movie as either full-screen or overlay titles. The difference is that in an overlay title the transparent background is replaced by other material (usually a video clip), whereas in a full-screen title, any transparent areas of the background are replaced with black.

Studio supports two title formats. Both allow you to combine decorative text with graphic shapes and images, but each has specialized properties, and its own editing tools.

Classic titles are primarily static, but allow simple animation in the form of text ‘crawls’ and ‘rolls’.

The Classic Title editor also supports advanced text formatting such as variable character and line spacing. Most importantly, the Classic Title editor can also be used for visual editing of disc menus.

Motion titles provide fewer special text operations, and cannot be used to edit disc menus. As the name suggests, however, these titles support a rich set of customizable animation routines, which can be applied to invidual elements – text or graphic – to produce dynamic visual compositions. The thumbnail versions of motion titles are distinguished by a special symbol in your project.

In the Album, a gray checkerboard is used to indicate the portion of a title that will be treated as transparent in overlays. (If you prefer a black background, use the Album

¾

Black

Chapter 3: The Album 81

background menu command.) As with video scenes, titles that have been added to your current project are indicated in the Album by a checkmark symbol.

With Studio’s built-in title editors, you can readily create your own titles when needed. However, you may find it easier still to start with one of the supplied titles, of either type, and customize it in the corresponding editor.

The Titles folder: The icons in the Titles section represent files in the folder named at the top left of the section. Each folder contains either classic or motion titles. The special folders “My Motion Titles” and “My

Classic Titles” provide default locations for storing titles that you have created or modified yourself. You can also select a different folder to be the source of the section (see “Source folders for Album content” on page 62).

For information on using titles in your movie, see

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor , and Chapter13:

The Motion Titler .

™

T

HE

S

TILL

I

MAGES SECTION

This section of the Album displays thumbnail icons of image files, which may include grabbed video frames, photographs and bitmapped drawings.

Most standard image file formats are supported. As with video scenes, images that are in use in your current movie are indicated by a checkmark symbol.

The Still Images folder: The icons in the Still Images section represent files in the folder named at the top left

of the section. Images can be added to the section by storing them in this folder. For instance, you can save grabbed video frames into the folder from the Frame grabber tool, copy images using the Import Wizard, or save your digital photos from a desktop photo-editing application. You can also select a different folder to be the source of the section (see “Source folders for

Album content” on page 62).

For information on using still images in your movie, see Chapter 10: Still images .

™

T

HE

D

ISC

M

ENUS SECTION

This section of the Album contains a collection of artist-designed menus for VCD, S-VCD and

DVD authoring. Menus in Studio are really specialized

“classic” titles: they can be created and edited in the

Classic Title Editor, and either saved from the editor into a disk folder or incorporated directly into your movie.

As with video scenes and other visual resources, disc menus that are in use in your movie are distinguished in the Album by a checkmark symbol.

For information on using disc menus in your movie, see Chapter 11: Disc menus .

The Disc Menus folder: The icons in the Disc Menus section represent files in the folder named at the top left of the section. Menus can be added to the section by storing them in this folder. You can also select a

Chapter 3: The Album 83

different folder to be the source of the section (see

“Source folders for Album content” on page 62).

The motion background symbol: Some of the menus supplied with Studio incorporate a background of moving video rather than a static picture, and you can also create such menus yourself. This “motion background” can help give a professional look to your finished disc.

Availability: The motion background feature is available in Studio Ultimate only. See “Adding a motion background” on page 252 for information on creating or editing a moving video background.

Menus with motion backgrounds are indicated by a small symbol in the bottom right-hand corner of the

Album icon.

Obtaining additional disc menus

Besides those installed with Studio, additional disc menus are available for purchase through the Pinnacle web-site. For more information about purchasing premium content for Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

™

T

HE

S

OUND

E

FFECTS SECTION

Studio comes with a wide range of ready-to-use sound effects. These wav files are installed into a number of folders, covering categories such as

“animals”, “bells” and “cartoons”.

The Sound Effects folder: This section of the Album displays the sound files contained in one disk folder, named at the top left of the section. You can display the sounds in a different folder – not necessarily one of those installed by Studio – by selecting that folder to be the source for the section (see “Source folders for

Album content” on page 62).

Besides wav (Windows “wave”) files, files in mp3 format, avi animation files, and other types are also displayed in this section of the Album, and may be drawn upon for supplemental audio in your productions.

Any sound clip can be previewed simply by clicking its name or icon.

For information on using sounds in your movie, see

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music .

Obtaining more sound effects

Besides those installed with Studio, additional sound effects are available for purchase through the Pinnacle web-site.

For more information about purchasing premium content for Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

™

T

HE

M

USIC SECTION

This section of the Album displays the music files in a folder on your hard drive. To use a file drag it onto the Music track or another audio track on the Movie Window Timeline.

Chapter 3: The Album 85

The Music folder: The wav , mp3 and other audio files come from the folder named at the top left of the section. Other music files can be added to the section by storing them in this folder. You can also select a different folder to be the source of the section (see

“Source folders for Album content” on page 62).

For information on using background music in your movie, see Chapter 14: Sound effects and music .

™

T

HE

P

ROJECT

B

IN

When you begin working with the Project Bin, you will notice a strong family resemblance between it and the

Album. The essential differences between the two are the scope and source of their collections. Whereas the

Album is a central library of available resources, the

Bin contains only those items that either already belong to the current project or that you have specifically earmarked for possible inclusion. It therefore does not need or have the Album’s system of source folders and file navigation. However, it is still possible to introduce material from the file system directly into the Bin by drag-and-drop, as described below.

The button to the left of the project name opens the Bin.

An empty Bin is automatically created for each project, and its contents are loaded and saved along with the project thereafter. To open the Bin and inspect its

contents, click the folder button near the left end of the

Movie Window title bar, or use the Toolbox

¾

Show

Project Bin menu command.

While open, the Project Bin appears as a panel in the screen area usually allotted to the Album. A single tab on the left side bears a folder icon identifying the panel as the Bin, while tabs along the top provide access to your project’s resources in four groups:

• Videos: Like the corresponding section of the

Album, this tab can house video files of all kinds, and allows previewing and selecting material in both file and scene views.

Photos: Again like the Album section, this tab is for your bitmapped image files, including digital photos and frame grabs.

• Audio: All types of music and sound files can be stored here.

The Videos section of the Project Bin presents an almost identical interface to that of the same section of the Album, lacking only the folder navigation controls. The checkbox at top left, ‘Show timeline media/content’, allows you to temporarily hide items that are already in use by your project.

Chapter 3: The Album 87

Other: This tab is for miscellaneous resources – classic titles, motion titles, disc menus and Montage

® themes.

Adding to the Bin

As noted above, every time you add content items to your project, the items are also added to the Bin for further use. You can also add items directly to the Bin only, leaving for later their possible inclusion in the project. If you like to begin your projects with a

“gathering” phase in which you assemble the needed materials prior to editing, the Bin can significantly streamline this task.

When new items are added, they are automatically sorted into the appropriate Bin sections, and will be available the next time the Bin is opened.

The items in the Bin are not new copies of the media files concerned, but simply references to existing files, so you can add as many as you like without worrying about using excessive amounts of storage. If the actual files corresponding to a Bin item is deleted or moved from its location, it will no longer be available in the

Bin either.

To add one or more selected items to the Bin, use any of these methods:

• Drag items from the Album onto the Bin button. A standard drag-and-drop mouse pointer confirms the operation.

Drag media items from Windows Explorer and similar applications onto either the Bin button, or the

Bin itself if it is open. All media types supported by

Studio are allowed, and will be appropriately classified.

• Select the context menu command Add to Bin or Pin to Bin on any Album item. “Pinning” applies only to items that are already part of your movie project. An item that is “pinned” to the Bin will not be removed from there even if you delete it from the project.

Once an item is in the Bin, you can use the same techniques for adding it to your project as you would from the Album, by dragging the icon to the Movie

Window, or right-clicking and selecting Add to project from the context menu.

A symbol in the top-right corner of an Album or Bin icon shows both whether the item is currently used in the project, and whether it has been explicitly added to the Bin. See page 65 for details.

Removing from the Bin

As just noted, there is a distinction between items that are added automatically to the Bin only because they are used in your current movie project, and those that you have added explicitly. “Pinned” items are those for which both conditions are true.

To remove an automatically-added item, delete it from the project.

To remove an item not in the project, click the

Remove from Project Bin command on the item’s context menu in either the Album or the Bin.

To remove a pinned item, click the Unpin from

Project Bin command on the item’s context menu in either the Album or the Bin, and also delete the item from the project.

Chapter 3: The Album 89

CHAPTER 4:

The Movie Window

The Movie Window, where you build your movie from the raw materials in the Album, occupies the bottom half of the screen in Studio’s Edit mode. To access the

Movie Window, first switch to Edit mode if you are not already there:

The Movie Window title bar contains several important controls and displays. The toolbox buttons at the left of the title bar open the Video toolbox and the Audio toolbox, which are discussed on page 102.

Next to the toolbox buttons is the button for the Project

Bin, represented by a folder icon. This button also serves as a target for material dragged to the Bin from the Album and from Windows Explorer. See “The

Project Bin” on page 86 for details.

To the right of the Bin button is a text area where the project file name is displayed. Status and warning messages are also displayed in this area when required.

The next controls relate to clip markers , which are like bookmarks attached to clips in your project. In a new project, the only visible clip marker control is the Add

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 91

Marker button. When you add your first marker, more controls appear.

The Add Marker button (top) creates a new clip marker at the Timeline scrubber position. After you add a marker to your project, controls for naming and selecting them become visible (bottom). See

“Clip markers” on page 99 for full information.

Further still to the right are the Audio scrubbing , Clip split and Clip delete buttons, then three view selection buttons (see “Movie Window views” on page 95), and finally a compact version of the Volume and balance tool’s output level meter (see page 316).

Audio scrubbing button

By default, your project’s audio is previewed during playback only. Studio’s audio scrubbing feature, which is turned on and off by the loudspeaker button, provides audio preview when you are scrubbing through your movie as well.

Audio scrubbing makes life much easier when making editing decisions that depend on sound cues.

Split clip/scene button – the razorblade

Click this button to split the currently-selected clip in the Movie Window, or the currentlyselected scene in the Album.

No information is lost. If the item is an Album scene, it is split at the indicated point into two shorter scenes. If the item is a clip in the Movie Window, it is duplicated and automatically trimmed to the split point.

The razorblade button can be used in conjunction with the track-locking buttons in the Movie Window’s

Timeline view to carry out special operations such as insert editing, and edits in which the audio leads or lags behind the video. See “Advanced Timeline editing” on page 126.

Splitting a clip: The placement of the edit line in the original clip determines the split point. When you apply the razorblade tool, Studio duplicates the clip and trims away the portion after the split point in the first copy and up to the split point in the second.

Delete Clip button – the trashcan

This button deletes the currently-selected content in any of the Movie Window views. By default, when video clips on the main video track of

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 93

your project are deleted in any view, the gap in your movie that would otherwise be created by the deletion is automatically closed up, and clips on other tracks are removed or shortened as required to keep everything in sync.

If you delete clips on other tracks, the default behavior is that gaps between them are not automatically removed, so the timing of other clips is not affected.

If you press the Ctrl key while clicking the delete button, or pressing the Delete key, the default behavior for the current track is reversed. That is, on the main video track, Ctrl+Delete leaves a gap when the clip is removed, while on the other tracks, the gap on the track is closed up. In neither case are other tracks affected.

You can also access the delete operations through the right-button context menu for clips on the Timeline.

The delete options on the right-button menu for

Timeline clips are not the same for clips on the main video track (L) as for those on other tracks (R). The menus summarize the context-dependent keyboard shortcuts.

Positioning: edit line, scrubbers

The current position is the frame showing in the Player when you are working with a clip in the Movie

Window. In the Timeline view, it is indicated by the edit line. The current position can be changed by moving either the Timeline scrubber (to which the edit line is attached) or the Player scrubber.

When the Clip properties tool is open, a third scrubber, the trim scrubber, is available for adjusting the current position within the clip during trimming.

™

M

OVIE

W

INDOW VIEWS

The Movie Window provides three different views of your project: Timeline , Storyboard and Text . Select the one you want to use by clicking the view selection buttons in the upper right corner of the Movie Window.

Storyboard view

Storyboard view shows the order of video scenes and transitions. It uses thumbnail icons for quickly structuring a movie. You can choose to work with large or small thumbnails with the Show large storyboard thumbnails checkbox on the

Project preferences options panel.

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 95

Timeline view

Timeline view shows the positions and durations of clips relative to the

Timescale. This view also displays up to eight tracks on which you can place various types of clip:

Video, plus full-screen disc menus, titles and graphics: The video track contains the primary visual material in your production. See

Chapter 5: Video clips , Chapter 10: Still images and

Chapter 11: Disc menus for more information.

Original (or “synchronous”) audio: The original audio track contains the audio that was captured along with the video from your camera.

You can manipulate the audio clips on this track to achieve various effects using insert-editing and splitediting techniques. See “Insert editing” (page 128) and “Split editing” (page 130) for more information.

Overlay video and audio: Video and images placed on the overlay track can be used with the Picture-in-picture and Chroma key tools to give your video productions a professional appearance. Original audio for overlay video is stored on the linked audio track. See Chapter 8:

Two-track editing for details about the overlay track.

• Title and graphic overlays: Images placed on the title track will be rendered as overlays upon the main video, with transparent backgrounds.

See Chapter 10: Still images and Chapter 11: Disc menus for more information.

Sound effects and voice-overs: The audio clips on this track are mixed with the original

audio track and the background music track to create the final soundtrack for your movie. See Chapter 14:

Sound effects and music for full information.

• Background music: The background music for your movies can be created to any desired duration with the ScoreFitter tool (page 303) or imported with the CD audio tool (page 302). Your soundtrack can also make use of mp3 and other music files (see page 297).

Disc menus, chapter marks and return-tomenu links: This is an extra track that appears above the video track whenever the movie has at least one disc menu. See Chapter 11: Disc menus for information.

Because many editing operations can be carried out only in Timeline view, you should choose it whenever extensive, detailed or advanced editing is required.

Track locking

The video track normally takes precedence over all other tracks for trimming or deleting. This has several consequences:

• When you trim a video clip, clips running simultaneously on other tracks are also trimmed.

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 97

When you delete a video clip, the time segment it used is also removed from any parallel clips.

• Clips that fall entirely within a deleted video clip’s span are also deleted.

These behaviors can be bypassed when necessary with a feature that allows you to “lock” any track independently of the others, thereby excluding it from editing and playback operations.

The padlock buttons along the right edge of the Movie

Window, can be clicked to toggle locking for the corresponding track. Tracklocking gives Studio insert-edit and split-edit capability (see

Chapter 5: Video clips ).

Track muting and hiding

The audio tracks can be individually muted with the mute buttons at the right edge of the Movie Window. These buttons have the same function as the mute buttons in the

Volume and balance tool. (See page 316 for more information.)

The equivalent operation for video tracks is effected with the hide buttons, which can be used to temporarily omit a track’s video from your project.

This is especially handy to see what’s really going on while editing overlay video.

Placement feedback

Studio gives you several types of feedback about your actions as you place clips in the Timeline view.

The status line: The status line area on the left of the

Movie Window title bar displays messages as you place clips and perform other actions.

Placement symbols: While you are dragging a clip into position on the Timeline, Studio provides feedback to tell you whether the current placement of the clip is valid. The mouse pointer shape and the colors of the vertical placement lines indicate what you can and cannot do.

For example, if you attempt to drag a sound onto the video track, the placement guidelines turn from green to red, the mouse pointer changes from “copy” to

“unavailable”, and the status line tells you, “Only scenes, titles, photos, menus and transitions on video track.”

Green placement lines with the “copy” pointer mean that an action is valid; red placement lines with the

“unavailable” pointer ; show that it is not.

Clip markers

Studio’s straightforward system of clip markers can simplify navigation within a project, especially one that is long or complex.

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 99

Markers can also be used to define start and end points for outputting a portion of your movie as a file or to the

Web. See “Create between markers” on page 333 for details.

Controls relating to clip markers appear in the Movie

Window title bar. In a new project, the only visible control in the group is the add marker button. The remaining controls appear only after the first marker has been added.

In a new project, the only visible clip marker control is the Add Marker button n . Clicking the button (or pressing your ‘M’ key) creates a marker at the position of the Timeline scrubber.

Once a marker has been added, the Add Marker button changes to Delete Marker, and the remaining controls appear o

. Notice marker tab ‘01’ at the scrubber position p

.

As more markers are added, the Previous Marker and Next Marker buttons are enabled as needed q

.

Studio renumbers markers to keep them in sequence r

, but leaves unchanged the name you provided, if any s

.

A clip marker represents a particular frame in a particular clip. Even if that clip is moved around within the project, or trimmed, the anchor location remains unchanged. However, the marker itself can be moved, even to a different clip, by dragging it with the mouse.

The clip marker controls include:

Add marker, Delete marker: In Timeline view, the add marker button is enabled whenever a clip is selected, provided there is not already a marker at the scrubber position.

If a marker is present, the delete marker button appears instead.

Previous marker, Next marker: These buttons allow you to step through the markers in your project. Unlike the add marker and delete marker buttons, these buttons are enabled in all Movie Window views, not just Timeline view.

• Clip marker title: If there is a clip marker at the

Timeline scrubber position, its number and name are displayed in this text field (otherwise the field is uneditable). The displayed marker number is assigned automatically, and cannot be changed, but the optional name can be modified at will.

Clip marker title list: Click the arrow button at the right of the clip marker title to open this list, which shows the number and name of each marker in your project. Selecting a marker moves the Timeline scrubber to the corresponding position.

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 101

Note: Once you have more than a very few markers in your project, managing them becomes simpler if you give them meaningful names. However, names are optional and, as noted above, Studio helps out by automatically keeping the list in time order.

Text view

The Movie Window Text view is a list showing the start and end times of clips, as well as their duration. In addition, custom names for clips are visible in this view.

™

T

HE TOOLBOXES

The toolboxes provide a convenient point-and-click interface for editing operations – adding clips to your movie, modifying existing clips and applying special effects. Studio provides separate toolboxes for video and for audio operations.

The toolboxes are available only in Edit mode. They are opened and closed with the buttons at the top left of the Movie Window.

Select the toolbox you want to open by moving your cursor over the icons. The individual buttons highlight, indicating which toolbox will open when you click.

The Album is then replaced by the toolbox display, which contains two main areas:

• Tool selector buttons in a panel on the left. Clicking one of these opens the corresponding tool.

• The currently-selected tool on the right. Doubleclicking a clip in the Movie Window also displays the corresponding tool (except for title clips, which are opened directly in the appropriate title editor when you double-click).

All the tool-selector buttons, except the top one in each set, open specialized tools. The top button in both toolboxes is the Clip properties tool. It displays a tool appropriate for trimming and otherwise editing the type of clip currently selected in the Movie Window.

The title editors

Studio includes a pair of powerful tools that are not directly accessed through the toolboxes. These tools,

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 103

the Classic Title Editor and the Motion Titler, let you combine text, images and other graphic resources to make titles and disc menus for your Studio productions.

Access the title editors through the Title and Disc menu tools, or with the Go to Classic Title/Menu Editor and

Go to Motion Title Editor commands from the rightbutton context menu in the Movie Window. See

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor , and Chapter 13:

The Motion Titler for full information.

The Video toolbox

The seven tools in this toolbox modify or create visual clip types, including video clips, themes, titles, still images and disc menus.

Clip properties: The Clip properties tool adjusts the start and end times of any type of clip. This is called “trimming”. The tool also allows you to type in a descriptive name for the clip. The tool also presents additional interface components appropriate to the type of clip being edited. See “Trimming with the Clip properties tool” on page 122 for more information.

Themes: The Theme editor tool lets you customize clips created from “theme templates”.

The tool includes a mini-Album from which you can import video and photos to be used in the theme clip.

Some theme templates also provide text captions or other parameters that allow customization. See Chapter

6: Themes and theme editing for more information.

Titles: This tool lets you edit the names and lengths of titles. Depending on the type of title you select, the Edit Title button provides access to the

Classic Title Editor or the Motion Titler, where you can change the text and appearance of the title. See Chapter

12: The Classic Title Editor , and Chapter 13: The

Motion Titler for more information.

Disc menus: The Disc menu tool has a number of controls for editing the links between the buttons on a disc menu and entry points into your movie called chapter marks , which are represented on the menu track in the Movie Window. The Edit Menu button opens the Classic Title Editor, where you can modify the visual appearance of a menu. See “The Disc menu tool” on page 235 for more information.

Frame grabber: This tool takes a snapshot of a single frame from your movie. You can use the grabbed frame in your movie, or save it for use in other applications. See “The Frame Grabber” on page 219 for more information.

SmartMovie: This tool automatically combines your source footage with the digital song file of your choice to create a music video in any of a variety of styles. See “The SmartMovie music video tool” on page 134 for more information.

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 105

PIP and chroma key tool: The PIP and Chroma

Key controls occupy separate tabs on the same tool window, so this can be thought of as really two tools in one. It provides an alternative, graphical interface to the Picture-in-picture and Chroma key effects. See “The Picture-in-picture tool” (page 184) and “The Chroma key tool” (page 190) for more information.

Video effects: Studio provides numerous plug-in video effects with this tool. Each video clip, theme clip or still image in your project can use effects, whether alone or in combination.

Along with its basic library of useful effects, Studio provides some “locked” premium effects that you can try out. See Chapter 7 : Video effects for details about this tool. For information about purchasing premium content for Studio, including varied collections of video effects, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

The Audio toolbox

The six tools in this set operate on or create audio clips

– “original” audio, voice-overs, sound effects and other audio files, CD tracks and SmartSound background music.

Clip properties: The Clip properties tool lets you adjust (“trim”) the start and end times of any type of clip. You can also enter a descriptive name for the clip to replace the default name if desired. (Clip names are displayed when the Movie Window is in

Text view.) The tool’s other controls vary depending on the type of clip. See “Trimming with the Clip properties tool” on page 308 for more information.

Volume and balance: This tool gives you master volume controls for each of the three audio tracks: original audio (audio captured with video), sound effects and voice-overs and background music . It also enables you to mute any or all of the tracks, and to add real-time volume fades. Use the balance and surround control to position each track independently of the other two in a one-dimensional stereo or two-dimensional surround-sound space.

When the overlay track is open, the tool provides a fourth set of controls, which affect the overlay audio track. See “The Volume and balance tool” on page 316 for more information.

Availability: Surround sound is supported in Studio Ultimate only.

Record voice-overs: To record a voice-over, simply click the Record button and begin speaking into your microphone. See “The Voice-over tool” on page 305 for more information.

Add CD audio: Use this tool to add tracks, in whole or in part, from an audio CD. See “The

CD audio tool” on page 302 for more information.

Background music: This tool lets you add background music using ScoreFitter, Studio’s powerful music generator. Choose a style, song, and

Chapter 4: The Movie Window 107

version. Studio will create a musical soundtrack that matches the duration of your movie. See “The

Background music tool” on page 303 for more information.

Audio effects: This tool lets you apply plug-in effects to any audio clip. The popular VST standard for audio plug-ins is supported, enabling you to augment your library with add-on and third party effects. A configurable noise reduction filter is supplied as a standard effect. Effects available in Studio

Ultimate also include both graphic and parametric EQ, reverb, chorus and others.

Some “watermarked” premium effects may also be included for you to try out, with others available through the Pinnacle web-site by clicking the More effects… “category” in the audio effects browser. See

Chapter 15: Audio effects for details about this tool.

For information about purchasing premium content for

Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

CHAPTER 5:

Video clips

The cornerstone of most Studio video projects is the

Album section containing your captured video scenes.

To create your edited movie, you drag scenes from the

Album into the Movie Window, where they are treated as editable video clips .

This chapter explains how to set the “in” and “out”

(start and end) points for each clip. The Movie

Window’s editing interface makes this “trimming” process simple, rapid and precise. The methods covered in this chapter for trimming video (“Trimming video clips”, page 117) can for the most part also be applied to the other types of clip (such as titles and sound effects) that are covered in later chapters.

A later section of the chapter covers more advanced editing techniques, including split edits and insert edits, that you can use to give your movies a more professional look. See “Advanced Timeline editing” on page 126.

And finally we’ll explore SmartMovie, Studio’s automatic movie generator. SmartMovie intelligently combines a music soundtrack with your video footage to create a beat-synchronized music video, or with a series of still images to create a slideshow. Both modes support a variety of style options.

Chapter 5: Video clips 109

™

V

IDEO CLIP BASICS

The first step in creating a movie is to introduce some video scenes from the Album into the Movie Window, where they become editable clips . At some point you will probably also add some transitions, titles, audio and other extras, but a set of video scenes is the starting point for just about any project.

This section explains how to add scenes to your movie, and how to work with scenes from multiple capture files. It also covers some interface features that provide useful feedback as you work.

Adding video clips to your movie

There are two ways to add a video clip to your movie:

Drag and drop: Drag a scene from the Video Scenes section of the Album and drop it into the Movie

Window. This is normally the easiest and quickest way to put together a rough cut of your movie. You can drag multiple scenes simultaneously if you wish.

The clipboard: The standard clipboard operations

(Cut, Copy and Paste) can be used with video clips in the Movie Window. The Copy operation works on

Album scenes also.

When a scene or clip is pasted into the Movie Window, it is inserted at the first clip boundary starting at the edit line position. You can use the standard keyboard shortcuts for clipboard operations (Ctrl+X for cut,

Ctrl+C for copy, Ctrl+V for paste), or select the desired operation from the right-button menu.

When the Movie Window is in Timeline view, you can drop a video scene or clip onto any of the following:

• The main video track. If the clip has associated audio, it is added to the original audio track. This video will serve as the background for any overlay video or titles on the lower Timeline tracks.

• The overlay track. Video on this track is superimposed on the contents of the video track. The picture-in-picture and chroma key effects are used to make a portion of the overlay frame transparent so that some of the main video can be seen.

The title track. If the overlay track is hidden, dropping a video clip on the title track causes the overlay track to open and the clip to be placed upon it. In other versions of Studio, or when the overlay track is already displayed, the title track does not accept video clips.

The sound effects track or the background music track. Attempting to drop a video clip on either of these tracks actually drops the clip’s original audio.

Working with multiple capture files

For some projects you may want to incorporate scenes from multiple source tapes, or from different capture files made from one tape. To achieve this, load in each of the files in turn and drag whichever scenes you want from each file into your movie.

To use multiple capture files:

1.

Drag scenes from the first capture file into the

Movie Window.

Chapter 5: Video clips 111

2.

3.

Using the dropdown list or the folder button in the

Video Scenes section of the Album, open the second capture file. Studio displays scenes from only the current file in the Album. See “Opening a video file” on page 67 for detailed information on this step.

Drag scenes from the second captured file into the

Movie Window. Continue in this manner until you have gone through all the files.

Handling multiple capture files is made easier by use of the Project Bin, where the files whose scenes you add to your movie are automatically included. See page 86 for details.

Mixing frame formats

Because any given movie can be in only one of the standard (4:3) format and the widescreen (16:9) format,

Studio does not let you mix frame formats in the Movie

Window. By default, the first video clip you add to a movie determines the movie’s frame format, and later clips are modified as necessary to conform to it. See

“The project video format” below for further information.

The project video format

The video scenes you add to a project need not all originate with the same device or be in the same file format. They need not even have the same frame size, aspect ratio or frame rate.

When video is played back within Studio, however, a common frame format must be used. The Project

format box on the Project preferences options panel lets you specify the format for new projects either explicitly (e.g. “NTSC Widescreen”) or implicitly, from the format of the first clip you add to the project.

The current project format is displayed as a tooltip over the project title in the Movie Window.

The project format applies to all video and image clips in the Movie Window, and to the preview of those clips in the Player. Visual content in the Album, such as your captured video scenes, is shown by default in its original format, whether or not that matches the project format.

If you want to avoid black bars (“letterboxing”) in your project video, but still want to use scenes shot in the wrong aspect ratio, there are several approaches you can consider:

• Use the Aspect ratio commands on the Album menu.

These let you stretch the Album scenes to conform to the proportions of the project frame, at the cost of some distortion. Please see “Video aspect ratios” on page 69 for more information.

Chapter 5: Video clips 113

The Zoom Picture to Full Frame context menu command for clips in the Movie Window expands the central portion of the original image enough to fill the frame in the project format. Proportion is maintained with this method, but some material is lost.

• For a fine-tuned version of the same approach, use the 2D Editor effect with keyframing to create a

“pan and scan” version your video. Studios often use this technique to make their movies fit a standard television screen when they are transferred to videotape or DVD. A portion of each frame is still lost, but you have some control over which portion that is. Careful tracking of the action with the aid of keyframing generally allows you to obtain acceptable results despite this problem.

Availability note: The 2D Editor effect and the keyframing feature are provided in Studio Ultimate only.

Compensating for source video in the “wrong” aspect ratio by adding black bars (L), stretching to the full frame (C), and zooming (R). Each method has its own drawbacks.

Background rendering

The project format is also used as the target format for rendering , which is the process of generating video for footage in which HFX transitions, effects or other

computationally demanding features are used. Until such video has been rendered, it may not display smoothly and with full detail during preview.

Studio is able to carry out rendering behind the scenes while you work. This feature is controlled from the

Background rendering box on the Video and audio preferences options panel.

Following the dialog’s advice regarding the codec to use for background rendering may help reduce the rendering time when your final movie is output.

If you are planning to preview your video on an external device (Studio Ultimate only), you may need to set the project format and the background rendering codec to match that device. For instance, if you are previewing on an analog monitor plugged into your DV camcorder, you should do your background rendering in DV.

Interface features

Studio provides a variety of visual cues regarding the video clips in the Movie Window:

• When a clip is added to the Movie Window, a green checkmark appears on the Album’s icon for the

Chapter 5: Video clips 115

corresponding scene. The checkmark remains as long as any clip in the Movie Window belongs to that scene.

• To see the original location of a clip in your source video, use the Find Scene in Album command on the right-click menu for Movie Window clips. Studio highlights the Album scene from which the selected clip is drawn. To go the other way, use Album

¾

Find Scene in Project to show how a particular

Album scene is used in your current project.

• When neighboring scenes from the Album are placed in sequence in the Movie Window, the border between the clips is displayed as a dotted line. This is to help you keep track of your clips, and does not affect how they can be manipulated in the Movie

Window.

• In Timeline mode, any special effects you have applied to a clip are indicated by small icons along the bottom of the clip. These correspond to the effect groups shown on the Video effects and Audio effects tools. You can open the tool for parameter editing by double-clicking any of the icons.

The star icon below this video clip shows that at least one effect in the “Fun” category has been applied.

™

T

RIMMING VIDEO CLIPS

In general, captured video scenes contain more material than you actually require for your movie. “Trimming”

– the process of adjusting the in and out points of a clip to remove unwanted footage – is a fundamental editing operation.

No data is lost by trimming: Studio sets new start and end points for the clip in the Movie Window, but the source of the clip – the original Album scene – remains intact. This means you can always reset clips to their original state, or select different trim points.

Studio offers two ways to trim any clip (video scenes, transitions, titles, still images, audio clips and disc menus):

• Directly on the Timeline (see “Trimming on the

Timeline using handles” below).

• Using the Clip properties tool (see “Trimming with the Clip properties tool” on page 122).

A video clip can be trimmed to any desired in and out points within the limits of the original scene.

Trimming on the Timeline using handles

The quickest way to trim is by dragging the edges of clips directly on the Timeline. Watch the Player as you trim, so you can find the frame on which you want to begin or end.

Chapter 5: Video clips 117

Let’s first consider the simplest trimming case, in a movie with only one clip. Then we’ll turn to the more usual situation of trimming a single clip that is surrounded by other clips.

To trim a single clip on the Timeline:

1.

Delete all but one clip from the Timeline. If the

Timeline is empty, drag a scene in from the Album.

2.

Expand the Timescale to make fine adjustments easier.

Position the mouse pointer anywhere on the

Timeline except directly over the edit line. The pointer becomes a clock symbol. Click-drag it to the right to expand the Timescale.

This illustration shows maximum expansion, where each tick mark represents a single frame:

3.

Position your mouse pointer over the right edge of the clip. The pointer becomes a left-pointing arrow.

4.

Click-drag to the left while keeping an eye on the

Player, which updates continuously to show the last frame in the trimmed clip.

As you shorten the clip, the arrow cursor becomes two-directional, indicating that the clip edge can be

dragged both left and right. You can reduce the clip to as little as a single frame, or increase it up to the end of the source scene.

5.

Release the mouse button. The clip is now trimmed.

Multiple clips

The secret to trimming a clip when multiple clips are on the Timeline is that you must first select the clip to be trimmed by clicking on it with the mouse.

To trim with multiple clips on the Timeline:

1.

Set up the Timeline with two short clips.

2.

Adjust the Timescale until the clip you want to adjust is a convenient size for editing.

3.

Click the second clip. The video track should now look something like this:

You can trim the right-hand edge of the clip just as in the single-clip example above. As you do so, the last frame of the clip is displayed in the Player. As long as the second clip remains selected, you can continue to trim more video by dragging the edge to the left, or restore some of the trimmed video by dragging the edge to the right.

Chapter 5: Video clips 119

4.

With the second clip still selected, move your mouse pointer over the left edge of clip until the pointer changes to a right arrow.

5.

Drag the left edge of the second scene to the right.

6.

As you drag, the first frame of the clip is displayed in the Player. As long as the clip remains selected, you can continue to trim more video by dragging the edge to the right, or restore some of the trimmed video by dragging the edge to the left.

Release the mouse button. The clip you trimmed snaps back against the right edge of the first clip.

Gaps and fills: Trimming with the Ctrl key

As we have seen in the example above, when you shorten a clip on the video track, the clip and any clips to the right of it move leftwards as necessary so that no gap is left. At the same time, clips on other tracks are shortened to keep the whole Timeline in sync. When you trim a clip on any other track, however, gaps are not automatically closed up, and no other track is affected.

This default trimming behavior simplifies editing under most circumstances, but Studio also gives you a way to invert the behavior when needed. If you press the Ctrl key before you begin trimming a clip on the video track, neither that clip nor any other will be repositioned, and gaps are not closed up. There is no effect on other tracks.

Meanwhile, using Ctrl when trimming clips on other tracks again inverts the normal behavior. The clips on the track will close in to fill any gap left by the trim.

Clips on tracks besides the one being trimmed are again unaffected.

Note: See page 93 for a description of the parallel behavior of Ctrl when deleting clips.

Clip-trimming tips

If you are having difficulty manipulating the edges of clips during trimming, try the following:

Verify that the clip you wish to trim is selected, and that it is the only one selected.

Expand the Timescale until it is easier to make fine adjustments.

• Avoid expanding the Timescale too far, which makes clips appear very long. If that happens, undo until the scale is the way you want it; or reduce the scale by dragging it towards the left; or select an appropriate value from the Timescale’s context menu.

Chapter 5: Video clips 121

Trimming with the Clip properties tool

Although it is possible to trim video clips directly on the Timeline with full frame accuracy, rapid, precise trimming is often easier to achieve with the

Clip properties tool. To access this tool, select the clip you want to change, then use the Toolbox ¾ Modify

Clip Properties menu command, or click one of the toolbox buttons at the top left of the Movie Window.

(Clicking the same button a second time will close the tool.)

In the case of video clips – in fact, any clips other than titles – you can also open and close the Clip properties tool by double-clicking the clip in any Movie Window view.

The Clip properties tool can be used to modify any kind of clip. It offers an appropriate set of controls for each type.

The Name text field: For a video clip, most of the clip property controls are for trimming. The only exception is the Name text field, which lets you assign a custom name to the clip to replace the default one assigned by

Studio.

The Name field is provided on the Clip properties tool for all clip types. Clip names are used by the Movie

Window’s Text view, and can also be viewed as fly-by labels when your mouse moves over clips in the

Storyboard view.

Preview areas: Separate preview areas show the in and out frames of the trimmed clip, together with a counter

and jog buttons. The layout of each preview area is similar to that of the Player during normal editing.

Setting playback position: A scrubber control across the bottom of the tool lets you set the playback position anywhere within the clip. You can also set the playback position using the counter and jog buttons located between the two preview areas.

Using the counters: The positions reported by all three counters are relative to the beginning of the clip, which is position 0:00:00.0. As with the counter on the Player, you can adjust the counters in the Clip properties tool by clicking in one of the four fields (hours, minutes, seconds, frames) to select it, then using the jog buttons.

When none of the fields is explicitly selected, the jog buttons apply to the frames field.

Transport controls: While the Clip properties tool is in use, the transport controls in the center area substitute for those that normally appear on the Player.

These special transport controls include a Loop play/Pause button that can be used to cycle repeatedly through the trimmed portion of the clip while the trim points are being adjusted.

Setting the trim points: The left bracket button beside the counter in the left preview area, and the right

Chapter 5: Video clips 123

bracket button beside the counter in the right preview area, set their respective trim points to the current position.

You can also adjust either trim point by:

Entering a value directly into its counter

Adjusting a counter field with the jog buttons

Dragging the corresponding trim caliper

The Duration text field: This field shows the length of the trimmed clip in hours, minutes, seconds and frames.

If you modify the value, either by editing the numbers directly or by clicking the associated jog buttons, the effect is to change the out point of the clip. Of course, you cannot reduce the duration to less than a frame, or increase it beyond the limits of the original video scene.

Usage tip: If you want to switch from trimming one clip on the video track to trimming another, just click on the new clip while the Clip properties tool remains open, or drag the Timeline scrubber to the new clip.

Resetting trimmed clips

If you change your mind about a particular trim operation (or group of operations) after previewing, either use the Undo button (or Ctrl+Z) or manually reset the trimmed clip using one of these methods:

• Drag the clip’s right edge directly on the Timeline until it stretches no further,

In the Clip properties tool, drag the trim calipers to the ends of the clip.

™

S

PLITTING AND COMBINING CLIPS

If you want to insert one clip on the video track into the middle of another clip, split the latter into two parts then insert the new item. “Splitting” a clip actually results in it being duplicated. Both clips are then automatically trimmed so that the first ends at the split point and the second begins there.

To split a clip in Timeline view:

1.

2.

Choose the split point.

You may use any method that adjusts the current position, such as moving the Timeline scrubber, clicking Play and then Pause , or editing the counter value in the Player.

Either right-click within the clip you wish to split and select Split Clip from the pop-up menu; or, make certain the edit line is positioned where you wish to split the clip, and click the Split clip/scene

(razorblade) button (see page 93).

The clip is split at the current position.

To restore a split clip:

• Use the Undo button (or press Ctrl+Z). Even if you have performed other actions since you split the clip, the multilevel undo allows you to step back as far as needed. Or,

If undoing is not desirable because of intervening actions that you don’t want to discard, you can replace both halves of the split clip with the original from the Album. Or,

• Delete one half of the split clip, and trim out the other.

Chapter 5: Video clips 125

To combine clips in the Movie Window:

Select the clips you wish to combine, then right-click and choose Combine Clips .

The operation is allowed only if the combination of clips will also be a valid clip – that is, a continuous excerpt of the source video. On the Timeline, clips that can be combined meet along a dotted edge.

™

A

DVANCED

T

IMELINE EDITING

Note: Other approaches to the kinds of edit described here, making use of the overlay track, are covered in Chapter 8: Two-track editing .

During most editing operations, Studio automatically keeps the clips on the various Timeline tracks synchronized. For instance, when you insert a scene from the Album onto the video track, the relative positions of all clips to the right of the insertion remain unchanged.

Sometimes, though, you might like to override the default synchronization. You might want to insert a new video clip into your project without displacing any clips of other types. Or you might want to edit video separately from its accompanying original audio – a valuable technique with several variations, discussed below.

Such special edits are possible using the track lock buttons along the right edge of the Movie Window in

Timeline view. Each of the standard tracks (all except

the menu track) provides a lock button. See “Track locking” on page 97 for more information on track locking.

A locked track is grayed out in the Timeline view, indicating that the clips on the locked track cannot be selected or edited in any of the three views; nor are they affected by editing operations on unlocked tracks.

Apart from the menu track, any combination of tracks can be locked.

Locking the title track, for example, prevents the duration of a title from being changed even when you trim clips on the main video track at the same time index.

When the title track is unlocked, trimming the main video clip above it automatically trims the title.

Chapter 5: Video clips 127

Insert editing

In ordinary Timeline editing, a video clip and the original audio that was captured with it are treated as a unit. Their special relationship is symbolized in the

Movie Window by the line connecting the video track indicator with the original audio track indicator, showing that the latter is dependent on the former.

The track lock buttons make it possible to deal with the two tracks independently for operations like insert editing , which typically means replacing part of a clip on the video track while the original audio track continues uninterrupted.

Note: Insert editing may also be carried out on the overlay video and audio tracks, using analogous methods to those described here. See

Chapter 8: Two-track editing for details.

For instance, in a sequence that shows someone recounting a story, you might wish to insert a shot of an audience member smiling (or sleeping!) without breaking away from the main audio.

To perform an insert edit on the video track:

1.

2.

In the Timeline view of the Movie Window, click the original audio track’s padlock button to lock the track.

The lock button is highlighted, and the track itself is grayed to show that its contents will not be affected by editing operations.

Clear space on the video track for the video clip you want to insert. Position the Timeline scrubber at the point you want the insertion to start and use the

Split clip/scene button. Now move to the point where the insertion should end and again split the clip. Finally, delete the portion of video that will be replaced by the insertion.

Because the audio track is still intact, having been locked, the video to the right of the insertion point does not move leftwards to fill the gap you have made in the Timeline, for the video and audio would then no longer be synchronized. If you were to preview your video now, you would see a black screen as the gap portion played back, but the soundtrack would be normal.

3.

Now all that remains is to place the clip you want to insert. Drag the clip (whether from the Album, the

Project Bin, or elsewhere on the Timeline) into the hole in the video track that you’ve just opened up.

If the inserted clip is too long for the space you created it is automatically trimmed to fit the space.

You can adjust the trimming with the Clip properties tool.

Chapter 5: Video clips 129

Insert editing on the original audio track

The converse insert-editing operation, in which a sound clip is inserted into the original audio track over unbroken video, is needed less often but is also readily performed in Studio.

The procedure is analogous to the one for inserting video: simply reverse the roles of the two tracks at every step.

Split editing

In “split editing”, a clip’s audio and video are separately trimmed so that the transition to one occurs before the transition to the other.

Note: Split editing may also be carried out on the overlay video and audio tracks, using analogous methods to those described here. See

Chapter 8: Two-track editing details.

In an “L-cut”, the video precedes its sync audio; in a

“J-cut”, the audio comes first.

Tip: For faster, more precise trimming, you may find it helpful to have the Clip properties tool open when following the procedures in this section. To open the tool, just double-click one of the video clips before you begin.

The L-cut

In an L-cut, the cut to new video comes before the cut in the audio.

Imagine a videotaped lecture in which the video periodically cuts away from the speaker to show travel or nature scenes illustrating the lecture topic.

Audio and video cut simultaneously.

Instead of cutting the audio and the video simultaneously, you might decide to let the speaker’s voice overlap into the following scene. This makes it clear to the audience that the new scene they are now watching illustrates whatever explanation the speaker has been providing.

Notice that the video and audio clip boundaries in the completed cut form an L-shape.

Audio cuts after video. The resulting “L” shape is outlined in this illustration.

There are many effective uses of this technique. It can be considered whenever the second clip’s video serves to illustrate the first clip’s audio.

Chapter 5: Video clips 131

To perform an L-cut:

1.

2.

Adjust the Timeline so you can easily count off the number of frames or seconds you want to overlap.

Select the left-hand clip and trim its right edge to the point where you want the audio to end.

3.

Lock the audio track. Now drag the right-hand edge of the same clip’s video leftward to the point where the following clip’s video should start.

4.

With the audio track still locked, drag the second clip’s video to the left until it meets the original clip.

If there isn’t enough excess video at the start of the second clip to make this trim possible, you will first need to trim off a sufficient amount from both its video and audio then try again.

5.

Unlock the audio track.

The video now cuts away to the second clip ahead of the audio. Video has been trimmed from the end of the first clip, and audio has been trimmed from the start of the second clip.

The J-cut

In the J-cut, the new audio cuts in before the video switches. This can be effective when the second clip’s audio prepares the viewer for the material in the scene.

Returning to the videotaped lecture example, let’s say we are now going to switch back to the speaker at the end of the interpolated footage. If we let the next part of the lecture appear on the soundtrack a few moments before the video shows us the podium again, the change will be much less abrupt.

This time the clip boundaries outline the letter J:

Audio cuts before video. The resulting “J” shape is outlined in this illustration.

To perform a J-cut:

1.

2.

Adjust the Timeline so you can easily count off the number of frames or seconds you want to overlap.

As before, trim back the right edge of the left-hand clip, both video and audio, by the overlap interval.

Chapter 5: Video clips 133

3.

4.

Lock the audio track. Now drag the right-hand edge of the same clip’s video back to the right by the overlap interval.

Unlock the audio track.

The audio now cuts away to the second clip ahead of the video.

Note: The procedures described above for performing the L-cut and the J-cut are not the only possibilities.

With the J-cut, for example, another method would be to trim the right-hand clip to the desired start point of the video then, with the video track locked, drag the audio portion leftwards to overlap the audio of the lefthand clip.

™

T

HE

S

MART

M

OVIE MUSIC VIDEO TOOL

Creating a music video seems like a big job, even with the convenient editing features of Studio. Dozens of brief clips must be carefully aligned to the beat of the soundtrack, in order that the music and video are properly coordinated.

With Studio’s SmartMovie tool, however, you can construct a dynamic, beat-synchronized music video almost instantly, in your choice of styles and using any combination of video footage and music.

You can make slideshows, too. SmartMovie can create an instant slideshow from any set of still images, in a choice of styles and with synchronized music.

Tip: The Timeline view of the Movie Window is recommended when working with audio clips.

The SmartMovie tool walks you through the creation process with simple step-bystep instructions. To begin, use the Album to locate the video scenes or still images you want to include, and drag them onto the Movie Window.

With the visuals in place, add a ScoreFitter, CD audio or digital music ( wav , mp3 ) clip to the background music track. The duration of this clip – and not the amount of visual material you supply – determines the length of your music video. If you don’t supply enough visual material, SmartMovie will use your video clips or images multiple times in order to achieve the required duration. Conversely, clips or images will be omitted if you provide more than can be used within the duration of the song.

Exception: When making a slideshow with the Use all images option checked (see below), it is the number of images you provide that determines the length of the finished project, not the duration of the music clip.

SmartMovie styles

Select a style from the dropdown list at the top of the

SmartMovie tool window. A variety of styles is offered for both music video and slideshow projects.

For video styles, you will get the best results if the starting duration of your video footage is about double the length of the soundtrack. Each of the slideshow styles has its own ideal ratio between the number of pictures and the length of the song. The status balloon provides guidance for getting the proportions right.

Chapter 5: Video clips 135

A brief description of each style is displayed in the status balloon as you scroll through the style list.

SmartMovie options

The Use clips in random order option lets you mix up the visual material without regard to its initial sequence. This option is the default with some styles. It tends to give a finished product with a relatively uniform texture, but sacrifices narrative continuity.

Check the Use all images option when you want to ensure that all the still images you have added to your project are actually used in the slideshow, regardless of the length of music you have provided. Studio will repeat or trim the music clip as required to match the number of images you have chosen.

Note: The Use all images option affects SmartMovie slideshows only, not music videos.

The Relative volume slider adjusts the prominence of the background music track relative to the other audio

tracks. Move the slider all the way to the right if you want to hear only the music track in the finished video.

The last configuration step is to enter the text to use for the opening and closing titles. Each text line consists of two edit fields. Use Tab and Shift+Tab to jump between the left and right fields.

The big moment…

Finally, click the Create SmartMovie button and sit back while Studio generates your movie.

Chapter 5: Video clips 137

CHAPTER 6:

Montage

®

themes and theme editing

Studio’s customizable Montage

®

“themes” provide a powerful but easy to learn method of achieving slideshow, animation and multitrack editing effects.

With themes you can quickly give your videos a more professional look while maintaining a coherent structure. Each theme consists of a set of templates that can be added to your project as “theme clips”. You can create attractive, visually consistent sequences that integrate artist-created titles and animations with your own photos and video.

Note: “Titles” created from a Montage theme are not related to those in the Titles section of the Album, or created with Studio’s title editors. Themes are easier to use, and can provide effects not available in ordinary titles. On the other hand, the title editors give you much finer control over the appearance of the titles.

The themes provided are each designed to cover a typical need. Within each theme, the available

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 139

templates are designed to complement one another when used in the same project. For instance, most themes provide an Opening template and a matching

Ending template. Many themes also provide one or more Segue templates for transitioning from one video or image clip to another.

The appearance of a theme clip’s Timeline icon reflects its structure. Here, from left to right, are an

Opening, a Segue, and an Ending icon. The zig-zag edges correspond to the placement of full-frame video in the clip. The video at the end of the

Opening, and at the start of the Ending, can be edited to match that of a Segue; thus the zig-zag also indicates graphically how the templates can be used together.

Each template defines a video or graphic sequence with blanks to be filled in by you. Most templates provide one or more slots for video or image clips. Many let you supply text captions for titles, and some have additional parameters for other special properties.

Theme templates are stored in their own section of the

Album. The first step in using a chosen template is to bring it into your project as a theme clip. As usual, this is done by dragging the icon from the Album to the

Movie Window.

In the Movie Window, the theme clip is treated as an ordinary, self-contained video clip. To customize the clip – to fill in the template’s blanks – you will use the

Theme Editor tool.

™

U

SING THEMES

Theme templates are stored in the Themes section of the Album. The Album displays all the templates in a given theme, as selected from a dropdown list. To use a template, simply drag its icon from the Album into the

Movie Window.

Pick a theme from the dropdown list (L) to show the templates available (R). To use a template, drag its icon down into the Movie Window.

When the Movie Window is in Timeline View, theme clips can be trimmed and edited much like ordinary video. You can elaborate them with transitions and effects, adjust their audio, and so on.

The theme clip (selected in illustration) is treated as a unit in the Movie Window. Its special properties can be modified with the Theme Editor tool (doubleclick the clip to open).

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 141

Like disc menus, themes are configured with a special editing tool, which opens automatically when the clip is added to the project, or when it is later double-clicked.

The Theme Editor tool allows the user to customize a theme clip by adjusting its built-in settings or specifying video and audio subclips for it to use. The editor can also be accessed with the Toolbox

¾

Edit Theme menu command.

The Theme Editor tool lets you specify theme elements such as video or image clips, property settings, and text captions. Clips are added by dragging them either from the editor’s own mini-

Album (left side of tool) or from the Movie Window.

Theme backgrounds

Some themes have built-in graphical backgrounds, a selectable background color, or both. Many of these also provide a

Background checkbox in the Theme Editor tool, which when checked makes the background transparent. This allows the theme to be used on the overlay track, with the video track as its background.

The Themes section of the Album

In the Album, the templates for one theme may be viewed at a time. As with video scenes, you use the mouse to select, play or add a theme template:

Single-click loads the template to the Player, where it can be played back with the transport controls.

• Double-click loads the template to the Player and begins playback immediately.

• Dragging the template to the Movie Window, or right-clicking its icon and clicking the Add To Movie context menu command, inserts it into your project.

As with menus, a special editor tool opens automatically when a theme clip is added to the movie.

Creating theme clips

To create a theme clip, use any of the standard methods of adding content to your project:

Drag an icon from the Themes section of the Album to the Movie Window.

• Select Add To Project in a theme template icon’s right-button context menu.

• Paste the contents of the Windows Clipboard after you have cut or copied an existing theme clip.

Each theme is configured to appear on the track that is appropriate to the theme’s content type:

• Themes whose content is a graphic overlay with transparent background, such as a title or PIP frame, are usually added to the Title track.

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 143

Themes with full-frame video, such as opening sequences, can be added to the Main video track

(Studio) or the Overlay video track.

The default length of a theme clip depends on the design of the individual template.

If you drop a new theme clip onto an existing one on the Timeline, the new clip either is inserted beside the old one or simply replaces it. The choice of operation depends on the position of the mouse pointer relative to the target clip when you release the button.

Inserting a theme clip before or after an existing clip: If you drop the new clip near the start or end of an existing theme clip, it is accordingly inserted before or after the existing clip. The placement lines that show the position of the new clip on the Timeline are drawn in green.

A new theme clip, represented by the ‘copy’ mouse pointer, is dragged near the beginning of the lefthand clip. Green placement lines indicate where the new clip will be inserted.

In the illustration above, the placement lines show the boundaries of the clip that would be created by releasing the mouse button at the current position, based on the template’s default length. All existing clips would be moved rightwards to accommodate the new one. If you were instead to drop the new clip near

the right-hand edge of the same existing clip, it would be inserted after the clip.

Replacing an existing clip: If you drop a new theme clip onto the middle of an existing one, the new clip replaces the old one. The new clip also takes over any existing customizations of the old clip. The placement lines, drawn in blue, show the boundaries of the clip to be replaced; regardless of its designed default length, the new clip will inherit these boundaries.

A new theme clip is dropped onto the middle of the left-hand clip, replacing it. The positions of other clips are not affected.

Working with theme clips on the Timeline

Theme clips behave like ordinary video clips when it comes to operations like trimming and adding transitions.

When a theme clip is trimmed...

Although trimming operations on the Timeline are the same for theme clips as for video clips, the actual result produced by trimming depends on the nature of the clip.

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 145

In an all-animated theme, such as a fancy rolled title, the animation runs to completion at whatever speed the current clip duration dictates. Shortening the clip thus causes the animation to run faster, but does not truncate the sequence.

Clips that include video, in contrast, can be trimmed in the usual way. Many themes include a variable-length video subclip. When one of these is present, the clip can be expanded as far as the length of the subclip will allow – indefinitely, if the subclip is a still image.

Interior trimming of themes

When a theme clip’s template begins or ends with a user-settable amount of full-frame video, as many do, the Timeline provides handles for adjusting the amount of “lead-in” and “lead-out” times – the durations of the full-frame portions. Click a handle and drag left or right to adjust either duration separately. The duration of the center part of the clip – the animated part – will shorten or lengthen accordingly. If you want to balance the lead-in and lead-out without affecting the duration of the center portion, click between the handles and drag. n

Click and drag the adjustment handle to trim the lead-in or lead-out portion of a theme clip. The duration of the center portion will increase or decrease accordingly. o Click between the handles to drag both at once, thereby repositioning the center in the clip without changing its duration.

For a detailed explanation of theme structure, see

“Anatomy of a theme” on page 147.

Transitions and effects

Transitions can be used at the beginning and end of theme clips in the same way as with other clip types.

Video and audio effects can also be added to theme clips as usual, and apply to all the content the clip embodies. However, a few effects, such as Speed , are not available for use with theme clips.

Anatomy of a theme

For examples of how themes work, let’s examine the included “50s Modern” theme, which contains five templates.

All the templates in this particular theme use the same backdrop design – an abstract, scrolling pattern. It is continuously visible except during full-frame video segments. The coloring of the pattern is set using a parameter control available in the Theme Editor for each of these templates.

Now let’s look at each template in turn to see how it is constructed from the elements – clips and captions – that you supply in the Theme Editor.

Opening: An Opening template usually starts with some sort of animation, including titles, and ends with full frame video. Our “50s Modern” example follows that pattern.

The scrolling background animation runs through most of this sequence. Within the animation, two

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 147

customizable captions are displayed. They are represented in the diagram below by lines on the

“Animation” bar. Both captions are flown into and out of the frame (dark line color), with a one and a half second pause for stationary display (light line color) in between.

Schematic representation of the Opening template in the ‘50s Modern’ theme, at its default length of about

14 seconds.

Just as the second caption is leaving the frame, an animated panel containing the running video subclip is launched. The video zooms to full frame by 11:18 in the theme clip, and remains so through to the end (the white portion of the “Video” bar in the diagram).

By default, the length of this theme clip is 13:29. The embedded video clip starts at a fixed offset of 7:03 and runs to the end; its length is therefore 6:26. If your video subclip is long enough, you can lengthen the overall clip, extending the full-frame video portion.

This capability is indicated in the diagram above by the arrow at the end of the “Video” bar.

Segue A: Segue templates connect two full-frame video sequences by means of some kind of animation. This first

Segue example begins with two seconds of full-frame video, then zooms out to reveal a formation of multiple video panels running simultaneously. Zooming in on the final subclip leads to an expandable section of fullframe video.

Segue A integrates multiple video sources.

Segue B: This Segue achieves the basic aim of connecting two video clips more simply than the previous one. The first subclip starts at full frame, then zooms out while rotating away from the viewer. When the reverse side of its rotating panel comes into view, the second subclip has replaced the first. The panel zooms in to fill the frame towards the end of the clip.

Segue B creates a simpler transition.

Once again, the full-screen segment of the second subclip can be extended by expanding the theme clip on the Timeline.

Segue C: This is similar to Segue B, except that the flying video panel takes an extra spin in the middle to admit one more subclip into the sequence.

Segue C includes a bridging video subclip.

The final subclip is again expandable.

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 149

Ending: The purpose of an Ending template mirrors that of an Opening template, and in this example the internal structure is also mirrored almost exactly. Fullframe video recedes to a flying panel that gives way to animated captions – exactly the opposite of the

Opening sequence described above. The one difference is that in this case the full-frame video portion of the clip is not extendable.

The Ending theme is essentially a mirror image of the Opening theme.

Opening the Theme Editor tool

The Theme Editor tool allows you to customize a theme clip by specifying your own subclips and other customizations. The tool can be invoked from a theme clip in the project in either of these ways:

Double-click the clip in the Movie Window.

Select menu.

Open With Theme Editor on the clip’s context

You can also open the tool directly:

Click the Theme Editor tool button.

Select Theme Editor in the Toolbox menu.

With these two methods, if a theme clip is currently selected in the Movie Window, it is automatically loaded into the editor upon opening.

While the editor is open, clicking on a different theme clip in the Movie Window changes the preview to that clip without closing the editor.

Using the Theme Editor tool

Each theme template has its own set of slots for video and photo content, represented by “drop zones” in the

Theme Editor. Most templates have at least one of these; the maximum is six. Some also provide text captions and other parameters as required to customize special features.

The Theme Editor is split down the middle into two parts. On the left, a mini-Album provides access to your video and still image libraries; on the right is a customization panel. Here are the drop zones for your video and images, along with any text fields or other controls required by template parameters.

The left side of the Theme Editor tool contains a mini-Album with tabs for Videos and Photos only.

The right side contains the theme clip’s drop zones, and controls for setting its parameters. Drag video or image clips onto a drop zone from either the mini-

Album or the Movie Window. If necessary to create a longer subclip, you can also select multiple clips of contiguous video and drag them to the zone as a unit.

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 151

Working with drop zones

Clearing drop zones: To delete a subclip from its drop zone, right-click the zone and select Delete from the pop-up menu.

Copying subclips to the Movie Window: To copy a subclip from a drop zone in the Theme Editor to the

Timeline (or other Movie Window view), right-click the zone and select Add to Timeline from the menu.

This is normally used to add or modify an effect on the subclip before dragging it back into the theme clip.

Muting subclip audio: Some drop zones are marked with an audio symbol , indicating that the audio portion of any video in that zone will be included in the theme clip’s audio. If you don’t want the audio to be used, click the audio symbol to mute the subclip.

To set the start frame of a subclip, hold down the left mouse button while the pointer is over the drop zone, then drag horizontally. To allow fine trimming, the amount of change produced by a given mouse movement is at first small then becomes rapidly greater with increasing distance. A relatively large mouse gesture may therefore be required to get the desired adjustment.

Aligning subclips: Video in a drop zone can be positioned relative to the zone’s time window with the mouse. When the mouse pointer enters a drop zone with excess video available, it changes into a double-

headed arrow. Click and hold the left mouse button now to control the start of clip slider below the zone.

Move the mouse back and forth to set the starting frame of the subclip.

As you scroll the start of clip slider, the icon in the drop zone is updated to show the new starting frame.

At the same time, the Player shows the frame at the current scrubber position. If the drop zone you are working with is active at that time index, the preview will reflect any changes to the start frame. When you are fine tuning the start frame of a subclip, it’s a good idea to set the scrubber position to the location where the Player preview will be of the greatest assistance.

Using the start of clip slider changes neither the position of the subclip within the theme clip, nor its duration. Rather you are only choosing which excerpt of the subclip is used. The Theme Editor does not allow you to set the start of the subclip so late that the video would run out while the drop zone is still active. For example, if you drop a six-second segment onto a drop zone requiring five seconds of video, you will be able to set the start point no further than one second into the subclip.

If the subclip is actually shorter than the drop zone’s duration, or of equal length, no adjustment of its start frame is possible. When the theme clip displays, the last frame of the subclip is frozen if necessary to fill the time allocated to its drop zone.

Adding effects within drop zones

It is not possible to apply video or audio effects to a subclip within the Theme Editor itself. Instead, rightclick the drop zone and select Add to Timeline from the

Chapter 6: Montage

®

themes and theme editing 153

pop-up menu. Locate the clip on the Timeline (at the scrubber position). From this point in, it’s just another clip: trim it to taste, and add or edit effects in the usual way. Finally, drag it back to the drop zone, overwriting the previous contents. The copy of the clip on the

Timeline can now be deleted.

CHAPTER 7:

Video effects

Most video editing consists of selecting, ordering and trimming video clips, of connecting clips with transition effects and combining them with other materials such as music and still images.

Sometimes, though, you also need to modify the video images themselves, manipulating them in some way to achieve some desired effect. Studio’s Video effects tool provides an extensive set of plug-in video effects that can be applied either to video or still images. See page

166 for descriptions of the basic set of effects supplied with Studio.

The Video effects tool is the eighth tool in the

Video toolbox. It has two main areas: at the left, an effects list showing which effects are already attached to the currently-selected clip(s), and at the right, a parameters panel where you can tune the effect as required.

155 Chapter 7: Video effects

Video effects vs. audio effects

In most respects, the Video effects tool and the Audio effects tool work identically, except for the type of material they apply to.

Copying and pasting effects

Once you have added an effect to a clip, and configured it through its parameters panel, Studio provides the ability to apply it to other clips on the Movie Window

Timeline as well. This is a time-saver when you are working on a complex project that makes heavy use of effects, especially if you take advantage of the available keyboard shortcuts.

To copy an individual effect from a clip that has multiple effects, right-click directly on its clip icon and select the applicable command ( Copy ‘Magnify’ Effect in the illustration.) The effect, along with all of its parameters and keyframes (if any), then becomes available to be pasted to other clips in the project.

Working with the effects list

Each video or image clip in your project can be modified by one or more video effects. Each effect is

applied to the original image in turn, in the order in which they are listed on the Video effects tool.

The checkboxes next to each effect name allow you to enable and disable effects individually without having to remove them from the list (which would cause any customized parameter settings to be lost). In the above illustration, the “Water Drop” effect has been disabled while the other two effects on the list remain in force.

Adding and deleting effects

To add an effect to the list for the currently-selected clip (or clips), click the Add new effect button, which opens an effects browser on the right-hand side of the tool window.

Click an item in the browser’s Category list to display the names of the individual effects in that category.

Select the effect you want, then click the OK button to add the effect.

To remove the currently-selected effect from the list, click the delete effect (trashcan) button.

Premium video and audio effects, like other locked content in Studio, can be used freely, but cause a

“watermark” graphic to be added to the video when played back. If you want to use the effect in an actual production, you can purchase an activation key without leaving Studio. For information about purchasing locked video and audio effects, and other premium content for Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

Chapter 7: Video effects 157

The Video Effects browser is open here to the Studio

Ultimate RTFX page, which contains an additional set of effects for Studio Ultimate. The other packs listed contain other premium effects requiring separate purchase. The last ‘category’, More Effects, opens a page on the Pinnacle web-site where additional premium effects are available.

Changing the order of effects

The cumulative result of using more than one effect on the same clip can vary depending on the order in which the effects are applied. With the up and down arrow buttons to the right of the effects list, you can control the position of each effect in the processing chain. The buttons apply to the currently-selected effect.

Changing effect parameters

When an effect is selected in the effects list, the parameters panel on the right-hand side of the Video

effects tool window provides controls for adjusting the effect’s parameters, if any.

The controls for the basic library of effects supplied with Studio are described below (beginning on page

168). Add-on effects are described in their own on-line documentation, which you can access from the parameters panel by pressing function key F1 or clicking the help button parameters panel.

Note: Some plug-in effects may provide their own parameter windows with specialized controls. In those cases, the parameters panel on the effects tool displays a single Edit button, which accesses the external editor.

Using parameter presets

In order to simplify the use of parameters, many effects offer presets that let you configure an effect for a particular use simply by selecting a name from a list.

In Studio Ultimate, there are two kinds of preset: static , which store a single set of effect parameters, and keyframed , which store multiple sets of parameters in the form of keyframes (see below).

Chapter 7: Video effects 159

In versions of Studio that do not support keyframing only static presets are available.

Often, the quickest way to configure an effect is to start with the preset that comes closest to what you want, then fine-tune the parameters by hand.

Resetting effects: A special type of preset is the factory default setting of each effect. The default can be restored at any time by clicking the Reset button at the bottom of the parameters panel.

If Reset is clicked when keyframing is in use, the default parameter values are assigned only to the keyframe at the current movie position. That keyframe is created if it did not already exist.

Keyframing

The parameters for Studio video effects are ordinarily applied at the first frame of the video clip and continue unchanged to its end. This is the standard behavior for each effect you add to the clip.

Ordinarily, an effect’s parameter values do not vary throughout the video clip the effect belongs to.

Keyframing – the ability to change parameter values smoothly within a video clip – opens a wide range of new possibilities for using effects in your movies.

Availability note: The keyframing feature described here is provided in Studio Ultimate only.

Each keyframe stores a full set of parameter values for the effect, and specifies at which frame within the clip those values should be fully applied.

With keyframing, new sets of parameter values can be applied as often as desired throughout the clip.

Between keyframes, numeric parameter values are automatically adjusted from frame to frame to connect the keyframe values smoothly.

A graphical view of the keyframes in the example above. The values of Zoom (Z), Horizontal Position

(H) and Vertical Position (V) are set by keyframe 1 at the start of the clip, by keyframe 2 about a third of the way in, and by keyframe 3 at the end. The values change smoothly over intermediate frames.

Chapter 7: Video effects 161

Most effects support keyframing. A few do not, either because they have no parameters or because, as with the Speed effect, keyframing doesn’t readily apply.

Keyframing scenarios

For each applied effect, a clip may theoretically have as many keyframes as it has frames. In practice, you usually need only a few.

Two keyframes are enough to smoothly vary parameter values from one setting to another throughout the clip.

Keyframing gives you sensitive control over the way the effect is applied to the clip. It becomes a simple matter to ease an effect in and out, for example.

With a set of four keyframes you can ease in one or more parameter values at the start of a clip and ease them out again at the end.

A pan-and-zoom slideshow like that described in under “Editing image clip properties” (page 212) can be created using the Pan-and-Zoom effect on a single still-image clip. Two keyframes with identical parameters define the start and end of each view – however many are required – within the show.

Using keyframing

In the parameters window for any effect that supports keyframing, locate and check the Use keyframes box.

Until you do this, the effect maintains a single set of parameter values throughout the clip.

When you switch on keyframing for an effect, two keyframes are created automatically. One is anchored

Chapter 7: Video effects 163

to the start of the clip, and the other to its end. The parameters for both are set to the non-keyframed value.

On the Movie Window timeline, a keyframe appears as a numbered flag on the video clip. The keyframe flags are displayed as long as the effect’s parameter window remains open.

Keyframes for the effect currently open in the effect parameters window are shown as numbered flags over a vertical line. The current keyframe, if any, has a highlighted flag, like that of keyframe 3 here.

At the same time, additional controls are displayed at the bottom of the parameters window: the Add and

Delete buttons, the Current keyframe indicator with forward and back arrows, and the Keyframe time counter with jog arrows.

New controls appear at the bottom of the parameters window when keyframes are enabled.

The Current keyframe indicator shows the number of the keyframe attached to the frame you are viewing in the Movie Window. Use the arrows to advance from keyframe to keyframe. As you click, the

Movie Window scrubber jumps to the next keyframe position.

When you are viewing frames of your movie for which no keyframe has been defined, the indicator shows a dash. The displayed parameter values are those that will apply to the current frame during playback.

To create a keyframe at any such point, click the Add button, or simply start to adjust the parameters: when you do, Studio adds a keyframe automatically.

Keyframes are numbered in sequence from the start of the clip. When a new keyframe is inserted, or an old one is deleted, those that come after are renumbered to correct the sequence.

The Delete button is available whenever the current frame has a keyframe; that is, whenever the Current keyframe indicator shows a number rather than a dash.

The Keyframe time counter shows the time offset within the clip of the current movie time – the frame showing in the Player. The first keyframe is therefore at time zero, and the last is at an offset equal to one frame less than the duration of the clip.

When the current frame has a keyframe, its time offset can be changed with the counter’s jog arrows. The positions of the first and last keyframes cannot be adjusted. Others can move freely between the current positions of their neighboring keyframes.

Chapter 7: Video effects

Setting the time of keyframe 3.

165

Previewing and rendering

While you are working with the Video effects tool, choosing effects and adjusting parameter settings, the

Player gives a dynamically-updated preview of the current frame in your movie. Previewing a single frame may not be very revealing when you are working with effects that evolve over the duration of the clip (like the

Water drop effect, page 177).In those cases, you will need to play back the clip to see the full impact of the effect you are applying.

Because many effects require intensive calculation, a fully smooth and detailed preview of the full clip won’t be instantaneously available in most cases. Each time effects are added or removed, or settings are changed,

Studio commences “rendering” the clip – recalculating its final appearance – in the background without interrupting your workflow. A colored bar appears in the Timescale above the clip while background rendering is in progress.

Background rendering is optional. You can disable it, if required, in the Project preferences options panel

( Setup

¾

Project Preferences ).

™

V

IDEO EFFECTS LIBRARY

The plug-in video effects installed with Studio are divided into six categories, each symbolized by an icon:

Cleaning effects help correct defects in the source video, such as noise and camera shake.

Time effects , like Speed , change the tempo of playback without affecting the appearance of the video frames themselves.

• Style effects like Emboss and Old film let you apply distinctive visual styles for added impact.

• Overlay effects support the overlay features of

Studio, such as Picture-in-picture and Chroma key .

Fun effects like Water drop and Lens flare provide extra scope for creativity and fun in your movies.

• Color effects let you modify the coloration of a clip, whether subtly or dramatically.

Plug-in effects are organized into packs of one or more effects each. In this manual, we cover the nine effects in the Studio HD RTFX pack (see page 168), which is included with all versions of Studio. Further on, we briefly describe each of the more than 20 additional effects in the Ultimate RTFX pack (page 172), which is included with Studio Ultimate.

Full documentation of the parameters for the Ultimate effects is included in their context-sensitive on-line help, which can be viewed by clicking the help button at the top left of the parameters panel for each effect, or by pressing the F1 key when the panel is open.

Building your effects library

Studio’s plug-in architecture means that you can continue to add new effects to your video effects library as they become available. Expansion packs of effects from Pinnacle and other vendors will integrate seamlessly with the program.

Chapter 7: Video effects 167

Some expansion effects are shipped with Studio as locked, premium content. These include Pinnacle’s

RTFX Volume 1 and 2 packs. Such effects can be previewed in Studio as usual, but are “watermarked” with a special graphic during playback.

Purchasing an activation key will remove the watermark. This can be done without leaving Studio.

For more information about obtaining premium content for Studio, see “Expanding Studio” on page 12.

Warning: Studio’s plug-in video effects are computer programs. They are theoretically capable of actions with the potential to damage or disrupt your system, such as modifying or deleting files and editing the system registry. Pinnacle advises against installing third-party plug-ins except those from trusted vendors.

™

S

TANDARD EFFECTS

This section describes six of the effects included in the

Studio HD RTFX group at the top the Studio effects browser. The others are covered elsewhere: Chroma key on page 193, Pan and zoom on page 218, and

Picture-in-picture on page 188.

Cleaning effects

Auto color correction , Noise reduction and Stabilize are classified as cleaning effects , which help correct defects in the source video, such as noise and camera shake. Keep in mind that these are effects are generalpurpose filters designed to reduce the most common

problems found on a wide range of material. They are not a panacea. Your results will vary depending on the original material and the severity and nature of the problems.

Auto color correction

This effect compensates for incorrect color balance in your video. The idea is similar to the “white balance” setting on a camcorder.

Brightness: Color correction may affect the brightness of the image. You can apply a manual correction, if needed, with this slider. (Technically, the control modifies the “contrast gamma” of the image rather than its actual brightness.)

Note: The Auto color correction effect may introduce video noise into the clip as a side-effect of processing.

If this happens to a troublesome degree, add on the

Noise reduction effect described below.

Dream glow

Applied to the right material, this effect suffuses the scene with a spectral glow suggestive of altered reality.

Adjustable Blur and Glow parameters let you fine tune the appearance. Glow is a uniform brightness boost. As its level increases, the lighter parts of the image are replaced by expanding whited-out regions as the maximum brightness level is reached or exceeded.

Chapter 7: Video effects 169

An outdoor scene with (L) and without (R) the

Dream glow effect.

Rotate

This effect allows rotation of the entire video frame, and also provides controls for independent horizontal and vertical scaling.

Full-frame 180° rotation (L); rotation with differential scaling, to produce a simple perspective effect (R).

Noise reduction

This plug-in applies a noise-reduction algorithm that may improve the appearance of noisy video. In order to minimize artifacts (image defects caused as a sideeffect of image processing), noise reduction is only performed in areas of the frame where the amount of motion falls beneath a certain threshold value.

Motion threshold: This slider governs the threshold value. Moving the slider rightwards increases the amount of motion the effect will tolerate, thus tending to increase the proportion of the image that will be affected. At the same time, the danger of introducing unacceptable artifacts into the video is also increased.

Stabilize

Like the electronic image stabilization feature in many digital camcorders, this effect minimizes any jerkiness or jitter caused by camera movement. The edge areas of the image are discarded, and the central portion is magnified by about 20% to fill the frame. By adjusting the boundaries of the selected region on a frame-byframe basis, Studio is able to compensate for the unwanted camera motion.

Stabilize works by expanding a selected area (inner lines) to full-frame size. The area is adjusted from frame to frame to compensate for slight aiming differences caused by camera shake.

Speed

This sophisticated effect allows you to set the speed of any video clip over a continuous range from 10 to 500 percent of normal, in either forward or reverse motion.

The length of the clip changes as you vary its speed.

Chapter 7: Video effects 171

If the clip contains audio, that too is sped up or slowed down. The option of maintaining the original pitch lets you avoid the sudden introduction of cartoon voices into your soundtrack.

™

U

LTIMATE EFFECTS

The Studio Ultimate RTFX pack of video effects is included with Studio Ultimate. Users of other Studio versions can obtain the effects by upgrading to Studio

Ultimate.

This section gives a brief description of each effect in the group, except:

• Two of the Overlay effects are covered elsewhere

( Chroma key on page 193, and Picture-in-picture on page 188).

• The HFX Filter effect, which allows you to create and edit animated 3D transitions with Pinnacle’s

Hollywood FX software, opens externally to

Studio, and provides its own on-line help. HFX

Filter uses a special Pinnacle category icon.

The effects appear here in the same order as they do in the effects browser, where they are sorted by category

(see page 166). Full descriptions, including all parameters, are available in the context-sensitive help when the effect parameters window is open in Studio

Ultimate.

Blur

Adding blur to your video produces a result similar to shooting out of focus. Studio’s Blur effect allows you to add separate intensities of horizontal and vertical blurring over the whole frame or any rectangular region within it. You can easily blur out only a selected portion of the image, such as a person’s face, an effect familiar from TV news coverage.

Emboss

This specialized effect simulates the look of an embossed or bas-relief sculpture. The strength of the effect is controlled by the Amount slider.

Emboss can often be enhanced by adjusting contrast and brightness with the Color Correction effect (right).

Old film

Old movies have a number of traits that are usually considered undesirable: grainy images caused by early

Chapter 7: Video effects 173

photographic development processes, spots and streaks from dust and lint adhering to the film, and intermittent vertical lines where the film has been scratched during projection.

The Old film effect lets you simulate these defects to lend your pristine video the appearance of movies that have suffered the ravages of time.

Soften

The Soften effect applies a gentle blurring to your video. This can be helpful for anything from adding a romantic haze to minimizing wrinkles. A slider controls the strength of the effect.

Stained glass

This effect simulates the appearance of viewing the video through a pane of irregular polygons arranged into a mosaic.

Sliders let you control the average dimensions of the polygonal “tiles” in the image and the width of the dark

edging between neighboring tiles from zero (no edging) to the maximum value.

Three variations of the Stained Glass effect

Luma key

This overlay effect works very similarly to Chroma

Key (page 193), but in this case the transparent areas of the foreground image are defined by luminance rather than color information.

2D Editor

Use this effect to enlarge the image and set which portion of it will be displayed, or to shrink the image and optionally add a border and shadow.

Earthquake

The Studio Ultimate Earthquake effect jiggles the video frame to simulate a seismic event, whose severity you control with sliders for speed and intensity.

Chapter 7: Video effects 175

Lens flare

This effect simulates the flaring seen when direct bright light overexposes an area of a film or video image.

You can set the orientation, size and type of the main light. The first option of those shown below lets you remove the light, though its secondary effects – rays and reflections – are still generated.

The eight Type options.

Magnify

This effect lets you apply a virtual magnifying lens to a selected portion of the video frame. You can position the lens in three dimensions, moving it horizontally and vertically within the frame, and nearer to or further from the image.

Motion blur

This effect simulates the blurring that results when a camera is moved rapidly during exposure. Both the angle and the amount of blurring can be set.

Water drop

This effect simulates the impact of a drop falling onto the surface of water, producing expanding, concentric ripples.

Stages in the Water Drop effect (“Big drop” preset).

Water wave

This effect adds distortion to simulate a series of ocean waves passing across the video frame as the clip progresses. Parameters allow you to adjust the number, spacing, direction and depth of the waves.

Black and white

This effect subtracts some or all of the color information from the source video, with results ranging from partly desaturated (the “Faded” preset) to fully monochrome (“Black and white”). The Amount slider controls the strength of the effect.

Color correction

The four sliders in the parameters panel for this effect control the coloration of the current clip in terms of:

Brightness: The intensity of light

Chapter 7: Video effects 177

Contrast: The range of light and dark values

Hue: The location of light on the spectrum

Saturation: The quantity of pure color, from gray to fully saturated

Color map

This effect colorizes an image using a pair of blend ramps, or color maps. Stylize your footage with bold color treatments, add duotone and tritone style colorization, or create striking editorial transitions.

Color map can be used for anything from fine control of monochrome images to psychedelic color transformations.

Invert

Despite its name, the Invert effect doesn’t turn the display upside-down. Rather than the image itself, it is the color values in the image that are inverted: each pixel is redrawn in its complementary light intensity and/or color, producing a readily recognizable but recolored image.

This effect uses the YCrCb color model, which has one channel for luminance (brightness information) and two channels for chrominance (color information). The

YCrCb model is often used in digital video applications.

Lighting

The Lighting tool enables correction and enhancement of existing video that was shot with poor or insufficient lighting. It is particularly suitable for fixing backlit outdoor sequences in which the subject’s features are in shadow.

Posterize

This Studio Ultimate effect lets you control the number of colors used to render each frame of the clip, all the way from the full original palette down to two colors

(black and white) as you drag the Amount slider from left to right. Regions of similar color are coalesced into larger flat areas as the palette shrinks.

RGB color balance

RGB Color Balance in Studio Ultimate serves a dual role. On the one hand, you can use it to correct video that suffers from unwanted coloration. On the other, it allows you to apply a color bias to achieve a particular effect. For example, a night scene can often be heightened by adding blue and slightly reducing overall brightness. You can even make video shot in daylight look like a night scene.

Chapter 7: Video effects 179

Sepia

This Studio Ultimate effect imparts the appearance of antique photography to the clip by rendering it in sepia tones rather than full color. The strength of the effect is controlled with the Amount slider.

White balance

Most video cameras have a “white balance” option for automatically adjusting their color response to ambient lighting conditions. If this option is switched off or not fully effective, the coloration of the video image will suffer.

Studio’s White balance effect corrects the problem by allowing you to specify which color should be taken as

“white” in this image. The adjustment needed to make that reference color white is then applied to every pixel of the image. If the reference white is well chosen, this can make the coloration seem more natural.

CHAPTER 8

:

Two-track editing

Studio provides the power of multitrack video editing to Studio through an auxiliary video track on the Movie

Window Timeline called the overlay track. With it you can use advanced picture-in-picture and chroma-key effects while retaining the convenience of Studio’s streamlined and intuitive user interface.

Introducing the overlay track

Upon installation, the Timeline displays the five tracks familiar to long-time Studio users: the video track with its original audio track, and the title , sound effect and music tracks.

To open the overlay track, drag a video clip from the

Album n

into the Movie Window and drop it on the title track o

. The overlay track instantly appears with the clip properly positioned upon it p

.

Drop video on the title track to open the overlay track.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 181

Along with the overlay track, Studio adds an overlay audio track to accommodate the video clip’s original audio information.

Once the overlay video and audio tracks have been opened, Studio no longer accepts video clips on the title track. Drag clips from the Album directly onto either the video or overlay track as required.

Video clips on the video and overlay tracks.

Displaying and hiding the overlay track

As we have just seen, the overlay video and audio tracks are displayed when you add your first overlay clip. Similarly, when you remove the last clip from these tracks, Studio again hides them from view.

This default behavior help keep the Movie Window uncluttered, but if you are making frequent use of overlay video, you might prefer to have the track visible at all times. This can be achieved by activating the Always show overlay track command on the pop-up

“context” menu that appears when you click on the

Movie Window with your right mouse button.

A/B editing

The second video track in Studio Ultimate often simplifies the editing tasks – insert edits, L-cuts and Jcuts – discussed under “Advanced Timeline editing” on page 126.

An insert edit , for instance, becomes a trivial operation: simply drag the clip to be inserted onto the overlay track, and trim it as desired. (See “The Picture-inpicture tool” below if you want the second video to appear at reduced size so that only part of the main video is obscured.)

An insert edit on the overlay track. The main video is obscured while the B clip is playing.

In the J-cut and the L-cut, the audio portion of a clip begins a little before (J) or a little after (L) the video.

They are often used together to soften the start and end of an inserted clip.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 183

Split editing on the overlay track. The overlay video track has been locked, allowing the B clip’s audio to be trimmed. The main audio can be reduced or muted as needed.

The Picture-in-picture tool

Picture-in-picture (often abbreviated to “PIP”) – the inclusion of an additional video frame within the main video – is a versatile effect familiar from its use in professional TV productions.

Picture-in-picture with optional border, shadow and rounded corners (left). Split-screen effects, like the vertical split at right, are among the variations that show off the versatility of the PIP tool.

To use picture-in-picture, start in the usual way by dragging some video clips onto the Movie Window

Timeline. Drop the clips you want for background video onto the video track. The foreground clip – the

PIP clip – goes on the overlay track underneath the main clip.

Note: If you are planning a split-screen effect, like the one shown at right in the illustration above, it doesn’t matter which of the two clips goes on which track.

With the clips in place, select the foreground clip and open the Picture-in-picture and Chroma key

(PIP/CK) tool. It is the seventh tool in the Movie

Window’s video toolbox. We usually refer to the two aspects of the tool separately as the Picture-in-picture and the Chroma key tools.

The Picture-in-picture and Chroma key (PIP/CK) tool is really two tools in one. Because they are used independently, we treat them as separate tools. This illustration shows the PIP side of the tool. Click the

Chroma Key tab at the top of the tool to switch.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 185

Picture-in-picture tool controls

Most of the left-hand side of the PIP tool is taken up with an interactive layout area where you can both view and modify the dimensions, placement and cropping of the overlay video. The adjustments that you make are reflected in the Player preview as you work.

The layout area has two modes, selected by the Scale and Crop radio buttons.

Scale mode: The gray, checked region in the layout area represents the transparent portion of the overlay frame, through which any underlying video can be seen. In typical PIP usage, this accounts for most of the screen, the overlay being sized small enough that the main video is not unnecessarily obscured. You can modify the PIP frame in three ways:

Click on the PIP frame and drag it within the layout area to reposition it within the main video frame.

• Use the center control points on the edges of the PIP frame to change its dimensions arbitrarily.

Use the control points at the corners of the PIP frame to change its size but not its proportions (“aspect ratio”).

Crop mode: In this mode the layout area represents the entire overlay frame, regardless of its actual dimensions as set in Scale mode. The rectangle defined by the control points shows which portion of the frame is visible. Outside the visible area, the frame is semitransparent, letting the checked pattern show through.

As in Scale mode, the side control points allow for free adjustment of the crop rectangle, whereas the corner control points preserve its aspect ratio.

The PIP tool in Scale (L) and Crop (R) modes.

Presets: Choose a preset name to set up all the PIP controls at once to the predetermined values associated with that name. You can choose a preset as a first approximation to your desired settings, then adjust them manually until you get exactly what you want.

Transparency: Use this slider if you want the underlying video to show through the overlay itself.

Moving the slider to the right makes the overlay, with its border and shadow, increasingly transparent.

Border: These controls set the color, width and transparency of the border that will be drawn around the overlay frame. Set the width to zero (slider all the way to the left) if you don’t want a border at all. See page 196 for information on how to use the color controls.

The Softness slider controls the amount of blurring on the outside edge of the border. Move the slider left for a hard edge, or right to blend the border with the background video. Check the Rounded corners box if you want to round off the corners of the PIP rectangle.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 187

Shadow: These controls set the color, width, angle and transparency of the drop shadow effect that gives the illusion of the overlay frame floating above the background video. Set the width (using the Distance slider) to zero if you don’t want a shadow to appear.

The dial-shaped shadow-angle control gives you eight choices for the placement of the shadow relative to the frame.

Enable picture-in-picture: This checkbox allows you to turn the PIP effect on and off.

Apply to new clips: This option is handy when you want to set up the same PIP settings for a number of different clips. As long the option is checked, PIP will automatically be applied to each new clip that you drag onto the overlay track, using the same settings that were displayed the last time the tool was open.

The PIP effect interface

If you prefer to enter your PIP parameter settings numerically rather than graphically, you can turn to an alternative interface provided by the Video effects tool.

You can also combine the two methods, using the PIP tool’s graphical interface to specify the initial settings, then fine tuning them with the numerical effect parameters.

The available parameter settings of the Picture-inpicture effect are almost identical to those offered by the PIP tool:

Position: The Horizontal and Vertical sliders set the offset of the center of the PIP frame from the center of the background frame.

Parameter settings for the Picture-in-picture effect.

Size: The Width and Height sliders set the size of the

PIP frame as a percentage of its original dimensions.

Cropping, if used, can further reduce the final size of the PIP frame on the screen.

Cropping: The four sliders in this group trim away a percentage of the original PIP video frame, allowing you to remove unnecessary portions of the image and focus on the main subject.

Video: The Transparency slider lets the background video show through the PIP overlay to any desired degree.

Border: The parameters in this group are equivalent to the Border settings on the PIP tool, allowing you to set the overlay border’s color, thickness, transparency and edge softness, and to select the rounded corners option if desired. One bonus of the effect interface is that there are separate Width and Height controls to control the border thickness, rather than the single setting provided by the tool.

Shadow: As with the Border group, these parameters are essentially the same as those on the PIP tool, except that the Horizontal offset and Vertical offset parameters afford slightly more flexibility in positioning the shadow than do the tool’s Distance and Angle settings.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 189

The Chroma key tool

Chroma key is a widely-used technique that allows foreground objects to appear in a video scene even though they were not present – and often could not have been present – when the scene was shot. When an action star tumbles into a volcano, or battles a giant cockroach, or saves the crew with a daring space-walk, the chances are that chroma key or a related technology was involved in the scene.

Chroma key effects are often called “blue-screen” or

“green-screen” effects because the foreground action is shot in front of a uniform blue or green background.

The background is then electronically removed, leaving only the foreground action to be superimposed on the actual background of the final scene, which has been separately prepared.

Blue and green are the generally-preferred colors for chroma key use because their removal from an image will not affect human skin tones, but in principle any hue can be used with Studio’s chroma key tool.

Creating a scene with chroma key: A clip on the video track (L) is chosen as the background for a green-screen clip on the overlay track (C). Chroma keying removes the green to complete the scene (R).

As with picture-in-picture, the first step in using chroma key is to drag some video clips onto the

Timeline. Drop the clips you want for background video onto the video track. The foreground clip, which should have a uniform, highly-saturated background like the center clip in the illustration above, goes on the overlay track below the main clip.

With the clips in place, select the foreground clip and open the Picture-in-picture and Chroma key

(PIP/CK) tool. It is the seventh tool in the Movie

Window’s video toolbox. Select the Chroma key tab to display the controls you will need.

The chroma key side of the PIP/CK tool.

Chroma-key tool controls

The chroma key tool constructs a “mask”, shown in the

Key channel graphic on the left side of the tool, where the transparent part of the frame is drawn in black, and the opaque part – the part you will see in the final video

– is drawn in white. Most of the remaining controls are used to define exactly which areas of the frame will be included in the transparent part of the mask by setting the “key color” and related properties.

Transparency: Use this slider if you want the underlying video to show through the normally opaque overlay. Moving the slider to the right makes the overlay, with its border and shadow, increasingly transparent.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 191

Presets: The tool provides two presets, called “Green screen key” and “Blue screen key”. These provide good starting points for setting up the tool if you are using one of the standard chroma key colors.

Key color: Use the color swatch or eye dropper buttons to select the color that will be removed from the video frame leaving only the desired foreground. See page

196 for information on how to use the color controls.

Rather than an actual color, you are really selecting only a hue , without regard to the other properties – saturation and intensity – that in combination with hue make a complete color specification. The chosen hue is shown by the position of the highlighted region on the circumference of the color circle display.

The color circle on the Chroma key tool highlights a range of hues (around the circumference) and color saturation values (along the radius). Any pixel in the overlay frame whose hue and saturation fall within the highlighted region will be treated as transparent.

Color tolerance: This slider controls the width of the range of hues that will be recognized as belonging to the “key color”. Moving the slider to the right increases the angle of the arc covered by the highlighted region on the color circle.

Saturation minimum: Saturation is the amount of hue in a color. A pixel with zero saturation (corresponding to the center of the color circle) has no hue: it falls on

the “gray scale”, whose extremes are white and black.

Chroma key works most effectively when the background is highly and uniformly saturated, allowing a high setting of this slider. In the real world, vagaries of lighting and apparatus often result in a background that falls short of the ideal. Moving the slider left allows a wider range of saturation values to be matched, indicated by a highlighted region that extends farther towards the center of the color circle.

Softness: This slider controls the density of the underlying video. When it is positioned all the way to the left, the main video is entirely black. As you move the slider to the right, the main video is brought up to full density.

Spill suppression: Adjusting this slider may help suppress video noise or fringing along the edges of the foreground object.

Enable chroma keying: This checkbox allows you to turn the chroma key effect on and off.

Apply to new clips: This option is handy when you want to set up the same chroma key settings for a number of different clips. As long as the option is checked, chroma key will automatically be applied to each new clip that you drag onto the overlay track, using the same settings that were displayed the last time the tool was open.

The chroma key effect interface

If you prefer to enter your chroma key parameter settings numerically rather than graphically, you can turn to an alternative interface provided by the Video effects tool. You can also combine the two methods, using the chroma key tool’s graphical interface to specify the initial settings, then fine tuning them with the numerical effect parameters.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 193

The Chroma key plug-in provides parameter settings almost identical to those offered by the chroma key tool, but provides one more option, Invert Key . When this option is activated, the normally opaque parts of the key are treated as transparent, and the transparent parts as opaque, so that the underlying video shows through everywhere except for the area masked by the colored screen.

Parameter settings for the Chroma key effect.

The chroma key tool provides a special view of the transparency key it has generated. To get this view in the Player while working with the effect parameters, click the Show Key checkbox.

Using Show Key: At left the key, at right the real thing.

Chroma key tips

No matter how good your software may be, successful use of chroma key depends on carefully setting up your shot, and may require experimentation to get the details just right. Here are some tips to get you started:

Light the backdrop as evenly as possible: Very often, background coloring that looks flat to the naked eye will prove on playback to have areas that are too dark or too washed out to work well for chroma keying, which favors even, saturated color. Use multiple lights on the backdrop to ensure that it is well-lit across its whole area and without hotspots. Diffuse sunlight, as produced by a light overcast sky, can work well when shooting out of doors is an option.

Don’t let the subject shadow the screen: Arrange your subject and foreground lighting so that no shadows fall across the backdrop. The subject should be not less than one meter (three feet) in front of the backdrop.

Setting up a chroma key shot. The backdrop is well and evenly lit, and positioned well behind the subject so that shadows do not interfere. The lighting of the subject should be arranged to suit the background that will be keyed into the shot.

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 195

Choose foreground colors carefully: Don’t have your subject wear green if you are shooting on a green screen, or blue for a blue screen; those areas will be removed if they are taken to match the key color. You have to be especially careful about this when working with less even backdrops that require you to set a wider color tolerance in the chroma keyer.

Make a smooth profile: Chroma keyers do better with a smooth edge than a jagged or complex one, so try to have your subject present a smooth profile to the camera. Hair is particularly tricky, and should be slicked down if possible. If the subject can wear a hat, so much the better.

Use tight framing: The wider your frame, the larger your background needs to be, and the more difficult it is to control your shot. One way to keep things simple is to shoot your subject from the waist up rather than in full view.

Note: A professional background cloth for chroma key work is available as an inexpensive purchase at the

Pinnacle web-site .

Selecting colors

To select colors in tools and effects that provide a color parameter, click either on the color swatch (left) or the eye dropper button. The first

opens a standard color picker dialog; while the second lets you choose a color by clicking anywhere on the screen.

Two ways to set colors: The Windows color picker dialog (L) opens when you click the color swatch button provided in some tools and effects. Click the eye-dropper button to select a color from the Player preview window or elsewhere using a mouse pointer in the form of an eye-dropper (R).

Chapter 8: Two-track editing 197

CHAPTER 9:

Transitions

A transition is an animated effect that eases – or emphasizes – the passage from one clip to the next.

Fades, wipes and dissolves are common types of transition. Others are more exotic, and may even involve sophisticated 3-D graphics.

Transitions are stored in their own section of the

Album (see “The Transitions section” on page 78). To use a transition, drag it from the Album into the Movie

Window and drop it beside any video clip, theme clip or still image. (You can also apply transitions directly to audio clips. See “Transitions on the audio tracks” on page 315.)

A series of transitions (the icons between the video clips) in Storyboard view.

In Timeline view, you can drop the transition on either the main video track, the overlay track, or the title track. On the video track, the transition provides a

Chapter 9: Transitions 199

bridge between two full-screen clips (or between one clip and blackness if the transition has only one neighbor, as at the beginning of the movie). On the overlay and title tracks, the transition bridges two neighboring clips (or one clip and transparency).

Diagram: Five snapshots from the life of a 2-second diagonal wipe transition.

If a transition is to last for two seconds (the default transition duration in a fresh Studio installation), the second clip begins to run two seconds before the first clip is finished. At the outset, only the first clip is visible; by the end, the second clip has completely replaced the first.

The details of what happens in between, as the first clip is gradually removed and the second gradually appears, depend on the transition type. Since the video clips overlap, the total duration of the pair of clips is reduced by the duration of the transition.

Here is the same transition as above, this time using actual video. For clarity, the transition boundary in the three center frames has been emphasized in white. Both clips continue to run while the transition is in progress.

Transition types and their uses

Like all effects, transitions should be used not for their own sake but to serve the overall needs of your movie.

Well-chosen transitions can subtly reinforce the meaning of the movie and how it plays without drawing attention to themselves. Observing the way transitions are used in professionally-produced video on television will suggest many ways to improve your own movies. Generally, it is advisable to refrain from overusing transitions that cause abrupt changes or otherwise draw attention to themselves: there’s a big difference between a subtle dissolve and a heart-shaped wipe.

The basic transitions discussed below – fades, dissolves, wipes, slides and pushes – are all among the first group of standard transitions (the “2D transitions”) in the Album.

A set of more elaborate transitions is found in the

Alpha Magic group, which is the second entry in the dropdown list of transition groups in the Album.

The many other groups on the list all belong to the

Hollywood FX, a large set of complex transitions featuring three-dimensional graphics. The Hollywood

FX transitions are discussed at the end of this section

(page 203).

Cut: A cut is the minimal transition – an instantaneous shift from one scene to the next. In Studio, it is the default transition. A cut is appropriate when there is a strong inherent connection between one clip and the

Chapter 9: Transitions 201

next; for instance, when the camera changes position or angle within a scene.

Fade: This transition fades into the beginning of a video clip from a black screen, or from the end of a clip to a black screen. A fade dropped between two clips creates a fade down followed by a fade up . The fade transition is the first transition icon in the Album.

A fade is usually used at the beginning and end of a movie, or when there is a large break in continuity, as when a new section begins. For example, a movie of a play might benefit from inserting a fade between acts.

Dissolve: A dissolve is similar to a fade, except that the new scene begins to fade up even while the old one is fading down. The visual overlap this produces is less dramatic than a fade, but less abrupt than a cut. A short dissolve can take the edge off a cut, while a long dissolve is useful to suggest the passage of time.

Wipe, slide and push: In each of these standard transition types, the incoming video is gradually revealed behind an edge that moves across the frame in a certain direction. The Album icons shown with this paragraph represent a leftward wipe, a down-and-left slide and a rightward push respectively.

In a wipe transition, both the old and new video occupy their normal position in the frame throughout the transition. The new video comes into view as the transition edge crosses the frame, rather like new wallpaper being rolled on over old.

A slide is similar to a wipe, but in this case the frame of the new video slides across the screen until it reaches

its home position. The effect is reminiscent of a blind being pulled down over a window.

A push is similar to a slide, except that the old video is pushed out of the frame as the new video enters, like advancing a filmstrip from one frame to the next.

Hollywood FX for Studio

Pinnacle Systems’ Hollywood FX includes a large number of dramatic 3-D transitions and effects. These are ideal for opening sequences, sports and action footage, or music videos. Hollywood FX satisfies professional expectations for quality without sacrificing ease of use.

A basic set of fully-functional Hollywood FX is included with Studio, and many more are available for purchase online. For more information, see “Expanding

Studio” on page 12.

Also available for purchase on-line is the HFX Creator editing tool for Hollywood FX. This software lets you customize your Hollywood FX, or create new ones from scratch. HFX Creator includes advanced keyframe editing for flight paths and all parameters, powerful warp plug-ins, and a 3D text generator. You can also create a wide range of 3D MultiWindow Effects using external video sources, and add real-life 3D objects and lighting.

To initiate the purchase of HFX

Creator, click the Edit button in the

Clip properties tool for any Hollywood

FX transition.

Chapter 9: Transitions 203

Previewing transitions in your movie

Studio lets you preview transitions in the Player. Just drag and drop a transition into the Movie Window, click the Play button (or hit [Space]) and see how the transition works with your material.

You can also preview transitions by scrubbing through them in the Player or on the Timeline of the Movie

Window.

Background rendering of Hollywood FX

Background rendering is an optional feature in which the computation needed to create a detailed preview of

Hollywood FX transitions and other effects is carried out as a “background task” with no interruption of your workflow. You can configure background rendering on the Video and audio preferences options panel ( Setup

¾

Video and Audio Preferences ). See “Video and audio preferences” on page 352 for details.

Until the rendering of a transition is complete, the

Player will preview it at reduced resolution and frame rate. A colored bar appears in the Timescale above the clip while background rendering is in progress.

Audio transitions

Video clips in the Movie Window normally have synchronous audio. In the absence of a transition, both video and audio cut from one clip to the next. When a

transition is placed between two clips, the audio crossfades (the audio equivalent of a dissolve).

The only exception to this rule is the Fade transition, which takes the audio completely out then back in again.

Normal transitions cause a cross-fade in the audio (left). In a Fade transition

(right), the audio fades down then up along with the video.

The Ripple Transition command

This Studio feature is especially useful for creating a quick slideshow from a set of still images, or a video pictorial from a set of short clips. Such a presentation is more interesting if you connect each pair of clips with a transition. Ripple Transition gives you a quick and easy way of achieving that.

Begin with a set of a clips on the Timeline, then add a transition of the desired type between the first two clips.

Now select all the clips except the first, click on any of them with the right mouse-button, and select Ripple

Transition from the pop-up menu.

Chapter 9: Transitions 205

Studio inserts a duplicate of the original transition between each pair of selected clips.

™

T

RIMMING TRANSITIONS

Although transitions are not true clips, they are handled very similarly to clips within Studio’s editing environment. Like clips, you can trim transitions either directly on the Movie Window Timeline, or by using the Clip properties tool.

See “Trimming on the Timeline using handles” on page

117 for a discussion of the first method. The maximum allowed duration of a transition is one frame less than the shorter of the neighboring clips.

Trimming with the Clip properties tool

The Toolbox

¾

Modify Clip Properties menu command invokes the Clip properties tool for the selected clip. For all transition types, this tool provides previewing controls, and the ability to set two properties:

To set the duration of the transition, change the value in the Duration counter. A transition’s duration must always be less – if only by a single frame – than the shorter of its neighboring clips.

• The Name text field lets you assign a custom name to the clip to replace the default one assigned by Studio.

The Name field is provided on the Clip properties tool for all clip types. Clip names are used by the

Movie Window’s List view, and can also be viewed as fly-by labels when your mouse hovers over clips in the Storyboard view.

Many transition effects also support a “reverse direction” option, which causes the transition animation to run backwards, allowing a rotary wipe, for example, to be either clockwise or counterclockwise. The

Reverse checkbox is enabled when the current transition supports this option.

If you have purchased the HFX Creator application, you can open it within Studio by clicking the Edit button on the Clip properties tool for Hollywood FX transitions. HFX Creator is an external editing program with many options, whose use is described in its accompanying documentation.

Chapter 9: Transitions 207

Previewing in the Clip properties tool

The Clip properties tool provides previewing controls for transitions similar to those for video clips. See

“Trimming with the Clip properties tool” on page 122 for more information.

The preview areas show the last full frame of the outgoing clip and the first full frame of the incoming one. The preview frames update as you edit the

Duration field.

The transport controls let you preview the transition effect in the Player either frame by frame or at full speed. The Loop play/Pause button cycles through the transition repeatedly at normal playback speed.

Both the counter (with its associated jog buttons) and the scrubber give you direct access to any desired point within the transition.

CHAPTER 10:

Still images

Video usually means images in motion, but most productions also include stationary titles or graphics, and may include other types of still image as well.

The still images you can use in your movies include:

• All types of text captions and graphics, including scrolling credits and “crawled” messages.

Photos or drawings stored in disk-based image files.

Individual video frames obtained with the grabber tool.

Frame

• “Disc menus” for DVD, BD and VCD authoring.

These specialized images are covered in Chapter 11:

Disc menus .

Any of these still image types can be treated in either of two ways, depending on which track you drop them onto in the Movie Window Timeline:

• To add a full-screen image with a solid background, add the image to the video track.

• To add an image so that it appears in your movie with a transparent background , superimposed over the clips on the video track, place it on the title track.

To be used in this way, the image must be in either

TIFF ( tif ) or PNG ( png ) format, with the transparent

Chapter 10: Still images 209

area defined by means of an alpha channel as this format allows.

Note: Studio provides an additional option, the overlay track, for adding your images to the Timeline. See

Chapter 8: Two-track editing , for details.

The Album has separate sections for titles, bitmapped images and disc menus. All these resources are stored as separate files on your hard drive. You can also create titles and disc menus of your own in one of Studio’s title editors and add them directly to your movie without first saving them as separate files (see Chapter

12: The Classic Title Editor , and Chapter 13: The

Motion Titler ). Similarly, still video frames can be added directly from the Frame grabber tool (see “The

Frame Grabber” on page 219).

Full-screen images

A full-screen image is one that is placed on the video track. It fills the entire screen, replacing the video.

When the preceding video clip ends, Studio plays the still image clip. The visual effect is that the video ends, and is replaced by the graphic until the next clip begins.

Overlay images

An overlay image is one that is placed on the title track.

It is superimposed on the current video clip, without

replacing the video. The transparent area of the image must be defined by means of an alpha channel.

Making a slideshow

If you would like to assemble a quick slideshow of still images or video clips, you may want to take advantage of Studio’s Ripple Transition feature to quickly insert a chosen transition between each pair of clips or images.

See page 205 for details.

Applying effects

Most of Studio’s plug-in video effects can be applied to still images. (The exceptions are effects like Speed that only make sense for moving video.) See “Using video effects” on page 155 for detailed information.

™

E

DITING STILL IMAGES

As with other types of clip, you can trim still images directly on the Movie Window Timeline, or by using the Clip properties tool.

See “Trimming on the Timeline using handles” on page

117 for a discussion of the first method. The difference with a still image clip is that you can extend it to any

Chapter 10: Still images 211

duration you choose, whereas a video clip can be no longer than the original Album scene.

Effects like Blur , Posterize and Color correction can be applied to still image clips in the same way as to video clips. See “Video effects – the basic set” on page 166.

Editing image clip properties

The Toolbox

¾

Modify Clip Properties menu command opens a version of the Clip properties tool appropriate for the type of the selected clip. The topmost tool icon in the video toolbox can also be used.

With bitmapped images , including ordinary photos and image files, and with disc menus, double-click the clip for a third way to access the tool. Double-clicking a title, however, opens it into the appropriate title editor.

All versions of the Clip properties tool allow you to set the duration and name of the current clip, as follows:

• To set the length of time the still image is displayed, change the value in the Duration counter.

• The Name text field lets you assign a custom name to the clip to replace the default one assigned by Studio.

Clip names are used by the Movie Window’s Text view, and can also be viewed on the fly-by labels that appear when your mouse hovers over clips in the

Storyboard view.

The Clip properties tool for disc menus is described in

Chapter 11: Disc menus. See Chapter 12: The Classic

Title Editor and Chapter 13: The Motion Titler for details about editing the properties of titles.

Editing photos and graphics

The Clip properties tool for editing bitmapped images allows you to perform several important imageprocessing tasks:

• Zoom in on your pictures and photos in order to crop away unneeded material and focus on only the essential part of the image;

Rotate the image in 90-degree increments to permit the use of photos taken in “portrait” mode;

• Remove the “red-eye” effect that can occur when the subject of a photograph looks directly into the camera when the flash goes off;

• In Studio Ultimate, put together “pan-and-zoom” animations in which a high-resolution image is viewed as a succession of smoothly-connected closeups at various degrees of magnification. This technique is closely associated with the well-known documentary filmmaker Ken Burns.

The Clip properties tool for photos has pan-andzoom controls for focusing on an area of interest. In

Studio Ultimate, pan-and-zoom can be animated to create the effect of traversing the image from one focus to another. Animated ‘P&Z’ can be obtained in other versions by upgrading to Studio Ultimate.

Chapter 10: Still images 213

If an image needs rotating by 90 degrees to bring it into “landscape” mode (wider than high), start by clicking one of the image rotation buttons. If needed, click the button more than once until the clip is properly oriented.

If you want to reframe the image, click directly on the tool’s preview window and, while holding the left mouse-button down, drag the image in any direction until it is properly positioned. Release the button to complete the operation. Next, use the Zoom slider to magnify or reduce the image size as desired. Adjust the position and magnification with these controls until the image is cropped and framed to your satisfaction.

The Reset button removes all your position and zoom changes, restoring the original framing of the image.

The red-eye reduction feature helps restore a natural appearance to photos in which the subject’s eyes are tinged with red. (This problem is caused by light from the flash unit bouncing off the retina of the eye when the subject is looking directly into the camera.)

To activate red-eye reduction, click the left button in the red eye group. The button stays down when clicked.

Now click the image preview with the left mousebutton above and to the left of the area in which redeye reduction should be applied. While holding the button down, drag down and to the right until the area is fully enclosed. When you release the mouse-button, the red-eye reduction effect is instantly applied within the rectangle you have outlined.

It is usually not necessary to be highly precise when marking out the red-eye reduction area. In fact, a larger rectangle may even yield a better result than a smaller

one that encloses the eyes and no more. If the red-eye reduction does not clear up the problem entirely on the first attempt, try again with a different rectangle size.

Studio’s red-eye reduction algorithm provides excellent results with a wide variety of photos. However, some photos are better-suited to the process than others.

To remove red-eye reduction once applied, click the right-hand button in the red eye group.

Animating Pan-and-zoom in Studio Ultimate

If you own Studio Ultimate, or purchase an activation key by clicking the activate button on the pan-andzoom controls, you can create effective animations from your photos and graphic images. Use the highestresolution images available with this technique, since they allow greater magnification levels before there is perceptible loss of quality.

Start creating a pan-and-zoom animation by clicking the

Animate from start to end checkbox to activate the animation feature for the current clip. This enables the Set start and Set end radio buttons, with Set start initially selected. Use the panand-zoom controls to set the framing you want to see at the start of the clip. Finally, click the Set end button, then use the controls to set up the framing you want for the end of the clip.

When the clip is played back, Studio will generate the intervening frames to connect your start and end views in a smooth animation.

Chapter 10: Still images 215

The procedure above describes the simplest form of pan-and-zoom animation. Effective uses include:

• Moving from a full-frame photograph to a detail view of a person or thing somewhere in the image.

This gives a similar result to zooming in while shooting video. This might be used to prepare the viewer for a sequence of shots exploring the same close-up subject in multiple views, or providing further close-ups of different parts of the same scene.

Moving out from a detail to the full-frame view, as though zooming out with the video camera. In the above scenario, this returns the viewer to the original context, perhaps closing a chapter or episode within your movie.

• Panning across a wide scene to absorb its details one by one. This technique can be used to impart a sense of discovery when a dramatic or humorous detail finally comes into view.

Complex pan-and-zoom animations

When you apply pan-and-zoom to a number of copies of the same image in succession, it is as though you are taking your viewer on a guided tour. In effect you are telling a story, one that gradually unfolds as you draw attention to one detail after another.

Story-telling may be difficult or not, but implementing your story in Studio is very simple. Once you have set up the first clip, with the first pan-and-zoom “camera move”, simply copy it as often as necessary, and change the end setting for each clip.

You almost always want the start framing of a new clip in the sequence to match the end framing of the

previous clip, in order that the sequence of moves will be smoothly connected. On the second clip, and all those that follow, click the Match previous clip button wherever you want continuity.

In order to allow the movie to dwell on each detail for a while after you pan to it, insert a non-animated copy of the image between each move. Connect these static clips into the sequence as usual with the Match previous clip button.

The pan-and-zoom controls are used here to focus in turn on four vignettes in the satirical painting “An

Election Entertainment” by English artist William

Hogarth. A fifth view pulls back to show as much of the entire canvas as will fit in a wide-screen frame without black sidebars. The tool automatically generates smooth motion from one view to the next, panning and zooming simultaneously as needed.

Chapter 10: Still images 217

Animating pan-and-zoom with keyframes

Studio Ultimate users have another option for animating their pan-and-zoom productions: keyframing. The use of this feature enables a string of pan-and-zoom movements to be associated with a single clip, instead of having a single movement on each of a series of clips. See “Keyframing” on page

160.

The pan-and-zoom effect interface

As an alternative to pan-and-zoom with the Clip properties tool, you can enter the framing properties numerically with the Pan and zoom video effect. This alternative interface is provided by the Video effects tool. You can also combine the two methods, using the tool’s graphical interface to specify the initial settings, then fine tuning them with the numerical effect parameters.

The Pan and zoom effect is found in the Fun Effects group. The parameters for pan-and-zoom are exactly parallel to those offered by the tool interface: you can use the sliders to set Zoom , Horizontal position and

Vertical position . The “red-eye reduction” controls of the tool interface do not have equivalent parameters, however.

Parameter settings for the Pan-and-zoom effect.

™

T

HE

F

RAME

G

RABBER

The Frame Grabber can capture a single frame from any video clip in your current project. The grabbed frame can be added directly to your movie or saved out to disk in any of a number of standard graphics formats.

Once you have saved a grabbed frame to disk, you can:

Use it in other software applications.

Manipulate it in image-editing software.

Import it back into your movies as a still image via the Album or one of the title editors.

The Frame grabber tool

Use the Frame grabber tool in conjunction with the Player. To access it, open the Toolbox and click the Frame grabber button.

Scrub or play through your movie or source video until the frame you want is displayed in the Player, then click the Grab button. The grabbed frame appears in the tool’s preview area, ready to be added to your movie or saved as a file on disk.

Reduce flicker: If the source video of the frame grab contains a large amount of motion, the grabbed frame may show flickering, which can be reduced or eliminated by checking the Reduce flicker option.

Because Reduce flicker also reduces resolution

Chapter 10: Still images 219

somewhat, you should not use the option if the overall result is undesirable for a particular image.

The Frame grabber tool after grabbing a frame from the movie. The grabbed frame can now be added as a still image to your movie or saved as a picture file.

Grab: Click the Grab button when you have located the frame you want to grab in the Player and configured the Reduce flicker option. The grabbed frame is displayed in the tool’s preview area, and the two output buttons ( Add to Movie and Save to Disk ) are enabled.

Add to movie: This button inserts the grabbed frame into the Movie Window video track ahead of the currently-selected clip.

Save to disk: This button opens a Save As dialog so that you can select a folder, file name and image format for the file in which the grabbed frame will be stored.

The dialog also provides controls that let you set the resolution of the saved image to any of several standard sizes, to the original size of the grabbed frame, or to a custom size that you enter.

If the “aspect ratio” (the ratio of the width to the height) of the size you choose is different from that of the grabbed frame, the image is stretched as necessary.

This can introduce visible distortion of shapes; for instance, people may appear either unnaturally thin or unnaturally squat.

CHAPTER 11:

Disc menus

When movies are designed for the DVD, Blu-ray Disc,

VCD or S-VCD disc formats, video becomes an interactive medium, with new possibilities for both videographer and audience.

Developing – “authoring” – a disc in one of these formats means going beyond the old idea of creating a movie to be viewed in strict sequence from beginning to end. Now the audience can decide which parts of the movie to view, and in what order.

The essential new feature that makes disc authoring possible is the menu . A particular disc may have one, a few or many menus, each consisting of a still image or short video sequence. Areas within the menus, called buttons , can be selected by the viewer to activate links to other content on the disc. Activating a link causes an immediate transfer to any of:

• A normal video sequence, which in this context is called a “chapter”. Chapter buttons often show a thumbnail frame from the video to which they link.

Another page of the same menu. Multiple pages, with the same page design but different chapter buttons, are used when a menu has too many buttons to fit on a single page.

A different menu.

Chapter 11: Disc menus 221

Unlike any other kind of clip, menus automatically loop . When the end of a menu clip is reached during disc preview or playback, it is immediately restarted.

This produces a jump in the playback position affecting all clips that run simultaneously with the menu, regardless of type – video (if the menu is an overlay), audio or still image.

The following diagram is patterned after the Movie

Window storyboard. It shows how the menu pictured above, which appears in the diagram as M1 , might fit into the overall scheme of a simple movie with two menus.

Each menu is followed in the movie by several chapters, all but one consisting of a single clip. Our menu, M1, has links to five chapters. Our menu is designed to display two chapter links per page, so three pages are required to accommodate all the links. (The

second page is the one appearing in the illustration.)

We’ve also given each page a link to the M2 menu.

The simple layout of this short movie can easily be extended to organize large numbers of clips. Much more complex movies are also constructed from the same elements: multi-page menus with links to chapters and to other menus.

Availability: Discs with multiple menus are supported in Studio

Ultimate only.

Disc authoring in Studio

For the purposes of editing in Studio, a disc menu is just one more type of clip. As with titles, you can use or adapt the menus provided in the Album, or construct your own from scratch in the Classic Title Editor (see

Chapter 3: The Album and Chapter 12: The Classic

Title Editor ).

To get a feeling for what is involved, try creating the pair of “instant” projects described below. You don’t have to go as far as making discs, but you can preview your movie using the DVD playback controls on the

Player (see “The DVD Player Control” on page 226).

Instant video scene catalog: In an empty project, multi-select a good number of scenes from the Album and drag them onto the video track. Now switch to the

Disc Menu section of the Album (the bottom tab) and drag any of the menus to the beginning of the Timeline.

When Studio asks if you would like it to “create chapters at the start of each video clip”, click Yes (see

“Using menus from the Album” on page 224). A new

Chapter 11: Disc menus 223

track appears at the top of the Timeline, and a small

“flag” appears over each of your clips. These represent links from the menu you just added. And that’s it – sit back and watch the show.

Instant slideshow: This time, start in the Still Images section of the Album. Drag as many images as you like onto the video track of an empty project, then drag in any disc menu as the first clip on the Timeline, and again click Yes when asked if you want links automatically created. Turn next to the Transitions section of the Album, pick any transition, and drag it between the menu and the first of your still images.

Finally, select all of the still images (click the first, then shift-click the last), click with the right mouse button, and choose Ripple Transition from the pop-up menu. Instant slideshow!

Menus and titles

The similarity noted on page 223 between titles and disc menus is not just on the surface: a menu is essentially “a title with buttons”. Any title on the

Timeline’s main video track can be converted to a disc menu simply by adding one or more buttons in the

Classic Title Editor.

Using menus from the Album

The Disc Menus section of the Album contains a collection of menus that have been designed for particular occasions, authoring styles and chapter counts. Each menu provides a background picture, a title, a set of chapter buttons (generally with spaces for

thumbnail frames), and a pair of Next page and

Previous page buttons.

The number of chapter buttons per page varies from one menu design to another, so one criterion for selecting a menu is the number of clips you want it to handle. It is generally more convenient for the viewer to browse a few menu pages with many buttons per page than many pages of a few buttons each.

During editing, you see all the buttons that the menu provides. During playback, the only buttons visible are those to which you have assigned links.

Menus with fewer buttons have more space for captions; those with many buttons will have abbreviated captions or none at all. Whether you need captions, and if so whether they should be simple

(“Chapter 1”) or descriptive (“Cutting the cake”) is a matter of your authoring style and the content of your movie.

In the VCD and S-VCD formats, the viewer must select chapters numerically (by keying numbers on the remote control), so it is usual to provide button captions that include the chapter number when authoring for these formats.

Dropping menus on the Timeline

When you drag a menu from the Album and drop it onto the video track or the title track, Studio gives you the option of automatically generating links to all video clips to the right of the menu on the Timeline. Multiple clips are combined into chapters if necessary to achieve the minimum chapter length you specify.

This is the quickest, easiest way to link in a disc menu, but may not be what you want in a particular authoring

Chapter 11: Disc menus 225

situation. If you check the Don’t ask me again checkbox, your choice of Yes or No becomes the default action when you drag in a menu in future. You can also set the default action, or reinstate the confirmation window, in the When adding a disc menu area of the Project preferences options panel (see

“Project preferences” on page 352).

To create your chapter links manually, rather than using the automatic linking feature, use the Set disc chapter command on the pop-up context menu for each video clip you want to add, or use the Set chapter button on the Clip properties tool for disc menus.

The DVD Player Control

Studio’s Player provides a specialized set of controls for previewing movies that contain menus, patterned after the button layout on a typical

DVD remote control. Switch the Player to DVD mode by clicking the DVD toggle button at the bottom right corner of the Player.

A grouping of DVD controls appears and activates below the Player preview screen:

Here are the functions of the individual DVD controls:

Main menu: Jumps to the first menu in your movie and begins (or continues) playing.

Previous menu: Jumps to the most recently active menu and begins (or continues) playing.

Clicking the button again jumps back from the menu to the most recent clip.

Previous chapter, Next chapter: Clicking the

Previous chapter button takes you to the start of the current chapter if you aren’t there already.

Click again to move on to the previous chapter. The

Next chapter button takes you forward to the next chapter in the movie. Within a menu, these buttons step backwards and forwards through the menu pages.

Button selection: The four arrow controls in this cluster move the on-screen cursor within a disc menu to select one of its buttons. The oval button in the middle of the cluster activates the currently-selected on-screen button, which is indicated by highlighting.

Activating menu buttons directly

One feature of the Player that set-top DVDs don’t have is the ability to click the buttons directly on the screen.

Whenever a button is visible in the Player preview area in DVD mode, you can click it to follow the button link.

Chapter 11: Disc menus 227

Editing menus on the Timeline

Menus can be trimmed on the Timeline just like any other still image clip (see “Trimming on the Timeline using handles” on page 117).

Setting the clip duration is generally less crucial for menu clips than for other types, since menus cycle during playback while waiting for user input. If you want a looping video background or looping audio with your menus, though, you will want to match the menu’s duration to that of the clips involved.

The menu track

Menu buttons link to particular points within your movie. Those points are marked by flags on the menu track, which materializes above the video track the first time a menu is added to your movie (and vanishes again if all menus are removed).

The menu itself is marked by a colored rectangle in the menu track ( M1 and M2 in the illustration above). Each link to a chapter is shown by a “C” flag. Here is a close-up of the first part of the Timescale, showing the rectangle identifying the first menu, and the chapter flags for three of the clips it links to.

The next part of the Timescale in the overview illustration above includes the fourth chapter link from

M1 , and a link (the left-pointing arrow) from the end of the previous clip back to the menu. A result of setting this link is that the C4 clip can only be reached from the menu. The C4 clip is followed by menu M2 , which

– along with the flags that belong to it – is automatically drawn in a new color.

Availability: Discs with multiple menus are supported in Studio

Ultimate only.

Editing on the menu track

Flags on the menu track can be moved by dragging them with the mouse, thereby changing the location at which the link takes effect in the movie. When a video clip is moved, any flags attached to the clip are moved along with it.

To create a link:

Right-click the menu track or the video track and choose either Set Disc Chapter or Set Return to Menu , depending on the kind of link you want to create.

Return to menu links are always created at the end of the current clip, rather than at the exact point where you click. You’ll rarely want to return from the middle of a clip, but you can drag the link flag to a new position if the occasion arises.

Chapter 11: Disc menus 229

To reposition a link:

Click the flag for the link and drag it along the menu track to its new position.

To delete a link:

Right-click the link flag and choose Delete from the pop-up menu; or,

Select the flag, highlighting it, then press the Delete key.

Editing with the Clip properties tool

The Clip properties tool for disc menus allows you to create, edit and fine-tune chapter links, and provides access to the Classic Title Editor for adjusting the visual content of the menu.

Like the Clip properties tool for other clip types, this tool lets you set a custom name for the menu by editing the Name field and trim the clip by editing the

Duration field.

The Edit menu button at the top right of the tool opens the menu in the Classic Title Editor. There you can

change every visual aspect of the menu: its background and button images, the appearance and contents of its captions, and more. For full information about the many capabilities of the Classic Title Editor, see

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor .

The preview area on the left side of the tool shows how the menu looks and also has interactive features you can use when establishing chapter links. (These are described on page 234 under “Chapter-editing controls”.)

The other controls are in four groups:

Menu-previewing controls

The Menu type options

Link property controls

Chapter-editing controls

Menu-previewing controls

These controls are located below the preview area.

Page selector: For menus with multiple pages (those with more links than a single page can accommodate) the arrow buttons let you select which page is active in the preview area. You can select any page in the menu for which links have been defined.

Alternative methods of selecting menu pages:

• Step through the pages by clicking the page link buttons in the preview area.

• Use the Button selector control (described on page

232) to choose a button on any page of the menu.

Show link numbers checkbox: Check this box to cause link numbers to be displayed in the

Chapter 11: Disc menus 231

preview area over every button in the menu. The link numbers match the format and color of the chapter flags on the menu track.

The Menu type options

This pair of options determines whether you or Studio will organize the chapter links for this menu.

If you choose Auto scene index , Studio will ensure that your chapter links are in the same order on the menu as they are in the movie itself, seven if you shuffle the order of the clips in the Movie Window. With the

Manual setting, the order in which chapters are shown on the menu is up to you. If you want to sort your chapter links yet still retain future control of their order, you can click Auto scene index first (to sort the links), then Manual .

Availability: The option of manually ordering menu chapters is available in Studio Ultimate only. In standard Studio, the Auto scene index feature is permanently enabled.

Link property controls

The controls in this area set the display properties of the chapter links on the menu.

Button selector: Every link button in your menu, no matter which page it is on, has a unique sequence number. Use the arrow buttons on this control to select the menu button you want to work on.

The selected button is highlighted in the preview area.

You can also select a button by clicking on it in the preview area.

Button caption text field: Edit the text for the current button without opening the

Classic Title Editor. The “#” character in button captions has a special meaning: Studio replaces it with the button’s sequence number. Use this to ensure that your buttons are correctly numbered regardless of menu layout changes. To edit other characteristics of a button caption – its position, font, and styling – click the Edit menu button to invoke the Classic Title Editor.

Set thumbnail button: By default, the thumbnail frame displayed on a menu button is the frame to which the button links. You can choose any frame in your movie to be the thumbnail, however. Just move the Timeline scrubber to the exact frame you want (as shown in the Player), and click the set thumbnail button.

Motion thumbnails checkbox:

Check this option if you would like your menu’s buttons to show moving video from their target chapters rather than a static thumbnail frame.

Because this feature requires that the moving thumbnails be pre-rendered, the results won’t appear immediately when you preview your movie in the

Player. Instead you will typically see a colored bar appear in the Timescale over the menu clip. This bar indicates that the clip is being rendered in the background, without interrupting your session.

Background rendering is optional. You can disable it, if required, in the Video and audio preferences options panel ( Setup

¾

Video and Audio Preferences ). See page 355 for more information.

Availability: The Motion thumbnails feature is available in Studio

Ultimate only.

Chapter 11: Disc menus 233

Chapter-editing controls

The controls in this area select or modify the individual chapter buttons within a menu.

The Set chapter buttons: These buttons set or sever the link between the selected chapter button and its target clip.

To set a link: Position the Timeline scrubber within a menu, video, theme or still image clip, and click the

Create chapter button. For video and still image clips, the chapter point is set to the exact location of the scrubber within the clip.

To clear a link: Click the Clear chapter button.

Set return button: This creates a “return-tomenu” link at the end of the current clip, which is where you almost always want it. During playback, the link causes an immediate jump to its menu. To create a return-to-menu link in the Clip properties tool, position the Timeline scrubber in the clip where you want the link, and click Set return to menu .

Availability: Set return is available in Studio Ultimate only.

The Return after every chapter checkbox: Set this option to add a return-to-menu link after every chapter in this menu. Clicking this checkbox, whether to set or clear it, removes all existing return-to-menu links for the menu. Return-to-menu links are normally draggable, but while this box is checked they remain anchored to the end of their clips.

Creating links with drag-and-drop

The Clip properties tool for disc menus supports dragand-drop as a quick and convenient way to establish links for menu buttons.

To create a link using drag-and-drop:

Click the clip in the Movie Window that you want to link to, and drag it onto a button in the Clip properties tool preview area. The button is linked to the first frame of the clip. Or,

• Click the button for which you want to create a link, and drag it onto a clip in the Movie Window. In this case you are linking to the point within the clip at which you “drop” the button – generally not the first frame.

The Disc menu tool

If you open this tool while a menu is selected, it is equivalent to opening the Clip properties tool; otherwise, it provides a Create Menu button that takes you into the Classic Title Editor to begin the process of creating a new disc menu. (See “Editing with the Clip properties tool”, page 230, and Chapter 12: The

Classic Title Editor .)

Because developing a menu is a relatively intricate operation, Studio takes the opportunity to remind you that pre-built menus are available in the Album.

Chapter 11: Disc menus 235

CHAPTER 12:

The Classic Title Editor

Studio’s built-in Classic Title Editor is a powerful facility for creating and editing titles and other graphics. Its extensive suite of text and image effects and tools provides endless possibilities for the visual design of your movie.

Creating a title in the Classic Title Editor tool. The large area containing the picture and the text is the

Edit Window, while the panel occupying most of the right-hand side is the Classic Title Editor Album.

Other controls are in clusters around the Edit

Window.

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 237

The Classic Title Editor is not limited to creating passive titles. For disc projects, you can also add and edit the special buttons needed for handling viewer interaction with the menus of VCD, S-VCD, DVD and

Blu-ray Disc movies.

Note: Studio Ultimate includes a second title-editing tool, the Motion Titler, with animation capabilities not found in the Classic Title Editor. The Classic Title

Editor also has some features the Motion Titler does not, however, including the ability to create navigable disc menus as well as titles.

Launching the Classic Title Editor

Reflecting the versatility of the Classic Title Editor is the variety of ways of accessing it from Studio’s Edit mode, using either one of the tools in the Video toolbox

(see page 104) or a mouse command on one of the

Timeline tracks (see page 96).

• To create a full-screen title or menu: Select Go to

Classic Title/Menu Editor from the right-button context menu in the main Timeline video track.

• To create a title from the toolbox: Open the Create title tool and click Classic Title Overlay or Full

Screen Classic Title .

• To create a disc menu from the toolbox: Open the

Create disc menu tool and click Create Menu .

• To edit a full-screen classic title: Double-click the title in any Movie Window view, or right-click the title and select Go to Classic Title/Menu Editor .

To edit a full-screen menu: Double-click the menu in any view and click the Edit Menu button, or rightclick the menu and select Go to Classic Title/Menu

Editor .

To edit an overlay title: Double-click the clip on the title track or in List View, or right-click it in any view and select Go to Classic Title Editor .

• To edit a title or menu from the toolbox: With the clip open in the Clip properties tool , click the Edit

Menu or the Edit Classic Title button.

™

T

HE EDITOR CONTROLS

The main Classic Title Editor controls are laid out in clusters around the Edit Window (see the picture on page 237).

Title-type buttons

The four buttons in this cluster sit on the left side of the screen above the

Classic Title Editor’s Edit Window. Only one of them can be selected at a time. Choose the first button if you are creating a still title. The second creates a roll , in which the title text and graphics travel upwards on the screen as the title displays, like the credits at the end of a move. The third creates a crawl , in which the title is displayed as a single line of text moving from right to left across the screen like the bulletins on a TV news show.

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 239

The fourth button is for creating disc menus , which you can think of as “titles with buttons”. In fact, a menu is just like any other title except for two attributes:

A menu has at least one button. A title has none.

Adding a button to a title turns it into a menu, and deleting the last button on a menu turns it into a title.

By the same token, if you click the Menu button while editing a title, Studio automatically adds a button to the title.

A menu cannot have rolling or crawling text. The

Classic Title Editor does not allow you to add menu buttons to a rolled or crawled title.

Because disc menus are allowed only on the main

Video track of the Movie Window Timeline, the button for creating disc menus does not appear when a title from one of the other tracks is being created or edited.

Availability: Rolls and crawls are supported in Studio Ultimate only.

Object toolbox

This cluster of four Classic Title Editor tools is located below the Edit Window.

The first tool (the arrow) is used for all editing operations upon the currently-selected object . A selected object is surrounded by a number of control points with which you can change its size, position, proportions, and other geometrical features.

The other three tools are for creating objects in the Edit

Window – text boxes, ellipses and rectangles.

Each is used in the same general way.

Click one of the three tools, then click the Edit Window at the point where one corner of the object should be. Drag the mouse to outline the new object as indicated by the dotted line.

When the object has the size and proportions you want, release the mouse. Whatever its type, the object is created with the specified dimensions. Its other attributes – color, shading, shadow, etc. – are determined by the currently selected look in the Classic Title

Editor Album. All attributes can later be changed at will.

After the object is created, the object tool you used deselects, and the selection arrow again becomes active. The object itself is selected – shown in the usual way by its control points – and can now be manipulated with the mouse.

Reordering objects in three dimensions

Because objects can overlap one another, it is easy to get into situations where an object that should be completely visible is partly or wholly obscured by one or more other objects. In such cases, use the four reordering commands on the

Classic Title Editor’s Layers menu. These commands affect the currently-selected object, symbolized by rectangle “3” in the diagram.

Bring to Front: The object is moved out in front of all other objects. In the diagram, object 3 is now in front of object 1.

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 241

Send to Back: The object moves behind all other objects. Object 3 is now behind object 5.

• Bring Forward One Layer: Object 3 now lies in front of objects 2, 4 and 5, but still behind object 1.

• Send Back One Layer: Object 3 is now behind objects 1, 2 and 4, but is still in front of object 5.

About text objects

Selecting a text object is different in one important way from selecting a rectangle or ellipse: the object’s text field is put into a “ready” state in which any keyboard activity will cause the field to activate and start displaying the input text.

The activation of the text field is indicated by a text insertion cursor, the changed appearance of the object frame, and the disappearance of the control points.

When a text object is not selected, you can activate its text field directly by clicking in the middle of the object. If you want the selection frame and control points to appear, you must click on the edges of the object. With other types of object, you can click anywhere in an object to select it.

To deactivate a text field, click anywhere in the Edit

Window outside the text object.

Because text plays a central role in most titles and menus, the Text Editor will automatically create and

activate a text object in the center of the Edit Window if you simply begin typing at a time when no text object already exists.

Advanced text editing features

As in a word processing program, the Classic Title

Editor allows you to format a selected range of characters. Simply mark an adjacent set of characters with the mouse and apply the formatting you desire.

Supported operations on character ranges include text styling (font, style and look), clipboard operations (cut, copy, paste), delete, and a number of special positioning, spacing and scaling commands that are accessible only from the keyboard. For details on these, please consult Appendix F: Keyboard Shortcuts .

Editing-mode selection buttons

These two buttons form the second cluster along the bottom of the Classic Title Editor’s

Edit Window. Their function is to govern which of two sets of editing operations is available for the currentlyselected object.

• The first button is on by default when an object is newly created. It enables the move , scale and rotate operations with a selection frame containing nine control points:

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 243

Clicking the second button enables the skew operation, which requires only a single control point.

With text objects, the second button provides two further operations, kern and change leading , accessed by control points in the center of each edge of the text frame:

Kern (L) and Change leading (R)

Object layout buttons

The two left buttons in this cluster are for grouping and ungrouping Classic

Title Editor objects. The first button is available when multiple objects are selected. Its action is to link the objects into a group – a composite object that is treated as a single entity by editing operations. When a group is selected, all its control points are visible simultaneously, and any of them may be used to manipulate the group.

A grouping of three objects

The second button, which is available whenever a group object is selected, separates the group into its constituent objects.

Although it is possible to “group groups”, grouping is always just one level deep, so ungrouping a supergroup will result in all the constituent objects being individuals again.

The next button opens a pop-out menu of 11 operations that apply only to groups. The first six let you align a set of objects along any one of their four edges or either of their two mid-lines. The next pair of commands provides for spacing the objects at equal intervals in

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 245

either the vertical or horizontal directions, and the final three resize the objects so that they have equal width, equal height, or both. All of these commands are particularly useful in menu creation, since you generally want menu buttons to be laid out in a regular fashion.

The final object layout button opens another pop-out menu, this one concerned with object justification . The nine options here are in a graphical form resembling a tic-tactoe board. Clicking one of the nine areas moves the object to the corresponding corner of the screen (as defined by the “text-safe” area delimited by red dashed lines), or to the center.

Multiple selection of objects

The first step in making a group is to select the multiple objects that will comprise it. This can be accomplished in either of two ways:

By clicking and dragging with the mouse to mark out a selection rectangle (a “marquee”) that encloses all the objects you want to group; or,

• By clicking the first object you want to group, then

Ctrl-clicking each of the others.

Temporary groups

Any selection of multiple objects functions as a temporary group, and can be moved, aligned, rotated, colored etc. as a unit. The temporary grouping loses its identity as soon as you click elsewhere in the Edit

Window, however, whereas a group created with the group button persists until explicitly ungrouped.

Clipboard and delete buttons

The buttons in this cluster provide the familiar editing operations Cut , Copy ,

Paste and Delete , all of which operate on groups, individual objects, or on selected text within a Classic

Title Editor text object. The first three work with the

Windows Clipboard, while the fourth simply deletes the chosen material without affecting the Clipboard.

Text-styling controls

The controls in this cluster at the top right of the

Classic Title Editor’s Edit Window should look familiar to anyone who has used word-processing software. The controls apply both to currently-selected text and to any new text that may be entered until the settings are changed again.

At the left are three font style buttons, which select the bold, italic or underlined styles respectively.

Perhaps surprisingly, the underlined style button – alone among these controls – can be applied to any type of object, not just text (try it!). This makes it possible to use the underlined highlighting style with buttons created from graphic objects: rectangles, ellipses and pictures.

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 247

The fourth button opens a pop-out menu of text-formatting options.

Unlike the other controls in the cluster, which govern the appearance of individual characters, the options on this menu apply to all the text in a given text box .

The three justification options – Left,

Center and Right – affect the placement of the text within its box (and not the placement of the box within the Edit Window, which is the function of the object justification menu ).

Shrink to fit , Scale to fit , Word wrap on and Word wrap off are options that determine how your text is treated when you resize a text box. With Word wrap on , which is the default for a new text box, resizing the box results in the text being reformatted – word-wrapped – to the new box width (while the resulting new height of the text in turn governs the height of the box). Word wrap off removes all “soft” line breaks (line breaks added for word wrapping), then makes the box as wide as necessary to contain the text. Word wrap mode is automatically turned on again if you type further characters into the text box.

With Scale to fit , the text is stretched during resizing to follow both box dimensions. With Shrink to fit , the text remains its original size unless the box is made smaller, in which case the text is resized as in Scale to fit .

Neither to fit command changes the line divisions of the text.

The font dropdown list and the font-size selector complete the text-styling controls group.

™

T

HE

C

LASSIC

T

ITLE

E

DITOR

A

LBUM

The Classic Title Editor Album is the rectangular panel on the right-hand side of the Classic Title Editor screen.

It contains resources for building menus and titles in the same way that the main Studio Album contains resources for creating movies.

The Classic Title Editor Album is controlled by the four buttons shown at right, which are located between the Edit Window and the Album itself.

Each opens one of the four Album sections: the

Looks Browser, the Backgrounds section, the

Pictures section and the Buttons section.

The fourth of these buttons, the one that opens the

Buttons section, appears only when a menu or a title from the main Video track is being created or edited.

This is because disc menus (which from the Classic

Title Editor’s point of view are just titles with buttons), are not allowed on the other Timeline tracks.

The Looks Browser

This section of the Classic Title Editor Album has three subsections, accessed by the Standard , Custom and Favorites tabs across the top.

The Standard tab is a collection of styles that can be applied to the text and other objects you use in your titles. Each style consists of a color (or color gradient, or transparency) for each of the “face” (surface), edge

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 249

and shadow of the object to which it applies, plus a separate blurring parameter for each. A final parameter is shadow direction, with eight possibilities.

To change the look of an existing object, simply click on the look you want while the object is selected. New objects are created with the most recently selected look.

Selecting a look in the Looks Browser: Each button in the Standard tab is available in eight styles, which are presented to you as a submenu. Double-click the main button to open the submenu. Each look has a numeric ID that displays as a tool-tip under your mouse. Above, the mouse is on look 27-3.

The Custom tab lets you customize the supplied looks or create your own by adjusting the parameters listed above. Three identical sets of controls adjust the parameters for face, edge and shadow respectively.

Here are the face controls:

The three option buttons across the top select a solid color, a gradient, or no color (transparency). Clicking

the color swatch beside the first button invokes an otherwise standard Windows color-picker dialog to which an Opacity slider (0-100%) has been added.

The swatch beside the second button pops up a gradient designer that lets you define a gradient by assigning the starting colors to each corner of a square surface. Click the color swatches in the corners of the gradient window to set the color for that corner in a color-picker dialog.

Note: Some of the more elaborate supplied looks employ special internal features and so cannot be edited.

The Favorites tab lets you save particular custom looks that you may want to re-use in the future, to spare you from having to remember or record the parameters you used. Click the left-hand button to save the current look as one of your favorites.

Click the right-hand button to delete the currentlyselected “favorite”.

The Backgrounds section

A title or menu can have four types of background: a solid color, a gradient, transparency (no background at all) or an image file (such as a drawing, photograph or saved video frame).

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 251

The color and gradient options in the Backgrounds section of the Classic Title Editor work in just the same way as those described above for the Looks Browser

(page 249), except that the color or gradient you select is instantly applied to the background of the title you are editing.

If you are working on an overlay title, you may find interesting ways to use the Opacity setting on the colorpicker dialogs for these buttons, especially when the overlay is coupled with transitions. Normally, though, you’ll use a transparent background for titles, and transparency is the default background selection for a new title or menu.

The final option for backgrounds is picture – an image file in any standard format. As with many of the sections of Studio’s main Album, the backgrounds are drawn from a source folder that may be changed using the folder button. The image file you select with the folder button becomes the new background, and the image files in the folder are displayed as thumbnails on the Album panel. If necessary, the Classic Title Editor stretches the background image until it fills the width or height of the screen but does not change its proportions.

Adding a motion background

In Studio Ultimate, disc menus can have a background of moving video, not just a static image. To create such a motion background , or replace one, simply click the folder button and browse for a movie file in AVI,

MPEG or WMV format.

The following rules apply when you add or change a motion menu clip:

• The length of the movie you add as a background does not affect the length of the menu clip in the

Movie Window. If the movie is shorter than the clip, it is simply repeated as necessary to fill out the required time; if longer, it is truncated. You can adjust the length of the menu by trimming on the timeline or in the Clip properties tool as usual.

If you add a widescreen movie as a menu background in a project in standard format, or a standard movie to a widescreen project, the movie is stretched or squeezed as required to match the project format.

To see movie files listed while browsing for a folder on your hard drive, select the desired movie type (or

“All Files”) in the “Files of type” box.

The Pictures section

As with the background pictures just discussed, the images in the Pictures section of the Classic

Title Editor Album can be of any standard type. Instead of being stretched to fill the Edit Window, however, these pictures are added to the title as picture objects and displayed at normal size with eight control points that allow them to be repositioned and resized (though not rotated or skewed).

Picture objects behave just like text objects and the two types of graphic object with respect to grouping, alignment and similar controls.

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 253

The Buttons section

Since buttons are the magic ingredient that turns titles into interactive menus, this section of the Classic

Title Editor Album is available only when the menu or title being edited is on the main video track, the only track on which menus can be placed.

Broadly speaking, a button is an area of the screen with which the user can interact in some way. Buttons are classified according to the action they produce when the user activates them, and not by their appearance, which generally should be chosen to give a strong clue to their behavior, but is not required to. The four types of button are:

• Normal: Clicking the button causes playback to jump to a chapter (that is, ordinary video) or another menu. The link between the button and its target is created in the Clip properties tool, not in the Classic

Title Editor.

Thumbnail: This special form of the normal button type displays a thumbnail frame (or a moving thumbnail preview) from the part of the movie to which it links.

• Previous: This button appears on the second and later pages of multi-page menus (menus with more links from normal or thumbnail buttons than will fit on one page). It links to the previous menu page.

• Next: This button appears on all but the last page of multi-page menus; it links to the following page.

The button art supplied with Studio includes several examples of each type. Each button is an image file in

Targa ( tga ) format. Examination of the files in an art

program like Adobe PhotoShop or Paint Shop Pro will show that the transparent portion of the button image, and the special area for the display of thumbnails

(where applicable), are defined by an alpha channel included with the image.

As usual, a folder button lets you select the disk directory from which the displayed images are obtained.

To use a supplied button, simply drag it from the

Album into the Edit Window, where it becomes a button object – essentially an identical twin of the picture object.

The default action of the supplied buttons is determined by their file names, but a new action can be assigned to the currently-selected button object from the dropdown list in the Buttons section of the Classic Title Editor

Album. The first choice on this list, “Not a button”, removes the action from the object – now it is merely a graphic. The other choices correspond to the button types listed above.

Tip: Remember, it’s not the button’s appearance that determines its behavior, but the button type you select from the menu.

Button highlighting

DVD menus (but not VCD and

S-VCD menus), give visual feedback by highlighting the current button as the user scrolls around the menu. Special active highlighting

Chapter 12: The Classic Title Editor 255

distinguishes a button that is in the process of being actuated, just before the action is performed. (You can preview this highlighting effect in the Player, and interact with the menu using either the mouse or the

Player’s DVD controls.)

The Classic Title Editor lets you assign the color that will be used for each type of highlight, and a style option that governs how the highlights will be drawn.

The controls for these settings are located below the button-type list.

Click the Active and Selected color swatches to set the highlight colors that work best with your menu. It may help to make your menus clearer if you use consistent highlighting colors for all the menus on a disc.

The three highlight style options, from left to right, are:

Box: The highlighting is drawn as a rectangle enclosing the button.

Follow shape: The highlighting covers the visible area of the button, whatever its shape.

• Underline: The button is underlined.

These highlight options can be applied to any type of button made from any type of object, not just the button images brought in from the Album. Clear the Highlight style checkbox if you want to disable button highlighting while working in the Classic Title Editor.

CHAPTER 13:

The Motion Titler

Studio’s Motion Titler is a powerful tool for creating and editing animated titles and graphics. Its extensive suite of text and image effects and tools provides endless possibilities for the visual design of your movie.

Although the Motion Titler has fewer tools in some areas than the Classic Title Editor, it excels in animation, special effects, usability and fun.

Areas of the Motion Titler display: n

the Title Bar; o

the Motion Titler Album; p

the Edit Window; q the Background Panel; and r

the Layer List.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 257

There are five main areas of the Motion Titler display.

1.

The Title Bar has four parts with, from left to right: the category and name of your title; a set of text manipulation controls; a duration counter field; and a close button, which has the same effect as the OK button in the bottom right corner.

2.

The five sections of the Motion Titler Album provide resources for building your titles. The first two sections, Videos and Photos, are local versions of the like-named sections from Studio’s main

Album, with the same controls. The others –

Objects, Looks and Motions – contain specialized resources for motion titles. All sections are covered in “The Motion Titler Album”, beginning on page

262.

3.

The Edit Window is your main work area when authoring or editing a title. It provides a scrubbable preview of your title with hands-on editing. See page 279 for details.

4.

Each motion title has a background layer, which you can either edit using the Background Panel or leave transparent. See page 277.

5.

Each graphic or textual element constitutes a layer in the title. The opaque parts of each layer obscure the layers below; the bottommost layer can obscure only the background. In addition to listing each layer by name, the Layer List includes an animation timeline showing which motions have been assigned to each layer. Durations on the timeline can be adjusted by dragging.

The process of building up an image in layers is called

‘compositing’. Because the information in each layer is maintained separately, to be combined only when the

image is output, it is possible to return to the composition at any time and add new layers, and to adjust, reorder, remove or replace existing ones. The

Motion Titler supports compositions with up to eight layers in addition to the background.

Building up an image in layers starting with an empty frame (top left). The checkerboard pattern indicates transparency. Although backgrounds can have transparent or translucent areas, here we add an opaque background (0) for clarity, followed by successive layers with some opaque content (1, 2, 3).

In the final composition (bottom right), upper layers obscure those below.

Note: The Motion Titler tool is available in Studio

Ultimate and Studio Ultimate Collection only.

Launching (and leaving) the titler

Like the Classic Title Editor, the Motion Titler can be invoked in a variety of ways from Studio’s Edit mode,

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 259

using either a tool in the Video toolbox (see page 104) or a mouse command on one of the Timeline tracks

(see page 96).

To create a full-screen motion title: Select Go to

Motion Title Editor from the right-button context menu in the main Timeline video track.

• To create an overlay motion title: Double-click the

Timeline title track, or select Go to Motion Title

Editor from the right-button context menu on either the title track or the overlay track.

• To create a motion title from the toolbox: Open the Create title tool and click Motion Title Overlay or Full Screen Motion Title .

• To edit a full-screen motion title: Double-click the title in any Movie Window view, or right-click the title and select Go to Motion Title Editor .

• To edit an overlay motion title: Double-click the clip on the title track, the overlay track , or in List

View, or right-click it in any view and select Go to

Motion Title Editor .

• To edit a motion title from the toolbox: With the clip open in the Clip properties tool , click the Edit

Title button.

Closing the titler

To close the Motion Titler, use any of the following methods:

• Click the OK button at the bottom right of the

Motion Titler window. This returns you to Studio’s

Edit mode. Your new or updated title is now part of the current project.

• Click the button at the top right of the window.

This is equivalent to clicking OK .

• Select File

¾

Close Title Tool , or File

¾

Cancel

Title Tool from the main menu bar while working in the Motion Titler. The equivalent keyboard commands are F12 and F11 respectively.

File operations

Most of the menu commands provided in the Motion

Titler duplicate the functions of buttons and context menus, but several commands in the titler’s File menu are not otherwise available. They are:

• New Title: This is the “start over” command, which removes all existing layers, and clears the background. If you make changes to a new or existing title before giving this command, you will have an opportunity to save your work back into the current project before proceeding.

• Open Title: With this command you can load a title from a file folder on your local system or network.

• Save Title and Save Title As: These standard commands, together with the previous, let you export titles to other computers, and share titles with other

Studio users.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 261

™

T

HE

M

OTION

T

ITLER

A

LBUM

The Motion Titler Album is a tabbed panel on the lefthand side of the Motion Titler screen. It contains resources for building motion titles in the same way that the main Studio Album contains resources for creating movies.

The Videos and Photos (shown here) sections of the

Motion Titler Album are functionally identical to the equivalent sections in Edit mode. The other three sections contain special resources for motion titles.

The Motion Titler Album has five sections, which are described in details on the following pages. Each is opened by its own tab button:

• The Videos section provides video materials for your title. Although the layout is a little different, this is the same section as in Edit mode, with the same capabilities. Any changes, such as

selecting a new video, or switching to Scenes mode, affect both simultaneously.

• The Photos section is also the same as its equivalent Album section, Photos and Frame

Grabs.

• The Objects section contains a collection of graphic objects that you can use to decorate your titles. Individual objects can be sized, positioned and rotated as needed.

The Looks section is where you can define the visual styling of a text or shape layer in your title. You can use one of the numerous preset looks, or define your own in terms of one or more face , edge and shadow components.

• The Motions section puts the excitement in your motion titles. Motions are animation programs that are most often applied to text but will work with any type of layer. Separate animations can be applied to the beginning, middle and end phases of any layer’s lifespan.

Adding Album resources to a title

To add a video, photo or object to the title, double-click its icon, or drag it from the Album into the Edit

Window, or choose Add to motion title from the icon’s context menu. In all cases the new element is created at a default size in the center of the Edit Window, whereupon you can move, resize or rotate it as you like.

Looks can be applied to the currently-selected text or shape layer in the Edit Window either by doubleclicking or by drag-and-drop. Looks cannot be used with layers of other types. If the layer to which a look is being applied is of the text type, and the text it contains is only partially selected, the look is applied only to the selected range.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 263

To add a motion to any element, double-click it while that element is selected, or drag it onto the element either in the Edit Window or the Layer List. If multiple layers are selected, double-clicking a look or a motion adds it simultaneously to all of them.

The Videos section

The Videos section of the Motion Titler Album will look familiar to anyone who has spent time in Studio’s Edit mode, for it is simply another view of the same section in the main Album. Despite minor differences in the layout of the controls, the functionality is the same. See page 63 for details.

With the Videos Album in Scenes mode, double-click scenes to add them to your motion title, or drag them into the Edit Window, or right-click the scene and choose ‘Add to motion title’ from the context menu.

Another way to use video is by dragging to the

Background Panel.

To add a video file or scene to your motion title as a layer, use any of the following methods:

Double-click the video in the Album.

Drag the video from the Album and drop it onto the

Edit Window.

• Right-click the video in the Album and select Add to motion title from the context menu.

In all of these cases, the video is added as a full-size layer to the Edit Window, where it can be resized, moved and rotated like other layers to fit your composition.

To add a video file or scene as the background of your motion title, drag it from the Album to the Background

Panel at the bottom left of the titler display. See “The

Background Panel” on page 277 for details.

The Photos section

The Photos section of the Motion Titler Album is simply another view of the Photos and Frame

Grabs section of the main Studio Album. The controls for folder navigation, favorites and viewing are used in exactly the same way in both locations.

To add a photo or other image file to your motion title as a layer, use any of the following methods:

Double-click the image in the Album.

Drag the image from the Album and drop it onto the

Edit Window.

Right-click the image in the Album and select Add to motion title from the context menu.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 265

The picture is added to the center of the Edit Window where it can be manipulated in the same manner as other layers. The image is automatically resized only if it would otherwise be too large to fit.

To add an image file as the background of your motion title, drag it from the Album to the Background Panel at the bottom left of the titler display. See “The

Background Panel” on page 277 for details.

The Objects section

The Objects section of the Motion Titler Album contains bitmapped clip art and decorations for your titles. Except that they are provided as resources with the Motion Titler rather than as files in an image folder, they are used in exactly the same way as the images in the Photos section.

Selecting and dragging an image from the Objects section for use in a motion title. Use the dropdown list at the top of the section to select one of the available image categories.

When added as a background by dragging to the

Background Panel, the images are stretched to fill the

available space. When added as an ordinary layer, the images are initially centered in the Edit Window frame at their original size. They can then be repositioned, resized and rotated as needed.

The Looks section

This section of the Motion Titler Album provides visual styles that can be applied to the text and shape layers in your motion title.

Preset looks

The easiest way to use looks is to select one of the icons in the Presets tab. The dropdown list above the icons lets you choose the built-in presets (“Standard”), or those you have designed yourself (“My Looks”).

Switching from the Standard (built-in) preset looks to the customized presets in My Looks. To begin creating a customized look, select a preset to use as a starting point, then click the Settings tab.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 267

To apply a preset look to a text or vector graphics layer, first select the layer with the mouse by clicking in the

Edit Window (page 279) or the Layer List (page 286).

You can affect multiple layers simultaneously using multiple selection or a layer group (page 293).

Having selected the layer or layers to change, use one of the following methods to apply a look:

Double-click the icon for the chosen look.

Right-click the icon and select layer(s) from the context menu.

Add to selected

• Drag from the icon onto the layer in the Edit

Window (or onto any one of multiple selected or grouped layers).

Cloning a style

Rather than applying a preset as such, you can also clone a look as part of a style , which in the case of text layers includes font information as well as the attributes of the look itself. Use Copy style on the context menu of the source layer, and Paste style on that of the destination layer, to achieve this.

Customizing looks

The Settings tab provides access to the Looks Editor, where you can examine, modify, add or delete the individual detail layers that contribute to a look.

There are three types of detail layer: face (surface), edge and shadow . The three types differ not in the settings they support, but in the default position at which they will be inserted in the layer stack. Unless explicitly dragged out of position, face details always appear at the top of the stack, followed by edges , and finally shadows . After a detail has been created,

however, it can be dragged up or down in the layer stack as desired.

Face, Edge and Shadow: A new face detail (left, top) is added above the uppermost existing face layer; new edge and shadow details are added below the bottommost layer of their respective types.

The properties of individual detail layers can be modified by means of controls on collapsible edit panels in the Looks Editor.

The Looks Editor is opened by clicking the Settings tab in the Looks section of the Motion Titler Album.

The title bar shows the name of the current look

(‘Nautilus’) and three buttons for creating new detail layers. The edit panel for the Face 3 detail is open; below it, the panel for Face 2 is closed.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 269

The following detail properties are available:

• Offset X and Offset Y : These sliders set the position of the detail layer relative to the nominal position of the text or graphic to which the look is applied. The range of offset is -100 (left, or bottom) to +100

(right, or top). The maximum offsets represent one eighth the width and one eighth the height of the Edit

Window work area.

In this example, a look with three detail layers has been applied to a single text layer. The detail layers are configured identically except for their offset values, as follows: top left (-100, 100); center (0, 0); bottom right (100, -100).

• Size : This slider sets the thickness of the segments used to draw the text or graphic, from zero to 200, where 100 represents the default thickness.

This example includes three detail layers with varying size values. From left to right: 80, 100, 120.

The visual effect of varying the size depends on the default thickness of the strokes in the layer. In a text layer, this depends the font family and size chosen.

Blur: As this slider increases in value from 0 to 100, the detail layer affected becomes increasingly ghostly and indistinct.

The detail layers in this example differ only in their blur settings. From left to right: 15, 0, 30.

• Fill: Click the color swatch button to open a standard color dialog in which the fill color of the detail layer can be set. You can also use the eyedropper button to pick up a color from the screen.

• Opacity: This slider sets the opacity of the detail layer from 0 (transparent) to 100 (opaque).

Working with detail layers

In addition to setting the properties of existing detail layers, the Looks Editor allows you to add details of any of the three types, to delete details, and to reorder the detail layer stack.

• To add a detail layer, click one of the three small buttons at the top right of the

Looks Editor. From left to right, these create a new face , edge and shadow layer respectively. The placement of the new detail layer in the layer stack is determined by its type, as explained above.

• To delete a detail layer, click the trashcan button at the right-hand end of the header bar of the detail’s edit panel.

To rename a detail layer, double-click its name, type the name you want, and press Enter.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 271

To close down or open up the edit panel of a detail layer, click the or button at the left-hand end its header bar.

To reorder detail layers, drag the header bar of the edit panel to its new location. If the look you are editing contains more than two or three layers, it can be easier to follow the action if you close down the panels first so that the whole stack is visible at once.

Saving a custom look

Once you have finished editing a custom look, you can save it to “My Looks” by clicking the Save Look button at the bottom of the Looks Editor. Before saving, it’s a good idea to rename the look. To do so, double-click the current name in the header bar of the editor, type a descriptive name for the look, and press Enter.

The Motions section

The Motions section of the Motion Titler Album contains the animation routines that give the

Motion Titler both its name and much of its power.

These motions are assigned to and operate on single layers in your title. The motions are divided into three classes based on the portion of the layer’s lifespan they affect: Enter , Emphasis and Exit .

• An Enter motion controls the arrival of the layer – its first appearance within the running title.

• An Emphasis motion maintains audience focus on the content of a layer by giving it an attention-getting action during its time on-screen.

An Exit motion takes the layer off-stage again, completing its life cycle.

Each layer is allowed to have one motion of each type.

All motions are optional, however, and it’s also quite possible to have a motion title with no motions at all.

A quick survey of the motions collection

In each of the three classes of motion, most of the animations can be grouped into several standard types based on their mode of action:

• Letter-based motions operate at the level of individual letters in a text caption (other layers are treated as consisting of a single “letter”). For instance, in the Enter motion “Letters turn”, the letters in the text layer are first seen edge on, then rotate in place one by one until all are in their normal orientation.

• Word-based motions work similarly, but with words as the smallest unit of animation. In the Enter motion “Words from bottom”, the words in the layer float up into position one by one from below the frame.

• Line-based motions are meant for layers with multiple lines of text, each of which is processed in turn. In the Enter motion “Lines from behind”, each line of text is brought onto the screen along a perspective track as though it originated from behind the viewer’s own position.

• Page-based motions affect the entire layer simultaneously. One example is the Enter motion

“Barrel roll”, which “rolls” the layer into position from above as though it were painted on the side of an invisible rolling barrel.

Most Enter motions have a corresponding Exit motion with which they can be paired if visual consistency is

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 273

desired. For example, a layer that enters with the

“Words from infinity” motion could be configured to exit with “Words to infinity”. However, this kind of consistency is only an option, not a requirement, and you can mix and match motions of the three types in any way you choose.

The Motions section of the Motion Titler Album has tabs for Enter, Emphasis and Exit motions. Each layer in a title can use one motion from each class.

Adding motions

To add a particular motion to a particular layer, first select the layer, then do any of the following:

Double-click the motion icon in the Album.

Drag the motion icon from the Album to an accessible layer (one not masked by other layers) in the Edit Window.

Drag the motion icon from the Album to the layer in the Layer List.

• Right-click the motion icon in the Album and choose

Add to selected layer(s) from the context menu.

Upon using any of these methods, the motion will be added to the layer, replacing the existing motion of the same type on that layer, if any. At the same time, a looping preview of the title animation will begin to run in the Edit Window so that you can immediately see the effect of the motion on the layer in the context of the overall title. See “Working with the Layer List” on page 286 for details on working with motions in the

Layer List.

™

C

REATING AND EDITING

M

OTION

T

ITLES

A title in Studio’s Motion Titler is built from elements of four types:

• The background layer: By default, the background is fully transparent. For overlay titles, this is normally what you want. For special purposes, or for full-screen titles, you can choose a solid color, an image, or video for the background. For additional flexibility, the Background Panel also includes a variable opacity slider. See “The Background Panel” on page 277.

• Video and image layers: The resources that make up these layers originate in the Videos, Photos and

Objects sections of the Motion Titler Album. The layers support the same operations as text and shape

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 275

layers except for the application of looks. See “The

Videos section” (page 264), “The Photos section”

(page 265) and “The Looks section” 265 for detailed information.

• Text and shape layers: These are “vector-based” layers, meaning that they are stored not as bitmapped images like video and photo files, but as a kind of

“recipe” for recreating the images from straight and curved line segments to which properties (e.g. color) and special effects (e.g. blur) can be applied. Like video and image layers, these vector-based layers can be dragged, resized, rotated and grouped, and you can apply motions to them. Unlike the other layers, however, they can also be customized with looks from the Looks section of the Motion Titler

Album. See “The Motions section” (page 272) and

“The Looks section” 267 for details.

• Motions: Motions are animation routines that can be applied to any layer in the title composition except the background. Motions are selected and applied from the Motions section of the Album. Once a motion has been applied to a layer, its timing can be adjusted in the Layer List timeline. See “The

Motions section” (page 272) and “Working with the

Layer List” (page 286) for further information.

Creating text and shape layers

To create a text layer, either click the Add

Text button in the header bar of the Layer

List, or simply double-click an empty area of the Edit

Window. A new layer containing default text will appear. The text is automatically selected, and will be replaced if you now begin to type.

To create a shape layer, click the Add Shape button (to the right of Add Text ), then make a selection on the pop-up menu. The available choices include circle, square, ellipse, rectangle, horizontal and vertical “pill” shapes, and triangle. Upon selection, a new layer of the given shape and a default size appears in the center of the Edit Window.

Editing layers

The remainder of this chapter provides details on editing layers in the Motion Titler.

• To learn about customizing the Background layer, see “The Background Panel” immediately below.

• For information on moving, resizing, rotating and rearranging all types of foreground layer, see “The

Edit Window” on page 279 and “Working with the

Layer List” on page 286.

To learn about editing text and setting text properties, see “Working with text” on page 282.

Multiple selection and grouping is covered under

“Working with layer groups” on page 293.

Finally, to learn how about motion editing in the

Layer List timeline, refer to “Working with the

Layer List” on page 286.

The Background Panel

Unlike the foreground layers in a motion title, the special background layer does not appear in the Layer

List, and is not modifiable in the Edit Window. Instead,

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 277

the background is controlled from the Background

Panel at the bottom left of the Motion Titler.

The Background Panel lets you create the background layer of a motion title. The preview area at the bottom shows the current content of the background without transparency or foreground layers. The area also serves as a target for dropping videos or images from the Motion Titler Album.

The default background for a motion title is fully transparent. If your motion title is on Studio’s overlay track or title track, any video or other images on the video track will be visible behind the title foreground.

To create a solid background, click either the color swatch button or the eyedropper button. The first brings up a standard color selection dialog, and the second allows you to pick up a color from anywhere on your computer’s display, inside or outside Studio’s own window.

To use video or a still image as your background, drag the item down from the Videos, Photos or Objects sections of the Motion Titler Album, and drop it on the preview area of the Background Panel.

To make the background translucent, position the knob on

the opacity slider anywhere between fully transparent

(all the way to the left) and fully opaque.

To reset the background to its default state, click the trashcan button.

The Edit window

The Edit Window is the main preview and editing area of the Motion Titler. This is where you rearrange, resize and rotate the foreground layers of your title.

A necessary first step for most kinds of editing is to select the layer or layers your want to affect. Selected layers are drawn within a frame with eight control points for sizing and a rotation handle for rotating the layer in one-degree increments. Most types of layer can be “grabbed” for dragging to a new position by clicking anywhere within the control frame.

Rotating a shape object within the Edit Window. The smaller arrow to the left of the mouse pointer is the rotation handle for the layer. To rotate a layer, click down on its rotation handle and drag.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 279

With text and shape layers, some of the layer content may appear outside the control frame. This occurs if one of the “details” within the look is defined with a horizontal or vertical offset that moves the detail away from the nominal location of the layer. See page 267 for more information.

Layer operations in the Edit Window

The operations described here are for a single layer, but can be extended to work with multiple layers simultaneously. See “Working with layer groups” on page 293 for more information.

To select a layer in the Edit Window, click it with the mouse. This causes the layer’s control frame to appear, ready for editing.

Layers respond to mouse clicks anywhere within their containing rectangle (the rectangle shown by their control frame when selected). This means that you may not be able to manipulate a layer that is visible only because it lies beneath a transparent area within the rectangle of another layer. To perform any editing with the mouse in such cases, you should first hide or lock the upper layer(s) as described under “Working with the Layer List”. See page 286 for details.

To move any non-text layer, click down anywhere within its rectangle and drag to the new position.

To move a text layer, position the mouse near the edge of the layer’s control frame until you see the drag pointer (four-way arrows) appear, then click and drag normally. Clicking inside the frame, as you would do a non-text layer, would

instead activate text-edit mode. See “Working with text” below for detailed information.

To resize a layer but retain its proportions, click down on a corner point of the control frame and drag outwards or inwards until the desired size is achieved.

To resize a layer and modify its proportions, click a side point of the control frame and drag. By resizing with the center control point on two adjacent sides in succession, you can produce any desired size and proportion.

To rotate a layer, click down on its rotation handle and drag. For finer control over the rotation, move the mouse pointer away from the center of rotation while dragging. The extra distance makes it possible to define smaller angles between one mouse position and the next.

To change the stacking position of a layer, right-click the layer, and select from its context menu one of the commands on the Layer submenu: Send to Back , Send

Back One Layer , Bring to Front , Bring Forward One

Layer . Convenient keyboard shortcuts are available for all four operations; respectively, Alt+Minus,

Ctrl+Minus, Alt+Plus and Ctrl+Plus.

Another approach to reordering layers, which may be more convenient in titles where several layers overlap, is to use the Layer List. The Layer List also allows individual layers to be “locked”, making them temporarily immune from manipulation. Although locked layers display at their usual stacking depth, they do not interfere with the selection of deeper layers by the mouse. See page 286 for details.

To delete a layer, select it, then – unless it’s a text layer – press Delete. Alternatively, you can use either

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 281

of the context menu commands Delete and Layer

¾

Delete Layer(s) . Why have two delete commands? In the case of a text layer in text-edit mode, the Delete command (and the Delete key) apply to the layer’s text only. To get rid of the layer altogether, the Layer submenu command is needed (or its equivalent, the trashcan button on the Layer List header bar).

Working with text

For all the graphical sophistication of the Motion Titler, in many instances the primary reason for using titles is the text they contain. The titler therefore provides several specialized options to help you ensure that you can get your text looking exactly the way you want.

The text operations we will look at below include:

Editing the text

Changing fonts, font sizes and styles

• Setting text justification and flow

• Copying and pasting text properties

Text-edit mode

As described elsewhere, when dragging a text layer you have to be careful to click at the edge of the control frame, rather than anywhere within it, to avoid accidentally putting the layer into text-edit mode . For the operations described here, however, text-edit mode is exactly what we want. In a newly-created text layer, text-edit mode is already enabled: you can begin to type immediately and the default text will be replaced.

To activate editing for an existing text layer, click anywhere inside the control frame. Text-edit mode becomes active and – to save you an often-required step – all existing text in the layer is automatically selected. As usual, selected text is indicated by highlighting.

A text layer with all text selected. From left to right, the text editing controls in the header bar above govern letter styling (bold, italic, underline); text alignment and text flow; and font name and size. In text-edit mode, the mouse pointer over the layer has the ‘I-beam’ shape as shown here.

To modify the text itself, simply start typing. The highlighted text disappears and the text you type takes its place. As you type, the current insertion point (the place in the text where new letters are inserted) is indicated by a vertical line.

If you want to add new text without losing what was already there, click at the desired insertion point after putting the layer in text-edit mode, or use the arrow keys to maneuver the insertion point as desired.

You can also highlight (and thus replace) only part of the text before typing: drag across the letters with the mouse, or hold down Shift while using the arrow keys. Lastly, if you want to select all the text in layer again, you can

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 283

use the mouse or arrow keys as just described, or give the standard shortcut Ctrl+A.

Styling highlighted text

As we have seen, the Motion Titler provides several text controls, most of them probably quite familiar to you from other applications. Those that apply to the highlighted text only are these:

• Font styling: To set or unset the bold, italic or underline properties of the selected text, use the toggle buttons in the header bar, or the standard keyboard shortcuts Ctrl+B,

Ctrl+I and Ctrl+U. The buttons light up when their respective style options are active.

• Font name: Your motion titles are the perfect place to experiment with fancy display fonts, so you’ll likely be accessing this dropdown list quite often. If you have many fonts on your system, the list can be quite long. For ease of navigation, pressing the first letter of a font name will take you instantly to the corresponding alphabetical location in the list. Click the font you want, or move to the name using the up and down arrow keys and press Enter.

To select a font, open the dropdown list and click the one you want. The font is applied to the currentlyhighlighted text only.

Font size: The Motion Titler provides several methods of setting the font size. You can enter a new value directly into the font-size edit field, or use the neighboring up and down arrow buttons to change the size in units of one point. Further to the right, the shrink font and enlarge font buttons change the size in intervals that widen as the font size increases.

Styling with looks

As explained in “The Looks section” on page 267, the appearance of text and shape layers can be transformed by the application of looks from the

Motion Titler Album. In a partially-highlighted text layer, applying a look affects only the highlighted text.

In principle, each of individual character in your title could be given its own look.

Copying and pasting text styles

With both text and shape layers, the Copy Style and

Paste Style context menu items let you copy looks from one layer to another without having to open the Looks section of the Motion Titler Album.

With text, this operation also clones the font name, size and style from one text layer to another, and also works on partial selections within or between text layers.

Text alignment

For titles with multiple lines of text, the Motion Titler provides a standard menu of justification options. The default for new text layers is center justification

( Align Center on the dropdown

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 285

list), in which each separate line is horizontally centered in the available space. The additional options provide for Align Left , Align Right and Justify .

In paragraph-oriented text software, the incomplete final line of a paragraph is usually not stretched across the full width of the column. In the Motion Titler, where the graphical appearance of the text is paramount, even a final line with as few as two characters is spaced to the same width as the others.

Text flow

To accommodate the various conventions of different languages with regard to the direction in which lines of text are written, and for maximum graphical design flexibility, the

Motion Titler offers a menu of eight text flow options. These options, which work in concert with the justification options just discussed, affect not just the way the text is displayed but also the meaning of standard keys like Home and End.

Working with the Layer List

The Layer List, which occupies most of the bottom part of the Motion Titler display, has two columns: one of layer headers, and one of timeline tracks. In each row, the header contains the name of the layer, a visibility button and a lock button. To the right of the header, the timeline track serves as a graphical editor for

controlling the lifespan of the layer within that of the title as a whole, and the durations of any motions that have been assigned to the layer. The Layer List timeline self-adjusts its resolution so as to make visible the title’s full duration, which you can set either by trimming in Edit mode or by entering a value directly into the Duration counter at the top right of the titler.

In addition to the layer headers and timeline, the Layer

List has a header bar that is home to several important groups of controls (see “The Layer List header bar” below).

The left-hand portion of the Layer List contains the layer headers; to the right is an animation timeline where the timing of each layer, and of any motions applied to them, is displayed and can be modified.

(Only the leftmost portion of the timeline is shown here.)

Selecting layers

Clicking a header in the Layer List has the same effect as selecting the layer in the Edit Window (and vice versa). The layer name highlights, and the layer’s control frame appears. Multiple selection is also allowed, using the standard Windows mouse and keyboard combinations Shift+Click (extend selection),

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 287

Ctrl+Click (toggle selection of one item), and

Shift+Ctrl+Click (extend selection from last item clicked). See “Working with layer groups” on page 293 for information on how to use multiple selections.

Layer names and renaming

When you create a new layer, the Motion Titler gives it a default name based on the resource name or file name. Since the default names are often not very descriptive of the layer contents, it may be helpful in a title with a number of layers to give them custom names that make it easier to tell at a glance which name goes with which layer.

The name of a new text layer is the same as its default text, i.e “Text”. Unless you give the layer a custom name, its default name will continue to match whatever text you type into the layer. Once you do rename a text layer, further changes to the text are no longer reflected in the layer name. The default behavior can be restored by setting a blank name, however.

To rename a layer, double-click the existing name. An edit field opens with the existing name selected. Type the new name, then press Enter or click outside the edit field to conclude the operation.

Reordering layers

As we saw on page 280 (“Layer operations in the Edit

Window”), the position of a layer in the layer stack can be altered by means of commands on the Layer context submenu, or by keyboard shortcuts such as Alt+Plus

( Layer

¾

Bring to Front ).

The Layer List offers a more direct approach: simply drag the layer header to a new position in the list. This is particularly handy in situations where overlapping layers make mouse selection difficult. As you drag the layer, an insertion line shows where the layer will appear in the list when dropped.

Using multiple selection (see “Selecting layers” above) you can drag several layers at once to a new position.

Hiding and locking layers

A complex title can get crowded very quickly as you add layers to the composition, and motions to the layers. The two buttons at the right-hand end of the layer header are handy, each in their own way, for simplifying such situations.

Click the eye-shaped visibility button to temporarily remove a layer from the Edit Window. The layer’s information and settings are preserved, but you will be able to work on other layers for the time being without the hidden layer obscuring either your view or your mouse actions. Click again to restore the layer to visibility.

Click the padlock-shaped lock button to prevent the layer from responding to mouse actions without hiding it from view. This allows you to work freely on deeper layers without losing the visual context that the upper layers provide. Click again to unlock the layer.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 289

The Layer List header bar

The controls and readouts on the header bar are in five groups. From left to right:

The Add Text and Add Shape buttons allow you to create new “vector-based” layers to which looks from the

Motion Titler Album can be applied. Clicking Add Text immediately adds a new text layer with a default look and caption. As a shortcut for Add Text , you can simply double-click any unused area of the Edit Window.

Clicking Add Shape opens a pop-up menu from which you can select a particular shape to add.

• The Layer Alignment , Grouping and

Layer buttons each open pop-up menus of commands affecting multiple layers. The

Layer menu provides the same functions as the Layer context submenu described under “Layer operations in the Edit Window” (page 280). The Layer

Alignment and Grouping menus are covered below

(“Working with layer groups”).

The transport buttons allow you to preview your motion title without leaving the titler. The preview loops continuously once started; to halt it, click anywhere on the Edit Window. As usual, the space bar on your keyboard provides a convenient shortcut for stopping and starting playback. From left to right, the functions of the five buttons are: jump to start , go back one frame , play/pause , advance one frame , and jump to end .

The copy , paste and delete buttons (or their standard keyboard equivalents

Ctrl+C, Ctrl+V and Delete), allow you to duplicate or delete layers of all types. Copy and paste encompass not just the visual properties of the layer but also any timing changes you have made or motions you have assigned.

In the case of text layers in text-edit mode, the copy operation applies not to the layer but to the selected text within it. To select a text object for copying without putting it into text-edit mode, either mark out a rectangle that intersects the layer, or click its header in the Layer List.

In text-edit mode the Delete key applies to the selected text; however, the delete button on the Layer

List header bar always deletes the current layer even for text layers.

• The counter shows the current position of the Layer List timeline scrubber in the usual hours, minutes, seconds and frames format.

A Motion Title is like a stage on which the layers are actors who come on for their big scene and then depart. Trimming the layers in the Layer List timeline allows you to control precisely the timing of their entrances and exits.

Editing layers and motions on the Timeline

When a layer is created, its duration is set to the full span of the title of which it is a part. To delay the first

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 291

appearance of a layer in the running title, or to banish the layer before the title itself is complete, drag the ends of the layer along the timeline in the same fashion as clip editing on the Movie Window timeline.

Up to three motions – one of each type – are allowed to each layer; these are also displayed on the timeline, where their durations too can be adjusted. Enter and exit motions are each anchored to their respective ends of the layer lifespan, but the end of the enter motion and the start of the exit motion can be freely edited with the mouse. If the layer has an emphasis motion, it occupies whatever unused duration remains.

Three layers with motions. The top layer has only an

Emphasis motion (solid line), which therefore uses the full duration. The bottom layer has Enter and

Exit motions, and a static interval between them. The center layer has motions of all three types. The Enter motion is being trimmed (note the horizontal arrow cursor); as its length changes, the Emphasis motion self-adjusts to consume fully any unused time.

To replace one of the motions used by a layer, simply add the new motion as usual: an existing one of that type will be overwritten.

To delete a motion without replacing it, click the small ‘x’ in the center of the motion’s timeline graph.

Working with layer groups

The Motion Titler allows you to group layers either on a temporary or a permanent footing.

To create a temporary group, you will use standard multiple selection techniques either in the Edit Window or on the Layer List. You can then make changes, such as applying a look, to all the members of the group simultaneously. The group remains whole only until you click another layer or an empty area of the Edit

Window, whereupon the layers resume their individual existences. In a temporary group, the control frames of each member are all visible at once.

To create a permanent group, you first create a temporary group, then give the Group command from the Grouping menu on the Layer List header bar (or from any member layer’s Grouping context submenu).

Once created, the group stays together until you explicitly break it either with another menu command

( Ungroup) , or by dragging the member layers out of the group in the Layer List. The same menu provides one further command ( Regroup ) that automatically reconstitutes the last group to have been ungrouped.

When a permanent group is selected, it has a shared control frame that encloses all its members. The control frames of the individual members are not visible.

Permanent groups have their own header entries and timeline track in the Layer List. The group header can be expanded or collapsed to reveal or hide the headers for the member layers. When the group is open, its member layers are indented with respect to the group header.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 293

An ordinary layer and a group with three member layers in the Layer List. The timeline graphics show that motions have been applied to the group itself and to one of its members. The mouse pointer is positioned to collapse the group, which would hide the names of the member layers.

Temporary groups and permanent groups respond differently to many commands as detailed below.

Note: Even when a layer belongs to a permanent group, it can still be individually selected, either in the

Edit Window (unless the group itself is currently selected) or the Layer List. A member layer can even be added to a temporary group with other layers inside or outside the permanent one.

Multiple selection of layers

The first step in making a group is to select the multiple objects that will comprise it. In the Edit Window, this can be accomplished in two ways:

By clicking and dragging with the mouse to mark out a selection rectangle (a “marquee”) that intersects all the objects you want to group; or,

By clicking the first object you want to group, then

Ctrl-clicking each of the others.

Another approach to multiple selection uses the Layer

List, as described above under “Working with the

Layer List”.

Edit Window operations on the group

Both temporary and permanent groups can be repositioned, resized and rotated:

To reposition any group, drag it to the new position as though it were an individual layer.

• To rotate a permanent group, drag the rotation handle of the shared control frame. All members of the group revolve about their common center like planets revolving around the Sun.

• To rotate a temporary group, drag the rotation handle of any member. All members of the group rotate about their own centers like planets rotating on their axes.

• To resize a permanent group, drag any control point of the shared frame. The size of the whole group changes as though you were stretching a rubber sheet with all the layers painted on it.

• To resize a temporary group, drag any control point of any member’s control frame. Each layer is affected individually, expanding or contracting in place about its own center.

In resizing operations on groups, as with individual layers, dragging by a corner control point preserves the aspect ratio of the layer, whereas dragging by a side control point allows the proportions to be altered.

Applying properties to a group

Once a temporary group is selected, any property settings you make will affect every member of the group to whom the property is applicable:

If you apply a look, any text or shape member will receive it.

Chapter 13: The Motion Titler 295

If you add a motion by right-clicking a motion icon and choosing Add to selected layer(s) , the result will be the same as if you had added it to each member individually.

If you select a font, or change any other text styling attribute, every text member of the temporary group will be updated.

Except in the first case, permanent groups have their own rules for these operations:

• If you apply a look, it works the same as with a temporary group.

• If you add a motion to a permanent group, the group is treated for the purposes of animation as a single graphic object, without regard to the letters, words or lines its members may contain. However, the individual motions of its members continue to run along with that of the group as a whole.

Text stylings cannot be applied to a permanent group.

Aligning layers in temporary groups

The final type of group operation, one that applies to temporary groups only, is provided by the

Layer Alignment menu. This is accessed with a button on the

Layer List header bar, or on the context menu for any layer that is currently part of a temporary group.

The commands, of which there are three for horizontal and three for vertical alignment, affect all the members of the group except for the first selected, which sets the position for the others.

CHAPTER 14:

Sound effects and music

Video may be thought of as primarily a visual medium, but the role of sound in your movies is often no less important than that of the images on the screen.

Feature film and television productions include numerous types of audio, beginning with the dialog and other sounds created during live action. In your movies, that raw soundtrack is brought in along with the video during Capture mode. It appears in the Movie Window

Timeline view on the original audio track below the video track. Original audio may also appear on the overlay audio track.

Most commercial productions also require sound effects – slamming doors, crashing cars, barking dogs, etc. – and incidental music, which may consist of music created especially for the production, songs taken from recordings, or both. Voice-overs and other customized audio are also often needed.

You can use all these types of add-on sound in your own movies:

A good starter set of wav format effects is installed with Studio, and others are widely available.

The Background music tool automatically creates a music track of your selected duration and style.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 297

You can drop mp3 files from the Album onto the

Timeline or import audio or MP3 tracks from a CD with the CD audio tool.

• The Voice-over tool lets you add narration or commentary as you preview your edited video.

Audio, whatever its type, is added to your production as clips in the Movie Window. These can be moved around, trimmed and edited in much the same way as video clips and still images.

Once a sound clip is part of your movie, you can modify it with fades and other volume adjustments. An easy way to create audio fades and cross-fades is to add transitions to your audio clips (see page 315).

You can adjust the positioning of your clips within a stereo or surround mix, and even change that positioning arbitrarily within the clip. You can also apply Studio’s audio effects, including noise reduction and reverb among others.

Availability: Surround sound is supported in Studio Ultimate only.

About surround sound

A “surround” mix goes beyond the two channels of stereo to provide a theater-style enveloping sound field for your DVD productions. Studio lets you set the apparent position of each audio track independently within the mix, and to “pan” the track (reposition it, whether smoothly or abruptly) in any desired direction as often as necessary over the course of your movie.

To preview surround sound while editing in Studio, you need a sound card that supports 5.1 channel output.

A surround soundtrack can be output to the DVD in either of two forms:

• In Dolby Digital 5.1 format, each of the six surround channels is stored discretely on the disc and will be routed directly to the corresponding speaker when played back on a full 5.1 surround playback system.

• In Dolby Digital 2.0 format, the surround mix is encoded onto two channels. When your DVD is played back on systems with a Pro Logic or Pro

Logic 2 decoder, and a 5.1 or better speaker layout, the original surround information is recreated. On other systems, the encoded soundtrack will be heard as conventional stereo.

Note: Even if you cannot hear your surround mix when previewing, it will still appear on your DVDs, but a surround preview allows more accurate mixing.

Creating a soundtrack file

Studio lets you output your movie soundtrack as an audio file in wav (PCM), mp3 or mp2 format. Simply open the File tab in Make Movie mode as usual and select Audio as your file type. Several presets are available, with some typical settings for standard file types. The Custom preset lets you configure the type and settings of the output file as desired.

Soundtrack file output presets

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 299

The Timeline audio tracks

The Movie Window’s Timeline view contains several audio tracks:

Original audio track: This contains the audio captured along with your video clips. It is sometimes called

“synchronous” audio because it is recorded simultaneously with the video track.

Overlay audio track: The original audio for video clips on the overlay track.

Sound effect and voice-over track: Sound effects and voice-overs are the typical content on this track. Sound effects are brought into your project from the Sound

Effects section of the Album (see “The Sound Effects section” on page 84). Voice-overs are created with the

Voice-over tool (described on page 305).

The Timeline audio tracks: original audio, sound effect and voice-over, and background music. When the overlay track is visible, a fourth audio track appears for the original audio for overlay video.

Background music track: Use this track to include mp3 or wav audio files, ScoreFitter background music

generated by Studio, and music (or other content) from audio compact disks (CDs). Audio files are imported via the Music section of the Album (see page 85).

Create ScoreFitter clips with the Background music tool, and CD audio clips with the CD audio tool (see

“The Background music tool” on page 303 and “The

CD audio tool” on page 302).

Switching audio tracks

Although the audio tracks do have their specialized roles, as described above, these mainly control the choice of track where new clips will appear. Original audio will always be placed on the original audio track when a new video clip is brought in; new voice-overs will always be created on the sound effects and voiceovers track; and new CD audio and ScoreFitter clips will be added to the background music track.

Once a clip has been created, however, you can move it to a different audio track if it is convenient to do so: each track is actually able to accommodate any type of audio clip. This gives you the flexibility to use two sound effects simultaneously, for example, simply by placing one of them on the background music track.

The only audio track with special status is original audio , either for the main video track or, when it’s in use, the overlay track. By default, audio clips on this track are edited in parallel with the contents of the video track at the same time index. To treat the original audio as a separate clip for trimming, or to drag it onto another audio track while leaving the video intact, or to drag other sound clips onto an original audio track, first lock the video track (by clicking the padlock icon on the right side of the Movie Window). See “Advanced

Timeline editing” on page 126 for more information.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 301

The CD audio tool

Use this tool to create an audio clip from a CD track. You can preview tracks within the tool, and select either a whole track or an excerpt to add to your movie.

If there is a CD in the drive that you have not previously used in a Studio project, Studio will ask you to enter its name before continuing. The controls on the tool will become available only when Studio can offer at least one entry on the CD Title dropdown list.

Select the CD from which you wish to capture audio in the CD Title dropdown list, and a track on that CD from the Track list. Since CD Title is also an editable text field, you can change the name by which Studio refers to this CD, if desired. The name change applies to both the current and future sessions.

Having selected the CD and track, you can now optionally trim the clip and give it a custom name using the other controls on the tool. These controls are common to most audio clip types, and are used for editing as well as creating clips. They are covered on

page 308 under “Trimming with the Clip properties tool”.

Finally, click the Add to Movie button. Studio captures the music clip from the CD drive and adds it to the background music track beginning at the current time index (as shown by the Timeline scrubber and the preview frame in the Player).

The Background music tool

Studio’s ScoreFitter automatically creates background music in the style of your choice.

Within that style, you select one of several songs , and within that song, any of a number of versions . The list of versions available also depends on the duration of background music you specify.

To create music for a particular set of clips, select those clips before opening the Background music tool. (To select your whole movie, use Edit

¾

Select All or press

Ctrl+A.) The total length of the selected clips will determine the initial setting for the music duration, though you can modify the value at any time by

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 303

trimming on the Timeline or directly editing the

Duration counter in the tool.

In the Background music tool, choose a style, song and version from the lists provided. Each style offers its own selection of songs, and each song its own selection of versions. Use the Preview button to audition the song while the tool is open.

Enter a name for the clip in the Name field and adjust its duration with the Duration counter, if desired. The music clip you create will be adjusted to fit exactly the duration you select.

When you have made your choice, click the Add to

Movie button. Studio creates the new clip on the background music track beginning at the current time index (as shown by the Timeline scrubber and the preview frame in the Player).

Expanding your song collection

ScoreFitter songs come in collections called “libraries”.

The Standard library, which is included with Studio, includes more than 40 songs in styles ranging from

Folk to Electronica. Additional libraries may be purchased from within Studio as they become available by clicking the Get More Songs button. Click the

Library radio button to see your song collection categorized by library rather than by style.

Using SmartSound

®

If you have installed songs in SmartSound format on your computer, these too will be available for use in the

Background music tool. To switch between your

ScoreFitter and SmartSound song collections, make the appropriate choice on the Source dropdown list at the top of the tool window.

The Voice-over tool

Recording a voice-over in Studio is as easy as making a telephone call. Just open the Voiceover tool, click Record and speak into the microphone.

You can narrate as you watch the movie play so your words match the action on the screen. You can also use the tool as a quick way of capturing ambient music or home-made sound effects via your microphone.

Before you can record audio using the Voice-over tool, you need to connect a microphone to the input jack of your PC sound board. You must also have at least one video clip in the Movie Window.

Review the video scenes in your movie and decide where you want the voice-over to begin and end. When you are ready, open the Voice-over tool. Note that the recording lamp – the dark rectangle in the upper left of the above illustration – is not lit.

Select your starting point on the Movie Window

Timeline. You may do this by selecting a clip, playing the movie and stopping it at the desired point, or by moving the Timeline scrubber.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 305

Position the microphone for use and try speaking a test phrase to check your recording level (see “Voice-over level” below). When you are satisfied, click the Record button (which toggles to a Stop button). Wait for a few moments as the recording lamp first signals

STAND BY then steps through a 3-2-1 countdown.

When the recording lamp signals RECORDING , and the movie begins to play back in the Player, perform your narration.

Finally, click the Stop button. The lamp goes out, and the voice-over clip is automatically placed on the sound effects and voice-overs track. Review the clip by selecting it then clicking the Play button.

Voice-over level

The record level for a voice-over clip is set when you create the voice-over and cannot be changed thereafter. However, you can adjust the playback volume at any time.

The record level is set with the Recording level slider and its accompanying level meter on the Voice-over tool.

Watch this meter to make sure your recording levels don’t get too high or low. The indicator changes color from green (0-70% modulation), through yellow, to red. Generally, you should try to keep your audio peaking in the yellow (71-90%) and out of the red (91-

100%).

Voice-over recording options

The Studio setup dialogs include several settings that affect your recording configuration and quality. This section provides a brief summary. See “Video and audio preferences” on page 355 for detailed information.

To access these options select Setup

¾

Video and audio preferences from the main menu bar.

The Microphone dropdown list on this dialog lists the multiple ways a microphone can be connected to your particular sound card. The entries on the list should look something like the following, from a system with an NVIDIA® sound card:

Choose from this list, then connect your microphone in the manner indicated (e.g. Microphone or Line In ).

The Channels and Sample rate adjustments on the options dialog control the quality of voice-overs or other recorded audio. Set them at the highest quality level you anticipate needing, but keep in mind that increasing quality requires more disk space.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 307

™

T

RIMMING AUDIO CLIPS

As with other clip types, you can trim audio clips either directly on the Timeline or by using the Clip properties tool. See “Trimming on the Timeline using handles” on page 117 for a discussion of the first method.

Most types of audio clip can be trimmed from a minimum of one frame up to the full original length of the clip content. ScoreFitter clips can be trimmed on the Timeline down to as little as three seconds, and upward without limit.

Trimming with the Clip properties tool

The Toolbox

¾

Modify Clip Properties menu command invokes the Clip properties tool for the selected clip. You can also access the tool by doubleclicking any audio clip.

To begin with, the tool provides controls that let you view or edit two properties shared by all clips:

• To set the duration of the clip, change the value in the Duration counter.

• The Name text field lets you assign a custom name to the clip to replace the default one assigned by Studio.

The clip name is used by the Movie Window’s List view, and can also be viewed as a fly-by label when your mouse hovers over the clip in the Storyboard view.

The other controls provided by the tool depend on the type of audio clip you give it.

Original audio, sound effects and voice-overs

The Clip properties tool provides the same kind of trimming controls for sound-effect and voice-over clips as for video clips, but displays a graph of the audio waveform instead of visual preview areas.

To learn how to trim with these controls, see

“Trimming with the Clip properties tool” on page 122.

Remember that clips on the original audio and the overlay audio tracks can only be edited independently when the corresponding video track is locked. See

“Advanced Timeline editing” on page 126.

CD Audio

For CD Audio clips, the Clip properties tool uses the same trimming controls as above, but additionally provides dropdown selectors for CD Title and Track .

You can use these to change the source of the clip at any time. CD Title is also an editable text field, so you can enter the actual title of the CD.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 309

ScoreFitter

ScoreFitter clips can be edited to almost any length, except that very short clips at some particular durations may not be available in every combination of Style and

Song. This tool is essentially identical to the tool for creating ScoreFitter clips (described under “The

Background music tool” on page 303), except that the

Add to movie button is replaced by the Accept changes button.

™

A

UDIO VOLUME AND MIXING

The audio levels and stereo positioning of individual clips can be adjusted either directly on the Timeline, or with the Volume and balance tool. Each technique offers its own advantages. Adjusting on the Timeline gives you a good sense of time versus volume or balance, whereas the Volume and balance tool facilitates mixing – separately adjusting the volume and stereo balance of each of the audio tracks.

For disc authoring, the Volume and balance tool lets you choose to create a surround soundtrack, rather than stereo. The tool lets you dynamically position any of the audio tracks from front to rear as well as left to right.

Availability: Surround sound is supported in Studio Ultimate only.

Anatomy of an audio clip

An audio clip icon on the Timeline has several parts.

The boundaries of each clip are denoted by vertical bars. The actual content of the audio is indicated by a waveform graph:

Waveform graph excerpt from three neighboring clips.

The appearance of the waveform graph tells you something about the character of the sound. A quiet sound has a narrow waveform, close to the centerline of the clip. A loud sound has a waveform with larger peaks and troughs, reaching almost to the borders of the clip. A continuous sound, such as a car engine, has many pulses packed closely together. A staccato sound has brief pulses separated by silences where the waveform is a horizontal line.

Adjustment lines

The orange volume line graphically models the volume changes you have made to the track and clip. If you have not adjusted the volume at all, the line runs straight along the clip at about three-quarters of the clip height. This is the “zero gain” (0 dB) level, where the clip’s original volume has been neither increased nor decreased.

If you raise or lower the volume of the entire track, the volume line remains horizontal, but is now higher or lower than the zero-gain base level.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 311

Finally, if you make volume adjustments within the clip, the line consists of sloping segments that meet at volume adjustment handles .

Unlike the waveform graph, or the adjustment lines for balance and fade (see below), the volume adjustment line is scaled logarithmically . Perceived volume varies logarithmically with the strength of an audio signal, so this feature allows the adjustment line to model more accurately what you really hear. For instance, an upward-sloping line segment will produce a smooth, steady fade up from the starting to the ending level.

The green stereo balance line and the red front-back balance (“fade”) line work similarly to the volume line, except that in both cases the neutral position is the vertical center of the clip, and the adjustment scale is linear.

Raising the stereo balance line positions the audio clip’s output further to the listener’s left, while lowering it positions the clip further to the listener’s right. Similarly, raising the fade line moves the clip away from the listener, and lowering it brings the clip towards the listener.

Note: You can only view and edit a clip’s fade line when the Volume and balance tool is in surround mode. The effect of adjusting the line can be previewed only on systems where surround-sound playback is available.

To select which of the three adjustment lines is currently displayed, use the audio clip’s right-button context menu:

.

Availability: Surround sound is supported in Studio Ultimate only.

Adjusting audio on the Timeline

Audio levels can be adjusted directly within a clip on the Timeline. Use the mouse pointer to adjust the volume line or either of the balance lines (see

“Anatomy of an audio clip” on page 311).

When you add a new audio clip to the Timeline:

• The volume adjustment line of the newly-created clip connects the lines from the preceding and following clips if any are present.

• If no volume adjustments have been made to other clips on the track, the volume line through the new clip is horizontal. Its height reflects the overall track volume as set in the Volume and balance tool.

If no volume adjustments have been made either to other clips or to the overall track volume, the volume line through the new clip is at three-quarters height.

To adjust the volume of a clip on the Timeline, select it

(by left clicking), then move your mouse pointer close to the line.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 313

The volume adjustment cursor will appear:

Click the left mouse button, and drag up or down in the clip. The volume line bends as it follows the mouse.

When you release the mouse, Studio creates an adjustment handle on the volume line.

When your mouse pointer is positioned over an adjustment handle on a selected clip, a highlighted version of the volume adjustment cursor appears. With this cursor, you can click and drag the adjustment handle both vertically and horizontally.

Right-click an adjustment handle to access the context menu command Delete volume setting . This command removes one adjustment handle. Use Remove volume changes to remove all the handles from the clip.

Adjusting balance and fade

The left-right and front-back balance lines have the same editing features as the volume line just discussed, except that with them the neutral setting is at half the clip height, instead of three-quarters as it is for volume.

In the case of left-right (stereo) balance, adjusting the line upwards from the center positions the audio further to the left. With front-back balance (“fade”), adjusting

the line upwards moves the apparent source of the audio away from the listener; adjusting it downwards brings the audio closer (towards the rear speakers).

Removing changes

Audio adjustment handles can be removed either individually or for an entire audio clip at once. Select the appropriate command on the clip’s right-button pop-up menu:

Transitions on the audio tracks

A quick way to create a fade at the beginning or end of an audio clip is simply to add a Fade transition as you would for a video clip. See Chapter 9:

Transitions for details.

To get a cross-fade between two adjacent audio clips, simply drop a Dissolve transition onto the

Timeline track between them. (Actually, any transition type other than Fade has the same effect, but Dissolve gives the best visual reminder of a cross-fade.)

Transitions on the audio track: Placed at the beginning of a clip, the Fade transition fades in; placed at the end, it fades out. The Dissolve transition creates a cross-fade between clips.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 315

The Volume and balance tool

Compared to adjusting audio on the Timeline, the Volume and balance tool offers a greater degree of adjustment functionality organized into one convenient location. It also provides both left-right and surround-sound balance controls. The tool operates in a similar way to a traditional audio mixer.

Availability: Surround sound playback is supported in Studio

Ultimate only.

The Volume and balance tool provides individual level controls for each of the audio tracks: original audio (left in illustration), overlay audio , sound effect and voice-over , and background music (right). The overlay audio controls are displayed only when the overlay video and audio tracks are open in the Movie

Window.

The balance control, located in the right-hand part of the tool, can position the audio of any clip – or part of one – in stereo (one-dimensional) or either of two surround (two-dimensional) modes. The mode is selected in the dropdown list above the control.

Each audio track has its own set of level controls. The set for the original audio track is shown at left.

The individual controls and displays include a track mute button n

. When this button is in its down position, no audio clips from the track will be used in your movie. The track mute button’s icon has a second purpose: it identifies which track the level controls apply to. This is the only visible point of difference amongst the three sets of controls (four if the overlay track is visible) .

The track level knob o raises or lowers the overall volume for the track. It therefore affects the vertical position of the volume adjustment lines on all clips on the track, but does not change their contour. Click on the knob and drag it with a clockwise rotation (up to the 2 o’clock maximum position) to increase the volume. Use a counterclockwise rotation (down to the

6 o’clock minimum) to lower the volume.

Level knobs, full off (L), default (C) and full on (R).

A sliding knob, the track fader p

, sets the current track level on a relative level scale q

, which is calibrated in decibels (dB). The 0 dB mark corresponds to the level at which the clip was recorded. The current level is displayed numerically in a separate readout r

.

The position of the fader knob shows the volume level at the current playback position in your movie, relative to the original level. Drag the knob up or down to modify the level. The knob is “grayed” (disabled) if

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 317

there is no clip on the track at the current time index. If the track is muted, the knob is grayed and set to the bottom of its range. Adjusting the fader results in a volume adjustment handle being added to the track as described above.

A track’s playback volume contour, or envelope , combines the overall track level with the relative level at each point on the track. This combined level, which is shown graphically by the volume adjustment lines on audio clips, is applied to the actual audio data to produce the track’s output level, as represented on the level meter s

, which illuminates during playback to show the level at the current time index.

The meter scale to the right of the level meter displays the output level. The unit is again dB, but on this scale

0 dB corresponds to the maximum digital sample value.

If the track volume reaches or exceeds this value, the output will be marred by audio “clipping” – the unpleasant sound produced by attempting to set volume levels outside the range of a digital signal. To avert this, adjust the fader such that the output level in the loudest parts of the track hovers around -6 dB to -3dB.

As a visual monitoring aid, the color of the level scale changes from green to yellow to orange as the output level – and thus the danger of clipping – increases.

Avoid letting the level stray above the yellow region. If clipping occurs, a red zone at the very top of the scale, the clipping indicator t

, lights and briefly remains lit to alert you that clipping has taken place.

The fade buttons u

produce a fade-in from or a fadeout to the current position of the movie. For a visual confirmation of their effect, watch the behavior of the clip’s volume adjustment line when the fade buttons are clicked. The fade duration is variable from zero to fiftynine seconds. Adjust it in the Project preferences

options panel ( Setup

¾

Project Preferences ) under

Volume fades . Fades are not available too close to the beginning or end of a clip.

The balance control

This control has three modes, stereo , surround and dialog , which you select from the dropdown list above the control. The mode can be changed whenever desired – even within an individual audio clip.

Availability: Surround sound is supported in Studio Ultimate only.

In any mode, the position of each track at each point in the movie is shown by its speaker icon, or “puck”. The icon matches the one on the muting indicator for the corresponding track.

In s tereo mode, you set the position of the track by dragging its puck left and right between a pair of main speakers:

Positioning the original audio in the middle of a stereo mix with the sound effects track (L) and the overlay track (R) on opposite sides. In this example the music track icon (right of center) is “ghosted”, indicating either that the track has been muted or that there is no clip on the track at this time index.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 319

In surround mode, you can position each track from front to back (“fade”) as well as from left to right

(“balance”). Each track can be independently placed anywhere within the rectangular listening area defined by the four corner speakers.

Dialog mode is similar in concept, but includes the center speaker at the front of the listening area. Sending a portion of a clip’s audio through the center helps stabilize the apparent location of the sound within the shifting surround mix. At the same time, the placement of the sound source can be freely varied in two dimensions as with the standard surround mode.

Surround and Dialog modes: At left, the music track, in Surround Mode, is positioned at the rear of the listening field. The original audio track at the same time index is in Dialog Mode, shown at right. The

Dialog mode focuses the original audio by including the center speaker in the mix.

There are two ways to set the position of a track’s icon in the balance control. Either click on any track’s icon and drag it to the desired position, or move it by dragging the triangular locator knobs below and to the right of the control. The locator knob below the balance

control adjusts the left-right positioning of the audio output from the currently-selected clip, while the knob on the right adjusts the front-back positioning.

Drag track icon directly (L) or with locator knob (R).

Viewing volume and balance contours

Each audio clip in your project displays a contour line showing one of its volume, left-right balance or frontback balance. To select which of the three types of line is displayed, use the commands on an audio clip’s right-button context menu (see “Anatomy of an audio clip” on page 311).

The contour lines can be modified directly on the

Timeline using adjustment handles . For details, see

“Adjusting audio on the Timeline” on page 313.

Chapter 14: Sound effects and music 321

CHAPTER 15:

Audio effects

You can modify any audio clip in your project using Studio’s plug-in audio effects, which are accessed with the Audio effects tool, the sixth tool in the Audio toolbox. The operation of this tool is identical to that of the Video effects tool. See “Using video effects” (page 155) for a complete description.

As with video effects, your library of audio plug-ins is expandable. Any audio effect using the popular VST standard can be used in Studio just like effects supplied with the program.

Icons for audio effects

In Timeline mode, any special effects you have applied to an audio or video clip are indicated by small icons along the bottom of the clip. These correspond to the categories shown by the Add new effect browser in the Audio effects and Video effects tools. Those categories are explained under

“Video Effects Library” on page

166.You can open the appropriate tool for parameter editing by double-clicking any of the icons.

Chapter 15: Audio effects 323

In the illustration, the Noise reduction effect has been applied to both audio clips. The star icon below the video clip shows that one or more of the effects in the

Fun category has been applied to it.

Copying audio effects

Effects can be copied and pasted between audio clips just as they can between video clips. See page 156 for details.

About the effects

The powerful Noise Reduction filter is provided in all versions of Studio. It is covered immediately below.

Studio Ultimate includes an extra group of audio effects. These are each briefly described starting on page 326. Full documentation of the parameters for the

Ultimate effects is included in their context-sensitive on-line help which can be viewed by clicking the help button at the top left of the parameters panel for each effect, or by pressing F1 when the panel is open.

In a special category is the Speed effect (see page 171), which operates on video and audio simultaneously.

Noise reduction

This advanced filter suppresses unwanted noise in any audio clip. The filter responds dynamically to the changing noise conditions within the clip. The preset you choose provides the starting point from which the adaptive algorithm proceeds.

You can often further improve your results by adjusting the Noise reduction and Fine tuning parameters. There

is a lag of about a second before any new setting has an audible effect, so make changes in small amounts then pause to check if there is an improvement.

Noise reduction: When a camcorder is used outdoors with the actors distant from the microphone, the

“source noise” may be very high, and to make matters worse the internal noise of the camcorder may be amplified to intrusive levels. If a lapel microphone connected to the line input of the camcorder were used when taping the scene, however, the source noise could be quite low. Adjust this control to match the noise conditions of the actual signal.

Fine tuning: This controls the amount of cleaning to be used. It is only needed when the Noise reduction level is low.

Auto adapt: When this option is checked, the filter automatically adjusts to changes in the type or amount of noise in the clip. The Fine tuning is not used when

Auto adapt is active.

Remove wind: This checkbox engages a filter that reduces wind noise and similar unwanted background sounds in the audio clip.

Note: The Noise reduction filter will help with a wide range of material, but it is not a panacea. Your results will vary depending on the original material and the severity and nature of the problems.

Chapter 15: Audio effects 325

™

U

LTIMATE EFFECTS

The Studio Ultimate pack of audio effects is included with Studio Ultimate only. Users of other Studio versions can obtain these effects by upgrading to Studio

Ultimate.

This section briefly introduces each effect in the group.

Full descriptions, including all parameters, are available in the context-sensitive help when the effect parameters window is open in Studio Ultimate.

ChannelTool

The basic action of this Studio Ultimate effect is to route your stereo audio signal. It allows you to connect either or both of the left and right input channels to either or both of the output channels. In addition,

ChannelTool offers special-purpose presets, including

Phase reverse and Voice removal – the “karaoke” effect.

Chorus

The Studio Ultimate Chorus effect creates a richer sound by repeatedly reintroducing “echoes” into the audio stream. By controlling properties like the frequency with which the echoes recur, and the decay

in volume from one repetition to the next, a variety of results is possible, including flanger-like sounds and other special effects.

DeEsser

This Studio Ultimate audio filter unobtrusively removes excessive sibilance from recorded speech.

Parameters allow you to fine-tune the effect to the particular recording you need to correct.

Equalizer

Graphic equalizers like this one in Studio Ultimate are similar in concept to the treble and bass “tone” controls on audio equipment, but provides a much finer degree of adjustment. Studio’s equalizer divides the audio spectrum into ten bands , each centered on a different sound frequency.

Chapter 15: Audio effects 327

The sliders let you increase or decrease the contribution of each band’s frequencies to the total sound over a range of 48 dB (-24 to +24). The adjustment to a band is applied full strength at the center frequency, and tapers to zero in either direction.

The display above the slider shows the activity across the audio spectrum as your project is played back.

Note: In musical terms, each equalization band covers one octave , and the center frequency is close in pitch to the note B.

Grungelizer

The Studio Ultimate Grungelizer adds noise and static to your recordings. It can make your clips sound as though you were hearing them on a radio with bad reception or a worn and scratched vinyl record.

Leveler

This Studio Ultimate effect helps compensate for a common problem in recording audio for video productions: the imbalance in the recorded volume of different elements in the original audio. For instance, your commentary as you shoot the video may be recorded at such a high level that it overwhelms other sounds at the location.

The trick in using the Leveler is to find a target volume somewhere between that of the loud and soft audio in the original clip. Below that volume, Leveler acts as an expander , increasing the original level by a fixed ratio.

Above the target volume, Leveler acts as a compressor , reducing the original level. With careful adjustment of the parameters, the internal balance of the audio can be significantly improved.

Reverb

The Studio Ultimate Reverb effect simulates the effect of playing back the source sound in a room of a given size and sound reflectivity. The interval between the arrival of the original sound at the listener’s ears and the first echoes is greater for a large room than a small one. The rate at which the echoes die away depends on both the room size and the reflectivity of the walls.

The presets for Reverb are named for the type of room they simulate – from the passenger cabin of a car all the way up to a huge underground cavern.

Chapter 15: Audio effects 329

Stereo Echo

The Stereo Echo effect, available in Studio Ultimate, allows you to set separate delays on each of the left and right channels, with feedback and balance controls to provide a variety of interesting sounds.

Stereo Spread

This Studio Ultimate effect allows you to decrease or increase the apparent width of the stereo listening field in an audio clip. Most often it is used to create a mix that sounds more open and spacious.

CHAPTER 16:

Making your movie

One of the great things about digital video is the large and growing number of devices that can make use of it.

Studio lets you create versions of your movie for whatever video viewers your audience will be using, from hand-held DivX players and mobile phones to

HDTV home theaters.

When you have finished editing your project, switch to

Make Movie mode by clicking the Make Movie button at the top of the screen.

This opens the Output Browser, which lets you tell

Studio with a few clicks everything it needs to know to output your movie in the form you want.

Begin by selecting the media type of your finished movie from the four tabs at the left side of the window:

Disc , File , Tape or Web .

Disc output lets you copy a movie onto a recordable disc in your computer’s CD, DVD,

HD DVD or Blu-ray recorder (also called a “burner”).

You can also ask Studio to create for you a copy, or

“image”, of the disc on your hard drive, without actually burning it. See page 334 for more information.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 331

File output creates files that can be viewed from your hard drive, your web-site, your portable movie player, or even your mobile phone. See page

338.

Tape output records your movie onto tape in a camcorder or VCR. This tab also lets you output the movie to your monitor screen. See page 346.

Web output creates a file including for uploading to YouTube or Yahoo! Video. On these popular web sites, your work has a potential audience of millions. See page 349.

The Output Browser. The tabs at left let you save to disc, file, tape or the Web. Other controls let you set output options as needed for the chosen media type.

On the right is a graphical display of disc usage.

Configuring output

Output can be configured quickly within each media type using the dropdown lists in the Output Browser.

If you need hands-on control, click the Settings button to open the correct panel of options for your chosen media type. When you have confirmed your settings, click the Create button to begin output.

Preparing your movie for output

Before your movie is completely ready for output some preprocessing will usually be required. In general,

Studio will need to “render” (generate video frames in the output format for) any transitions, titles, disc menus and video effects you’ve added to your movie. Any files generated by Studio during this process are stored in the auxiliary files folder, a location you can set using the folder button at the top of the Output Browser.

Create between markers

For output to file or to the Web, the Output Browser includes a pair of dropdown lists from which you can choose Timeline markers that define custom start and end points for output. Use one or both as required to produce excerpts of your movie for any reason.

Output to file or the Web can be delimited at one end or both by markers defined in Edit mode. The default limits – the actual start and end of your movie – are represented on the lists by ‘[start]’ and ‘[end]’.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 333

™

O

UTPUT TO DISC MEDIA

Studio can output movies directly onto VCD

(VideoCD), S-VCD (Super VideoCD), DVD, HD DVD and Blu-ray discs, if the requisite disc burning hardware is available on your system.

Whether or not you have a disc burner, Studio can also create a “disc image” – a set of files containing the same information that would be stored onto the disc – to a directory on your hard drive. The image can subsequently be burned to disc.

CD formats

If your system is equipped with a CD burner or a DVD burner, Studio can create VCD or S-VCD discs on either CD-R or CD-RW media.

Your VCD discs can be played back:

On a VCD or S-VCD player.

On some DVD players. Most DVD players can handle CD-RW media, but many will not reliably read CD-R. A majority of DVD players can handle the VCD format.

• On a computer with a CD or DVD drive and

MPEG-1 playback software (such as Windows

Media Player).

Your S-VCD discs can be played back:

• On an S-VCD player.

On some DVD players. Most DVD players can handle CD-RW media, but many will not reliably read CD-R. DVD players sold in Europe and North

America usually cannot read S-VCD discs; players sold in Asia often can.

• On a computer with a CD or DVD drive and

MPEG-2 playback software.

DVD, HD DVD and Blu-ray

If your system has a DVD burner, Studio can create three types of DVD disc: standard (for DVD players),

HD DVD format for HD DVD players, and AVCHD format for Blu-ray players.

If your system has an HD DVD or Blu-ray recorder, you can record onto any media supported by the device.

Your standard DVD discs can be played back:

On any DVD player that can handle the recordable

DVD format your burner creates. Most players can handle the common formats.

• On a computer with a DVD drive and suitable playback software.

• On any HD DVD player.

Your DVD or HD DVD disc in HD DVD format can be played back:

On any HD DVD player, including a drive-equipped

Microsoft Xbox 360.

On a computer with an HD DVD drive and suitable playback software.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 335

Your Blu-ray disc, or DVD disc in AVCHD format can be played back:

• On the Panasonic DMP-BD10, the Playstation 3, and other Blu-ray players (not all players support the

AVCHD format, but most do).

• On a computer with a Blu-ray drive and suitable playback software.

Outputting your movie

Studio creates your disc or disc image in three steps.

1.

2.

3.

First the entire movie must be rendered to generate the MPEG-encoded information to store on the disc.

Next, the disc must be compiled . In this phase,

Studio creates the actual files and directory structure that will be used on the disc.

Finally, the disc must be burned . (This step is skipped if you are generating a disc image rather than an actual disc.)

To output your movie to disc, or to a disc image:

1.

Click the Disc tab to bring up this display:

The two circular displays summarize your disc usage. The upper one shows the amount of hard

drive storage that will be required during the making of your movie, and the other shows an estimate of the time the movie will occupy on your writable disc.

Use the upper folder button to change the hard drive location Studio uses for storing auxiliary files.

If you are creating a disc image, it will also be stored in that folder. The matching button on the lower display lets you choose which burning hardware to use, if you have more than one device available.

2.

Select the Disc Type you are using, then whichever

Video Quality / Disc Usage preset best matches your intent.

If you wish to fine-tune your output settings, choose the Custom preset then click the Settings button to bring up the Make Disc options panel (see

“ Make disc settings” on page 360).

3.

Click the green Create disc button. Studio goes through the steps described above (render, compile, and if necessary burn) to create the disc or disc image you have specified in the Make Disc options panel.

4.

When Studio has finished the burning operation, it ejects the disc.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 337

Quality and capacity of disc formats

The differences amongst the various disc formats can be boiled down to these rules of thumb regarding the video quality and capacity of each format:

• VCD: Each disc holds about 60 minutes of MPEG-1 video, with about half the quality of DVD.

• S-VCD: Each disc holds about 20 minutes of

MPEG-2 video, with about two-thirds the quality of

DVD.

DVD: Each disc holds about 60 minutes of fullquality MPEG-2 video (120 minutes if the disc recorder supports dual-layer recording).

• DVD (AVCHD): Each disc holds about 40 minutes of full-quality AVCHD video per layer.

• DVD (HD DVD): Each disc holds about 24 minutes of full-quality DVD HD video per layer.

• DVD HD: Each disc holds about 160 minutes of full-quality DVD HD video per layer.

BD: Each disc holds more than 270 minutes of HD video per layer.

™

O

UTPUT TO FILE

Studio can create movie files in all of these formats:

3GP

Audio only

AVI

DivX

Flash Video iPod compatible

MOV

MPEG-1

MPEG-2

MPEG-2 TS

MPEG-4

Real Media

Sony PSP compatible

Windows Media

Choose whichever format matches the needs of your audience and the details of their viewing hardware.

The size of the output file depends on both the file format and the compression parameters set within the format. Although compression settings can easily be adjusted to produce small files, heavy compression comes at the expense of quality.

The detailed settings for most formats can be adjusted by choosing the Custom preset and clicking the

Settings button. Other presets load settings designed for typical situations. See Appendix A: Setup options for information about options in Studio.

The File tab of the Output Browser

Chapter 16: Making your movie 339

When your output options are in place, click the Create file button. A file browser opens to let you specify a name and location for the video file you are creating.

As a convenience, the Output Browser also provides buttons for launching any desired media file in Windows Media Player or Real

Player, so you can view your output file in an external player as soon as you have created it.

3GP

Studio can generate movies in this widely-used file format using your choice of MPEG-4 or H.263 video compression, along with AMR audio compression. The format is adapted to the comparatively modest processing and storage capabilities of mobile phones.

The list of presets for this file type offers two frame sizes in either encoder. Choose Small, at 176x144, or

Very Small, at 128x96.

Audio only

Sometimes a movie’s soundtrack can stand alone without visuals. Live entertainment footage, and video recordings of interviews and speeches are instances in which an audio-only version might be desirable.

Studio lets you save your soundtrack in wav (PCM), mp3 or mp2 format.

Click the preset that best meets your needs; or choose

Custom , then click the Settings button to open the Make

File options panel (see page 365).

AVI

Although the AVI file type for digital video is itself widely supported, the actual coding and decoding of video and audio data in an AVI file is performed by separate codec software.

Studio supplies a DV and an MJPEG codec. If you wish to output your movie as an AVI in some other format, you can use any DirectShow-compatible codec installed on your PC, as long as that codec is also installed on the PC that will play your movie.

Click the preset that best meets your needs; or choose

Custom , then click the Settings button to open the Make

File options panel (see page 365).

Chapter 16: Making your movie 341

DivX

This file format, based on MPEG-4 video compression technology, is popular for video files disseminated over the Internet. It is also supported by a range of DivXcompatible hardware devices, from DVD players to portable and handheld units.

Click whichever of the quality presets matches your needs; or choose Custom , then click the Settings button to open the Make File options panel (see page 365).

Flash Video

Studio supports output in Flash Video ( flv ) format, version 7. Virtually all current web browsers are able to display this popular format, which has been widely adopted by social networking sites and news sites.

Click the quality preset that matches your needs; or choose Custom , then click the Settings button to open the Make File options panel (see page 365).

iPod compatible

Like DivX, this file format is based on MPEG-4 video compression technology. The combination of powerful compression with a small 320x240 frame size produces very small output files relative to the more expansive formats. The generated files are compatible with the popular Video iPod devices, and may work with some other devices types as well.

The three quality presets select different data rates, each providing a different balance of quality and file size.

MOV

This is the QuickTime

®

file format. It is particularly suitable when the movie will be played on the

QuickTime player.

The presets provide a variety of size and encoding options. The Medium (384x288) preset uses MJPEG compression; Small (176x144) uses MPEG-4.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 343

MPEG

MPEG-1 is the original MPEG file format. MPEG-1 video compression is used on VideoCDs, but in other contexts it has given way to newer standards.

MPEG-2 is the successor format to MPEG-1. Whereas the MPEG-1 file format is supported on all Windows

95 and later PCs, MPEG-2 and MPEG-4 files can only be played on PCs with appropriate decoder software installed. Two of the MPEG-2 presets support HD

(High Definition) playback equipment.

MPEG-2 TS is the “transport stream” version of

MPEG-2. Its applications include HD playback on

AVCHD-based camcorders and Sony’s PlayStation 3 home game console.

MPEG-4 is another member of the MPEG family. It offers image quality similar to MPEG-2 but with even greater compression. It is particularly suitable for

Internet use. Two of the MPEG-4 presets (QCIF and

QSIF) create “quarter-frame” video sized for cellphones; two others (CIF and SIF) create “full-frame” video suitable for handheld viewers.

Custom presets.

With all MPEG variants, Custom lets you configure movie output in detail by clicking the

Settings button to open the Make File options panel

(see page 365).

Real Media

Real Media movie files are designed for playback on the Internet. Real Media movies can be played back by anyone around the world who has the RealNetworks®

RealPlayer® software, which is a free download from www.real.com

.

See page 369 for information about configuring your output with the Make File – Real Media options panel.

Sony PSP compatible

This is another file format based on MPEG-4 video compression technology. As with the iPod-compatible type, the combination of powerful compression with a

Chapter 16: Making your movie 345

small 320x240 frame size produces very small output files relative to the more expansive formats. The generated files are compatible with the popular Sony

PlayStation Portable devices, and may work with some other devices types as well.

Windows Media

The Windows Media file format is also designed for streaming Internet playback. The files can be played on any computer where the Windows Media player – a free program from Microsoft – is installed.

See page 372 for information about configuring your output with the Make File – Real Media options panel.

™

O

UTPUT TO TAPE

Choose the Tape tab on the Output Browser when you want to send your output to an external video device – a television, camcorder or VCR – or to “VGA”, for viewing on your monitor screen.

Configuring a camera or video recorder...

Make sure your recording device is properly connected before you begin to generate the movie.

Output via IEEE-1394 cable

If your recording device has a DV input, just connect it to your digital video hardware with an IEEE-1394 (or

“i.LINK”) cable. The connector at the camcorder end should be labeled

DV IN

/

OUT

.

On machines that don’t support recording back to the camcorder, including many PAL devices, the DV connector is called simply

DV OUT

.

Output with analog audio / video cables

If you have a Studio product with an analog (TV or video) output, such as Studio DVplus or DC10plus, connect the video outputs of the capture card to the inputs of the video recorder and the audio outputs of the sound card (or the capture card, if it has them) to the audio inputs of the video recorder.

Connecting a TV set or video monitor

Many camcorders have an integrated display, making it unnecessary to attach a video monitor.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 347

Otherwise, to view your movie as it is recorded, a TV set or a video monitor must be attached to the video outputs of your recorder. Video outputs are not always available on DV camcorders.

Output your movie to videotape

Verify that the camcorder/VCR is powered on and configured, and that you have inserted a tape cued to where you wish to begin recording. You now have two options:

1.

If you are recording your movie onto DV tape,

Studio gives you the option to control the DV device automatically. Click the Settings button then activate the check box in the Output options area.

With most DV devices there is a small delay between receiving the command to record and the actual start of recording. Since it varies from one device to another, you may need to experiment with the Record delay time value for best results with your particular device.

2.

If you are recording onto analog tape, or have not checked the Automatically start and stop recording option on the Make tape options panel, start your

VCR recording now.

Finally, click Play in the Player.

™

O

UTPUT TO THE WEB

Studio can upload your video directly to either Yahoo!

Video or YouTube, for sharing with a potential audience of millions of other Internet users.

Both options offers two preset formats, Best Quality and Fast Upload . These provide different combinations of frame size and video data rate.

No additional format settings are required for either destination.

After selecting the upload site and preset you want, click the Create button. This opens the Web Upload dialog box, where you can enter editorial information about your production.

Set the title, description and comma-separated search tags as desired, then check up to three categories in which your movie should be listed.

If you have previously logged into your Yahoo! account from Studio, but this time want to use a different user ID, check the Login as a different user box.

Chapter 16: Making your movie 349

Unless you are already logged in, the Yahoo! Desktop

Login dialog is now displayed. If you have an existing

Yahoo! Identity, enter your user information now; otherwise, you must first click the Sign up link to set up a new Yahoo! account.

Studio now automatically creates and uploads your movie. Click the Watch video online button if you would like to visit the Yahoo! Video site in your web browser to confirm the success of the upload.

APPENDIX A:

Setup options

Settings are provided to adjust various aspects of

Studio’s operation. The default values have been chosen to work well for the majority of situations and hardware. However, you may wish to modify them to suit your work style or your equipment configuration.

About Studio setup options

Studio’s setup options are divided between two tabbed dialog boxes, both with several panels.

The Main Options dialog box has two panels covering options relating to Edit mode. Open this dialog box to the panel of your choice by selecting one of the commands in the first group on the Setup menu.

The Make Movie Options dialog box has three panels, one for each of three media types: disc, file and tape.

Access this dialog box by selecting one of the commands in the second group on the Setup menu.

Option settings in Studio apply to both the current and future Studio sessions. There is no master reset.

Appendix A: Setup options 351

Project preferences

These settings are split into five areas, which are covered in the subtopics below. Hardware settings relating to editing are on the Video and audio preferences panel (see page 355).

Editing environment

Automatically save and load my projects: If this option is checked, Studio will continually update your stored project while you work without you having to save your changes explicitly. If you would prefer to look after your own loads and saves, leave this option unchecked.

Show large storyboard thumbnails: Check this box to get more detail in the thumbnail frames shown by

Storyboard view in the Movie Window.

Show premium content, Show premium features:

Premium content and features allow you to expand

Studio easily and conveniently when you need more resources or more power to enhance your movies.

Premium content refers to add-on effects, transitions, titles, menus and sound effects. Premium features refers to pan and zoom, chroma key, and other advanced capabilities.

Check the boxes if you would like the premium items to be listed in the Album and other appropriate places in Studio.

In general, when you click on a premium item you will be offered the chance to purchase and install it immediately, without leaving Studio, if you have an

Internet connection available. See “Expanding Studio” on page 12 for further information.

Project format

By default, your Studio movie project is in the same video format as the first clip you add to it. If you want to force new projects to a different format, click Use this format for new projects , and select your desired format from the dropdown list.

Default durations

These duration times are measured in seconds and frames. The seconds counter advances every 30 frames for NTSC, or 25 frames for PAL.

The three settings here control the initial duration value for transitions, still images and volume fades when added to your movie. The durations can be trimmed to custom values during editing. The default values upon installation are as shown in the illustration above.

When adding a disc menu

When you place a disc menu on the Timeline, Studio inquires whether you want to generate chapter links

Appendix A: Setup options 353

from the menu to all the clips that follow it (at least until the next menu). The choices on this dropdown list let you avoid the confirmation dialog by specifying that you always don’t or always do want the links to be created, or that you want Studio to create links from a new menu to its chapters and also return links back to the menu from the end of each chapter. A final option,

“Ask if chapters should be created”, enables the confirmation dialog, restoring the factory default.

Minimum chapter length: If you have specified that

Studio should create chapter links automatically when you add a menu, multiple clips are combined into chapters if necessary to achieve this minimum duration.

Folder for auxiliary files

Studio generates auxiliary files in many circumstances as you edit and output your project. These are all stored under the disk folder specified here. Click the Folder button to change the auxiliary files’ location – usually because you need to save space on a particular drive.

Delete: This button opens the Delete Auxiliary Files dialog, which lets you recover hard drive space by deleting files created while your project was being rendered.

Video and audio preferences

The five areas on this panel provide hardware and previewing settings.

Video preview

Because of the central role of previewing during interactive video editing, Studio provides a number of settings that affect preview behavior.

For previewing on a computer monitor, the default preview, at quarter-frame resolution, is probably quite good enough. If you have exacting requirements for the preview, and particularly if you are targeting an external output device for preview (by selecting it on the External dropdown list), you may need to check

Enable full-resolution preview . On some machines there may be a noticeable performance cost to this option.

Enable hardware acceleration takes advantage of the advanced capabilities of your graphics card where applicable. The option should be checked unless you are having display problems during preview.

The Show full screen preview on dropdown list lets you specify how Studio should preview when you click the full-screen button on the Player. The options available on the list depend on your display hardware.

Appendix A: Setup options 355

On a single monitor system, a full-screen preview

(other than external) must obviously use the same screen as Studio’s own interface. This is the Main VGA monitor option. In this special instance, full-screen playback begins from the current play position when you click the full-screen button, and ends either at the end of the movie or when you press the Esc key.

With a dual-monitor computer system, you would normally use your second screen as a full-size preview monitor and leave Studio unobscured on your main screen. The display on the second monitor is controlled entirely by the full-screen button, independently of whether your movie is playing back or paused.

The most straightforward option for full-screen preview is Second VGA monitor . In this mode, the preview is scaled to use as much as possible of the monitor display

(without disturbing the aspect ratio of the video). The

Player preview on the main screen remains blank, conserving processing power. When a second display is available, this mode is recommended for most users.

The remaining two options are special modes that allow full-screen output on one monitor while still providing a normal preview within the Studio window. These modes are offered only if your dual-output video card is one of the following types:

• ATI Radeon 9600 (or better) with version 5.8

(minimum) of the Catalyst™ display driver.

In order to use the additional preview modes, you must deactivate the second monitor in the Display

Properties dialog (or the Catalyst control center) before launching Studio.

• nVidia GeForce Fx5xxx or better, or an equivalent card in the Quadro series. The minimum driver versions are 81.85 (GeForce) and 81.64 (Quadro).

Before launching Studio, the second monitor must be activated as a Windows desktop extension ( not in the

Span or Clone modes).

Studio checks on start-up to see if the above conditions have been met. If they are, the remaining options are made available:

Second VGA, small preview on main VGA: This option goes beyond the other full-screen modes by reconfiguring the monitor display to match the exact format of your project’s video specifications for frame format and refresh rate. For instance, if your project format is 720x480 with the NTSC refresh rate of 60

Hz, the monitor will be put into that mode for the most accurate possible preview. At the same time, the usual small Player preview is displayed on the main screen.

Note: Even if you have the correct graphics card, the desired format may still not be supported by a particular monitor. If Studio determines that to be the case, it tries to fall back to the final preview mode

(next paragraph). If any instability occurs with your hardware set-up, reverting to one of the basic modes covered above is strongly recommended.

Safe mode second VGA, small preview: In this mode,

Studio matches your project video format as well as possible to the formats supported by the monitor. For instance, if the 720x480 frame format is unavailable,

Studio will set the display to 800x600 and center the frame on the monitor screen. Similarly, if the monitor does not support 50 Hz (PAL) output at a particular screen size, it will display at 60 Hz instead.

Appendix A: Setup options 357

Voice-over recording

Microphone: A dropdown list of choices for attaching a microphone to your hardware.

Channels, Sample rate: These settings control audio quality. A typical setting for voice-overs is 16-bit mono at 22.05 kHz.

Background rendering

Rendering is the process of generating video for footage that uses HFX transitions, effects or other computationally demanding features of Studio. Until such video has been rendered, it may not display smoothly and with full detail during preview.

Studio is able to carry out rendering behind the scenes while you work, a feature called background rendering .

Enable background rendering: Uncheck this box if you do not want to use background rendering at all.

One might do this on a slower computer if intensive rendering were causing other operations to become sluggish.

Set codec automatically: Let Studio decide which codec to use for encoding your rendered video.

Use this codec for background rendering: If you know that your project is going to DV tape, choosing

DV as your background rendering format may reduce the rendering time of your final movie. You would normally choose MPEG for as the rendering codec for disc-bound movies for the same reason.

Another consideration arises if you are planning to preview your video on an external device (Studio

Ultimate only). In such cases you may need to set the project format and the background rendering codec to suit the device. For instance, if you are previewing on an analog monitor plugged into your DV camcorder, you should do your background rendering in DV.

Surround-sound playback

Check Enable discrete 5.1 playback if the audio system you use when previewing your Studio project supports discrete 5.1 audio. Leave it unchecked if you are previewing in surround-sound with a Pro Logic compatible system, or in stereo.

CD drive (for ripping audio files)

If you have used any music from CD in your project,

Studio digitally transfers (“rips”) the audio data from the disc to the computer. The dropdown list here lets you select which CD device to use for ripping, if you have more than one available.

Appendix A: Setup options 359

Make Disc settings

These settings allow you to adjust options for creating

VCD, S-VCD, DVD, HD DVD or Blu-ray discs, and for creating a disc image on a hard drive.

To create a VCD or S-VCD requires a CD or DVD burner; to create a DVD requires a DVD or HD DVD burner; to create an HD DVD requires an HD DVD burner; to create a Blu-ray disc requires a Blu-ray burner.

You can burn DVDs in standard format for DVD players, in AVCHD format for Blu-ray players, or in

HD DVD format for HD DVD players. For details, see

“Output to disc media” (page 334).

Format

Disc Type: Select VCD, S-VCD, DVD or Blu-ray to create a disc (or disc image) of the corresponding type.

Select HD DVD to create either a DVD or an HD DVD for playback in an HD DVD player. If you want to create a DVD readable in most Blu-ray devices, choose

AVCHD.

Video quality / disc usage: These settings ( Automatic ,

Best video quality , Most video on disc and Custom ) are available except in the case of VCDs, where the format is fixed. The first three settings are presets that correspond to particular data rates. The Custom option lets you set the data rate to another value. In each case, an estimate is provided of the amount of video the disc can accommodate at the current setting.

Kbits/sec: When the Custom option has been chose in for the previous setting, this combination dropdown list and edit field lets you choose or specify the data rate – and hence the video quality and maximum duration – of the disc. Higher values correspond to better quality and lower capacity.

Audio compression: Depending on the format, some of all of the following methods of storing your movie’s soundtrack are offered:

PCM encoding for stereo sound is supported by all

DVD players, but takes up more space on the DVD than MPEG.

• MPEG audio, in MPA (MPEG-1 Layer 2) format, is always provided on PAL DVD players. On NTSC players it is broadly supported, but theoretically optional.

• Dolby ® Digital 2-channel encoding can be used to compactly store either a stereo or a surround soundtrack. To hear the surround mix requires equipment with Dolby Pro Logic compatibility. On other systems, it will be heard as a normal stereo mix.

• Dolby ® Digital 5.1-channel encoding stores the surround channels discretely. To hear the surround mix on playback requires a surround amplifier and speaker system.

Use progressive encoding: Each frame of a normal television picture is displayed as two successive

“fields”, each containing half of the several hundred horizontal video lines that make up the entire image: the odd-numbered lines in one field, and the even-

Appendix A: Setup options 361

numbered lines in the other. The eye sees the superimposed fields as a single image.

This system, called “interlaced scanning”, produces reasonably good results because of the characteristics of television screens and the human visual system.

However, high-definition TV systems and typical computer monitors provide “progressive scanning”, in which the image is drawn from top to bottom at a higher screen refresh rate, potentially producing a clearer image with less flicker. If your project mainly consists of progressive-scanned video, and/or still images, checking this box may provide superior output quality. Usually, however, this option should be left unchecked.

Always re-encode entire movie: This option forces your movie to be completely re-rendered for output. It is recommended only if you are experiencing problems with your output movie and want to narrow the possible sources of error.

Burn options

Create disc content and then burn: This is the default option for creating discs. In the first phase, the data that will be written to disc is generated and stored temporarily on your hard drive. In the second phase, the generated data is burned to the optical disc.

Create disc content but don’t burn:

With this choice, your disc burner is not used. Instead, the same files that would normally be saved onto a disc are stored to a hard drive folder as a “disc image”.

With some disc types, you may have a choice of disc image formats. Choose the one you want on the Image Type list in the Media and device options area (see page 363).

Burn from previously created disc content: Instead of using your current project directly to burn a disc, a previously-created disc image is now sent to your burner. This lets you divide the work of creating a disc into two separate steps that can be performed in separate sessions if desired. It is particularly useful when you want to make several copies of the same project, or when you want to generate the disc on one computer but burn it on another.

Media and device options

Target media: Choose an entry from this dropdown list matching the type and capacity of the disc to which you are burning your project.

Disc writer device: If you have more than one disc burner on your system, select the one you want Studio to use.

Copies: Select or enter the number of copies of this disc that you want to create.

Write speed: Choose one of the available speeds, or choose Auto for the default selection.

Image type: When you are generating a disc image rather than burning an actual disc, this dropdown list lets you choose amongst available formats, if

Appendix A: Setup options 363

applicable. Your choice may be important if you are planning to access the image with other software.

Eject disc when done: Check this box if you would like Studio to automatically eject the disc after the burn process has been completed.

General options

These options are provided for both the Make Disc and

Make File option tabs. Separately or in combination they let you specify special actions to be taken after your movie disc or file has been created.

Play sound when finished: As soon as Studio has finished outputting your movie, a sound effect will be played back through your computer’s speakers to alert you. This is handy if you want work nearby while the

CPU-intensive work of generating the movie gets done.

Make sure that your speakers are switched on and that the volume is suitably set when you rely on this feature.

Shut down PC when finished: Upon outputting your movie, Studio instructs Windows to shut down your computer. This option ensures that the system will be powered down even if you are away from your desk, or even asleep, when output is completed.

Make File settings

The File Type and Preset lists, which head the Make

File settings panel for all file types, correspond to the

Format and Preset lists in the Output Browser (see

Chapter 16: Making Your Movie ). Most file types share a common control panel. The Real Media and

Windows Media file types have special-purpose control panels, covered separately in “Make Real Media file settings” on page 369 and “Make Windows Media file settings” on page 372.

The common panel, to be described here, is used by all the other supported file types: 3GP, AVI, DivX, Flash

Video, MPEG-1, MPEG-2 and MPEG-4 (including iPod Compatible and Sony PSP Compatible), and the audio-only types.

The common Make File settings panel is shared by all file types except Real Media and Windows Media.

Not all the options are available for all file types.

Appendix A: Setup options 365

The panel lets you manipulate file and compression settings when the Custom preset has been chosen. Most of the file types support customization to some degree.

Custom settings may be used to minimize the size of the output file, to increase its quality, or to prepare it for a special purpose (such as distribution via the

Internet) where there may be requirements involving characteristics such as frame size.

Note: MPEG-2 and MPEG-4 files require special decoder software. Without a matching decoder installed on your PC you will not be able to play files of these types.

Video settings

Include video: This option is on by default. Clearing the checkbox causes the output file to have audio only.

List all codecs: By default this checkbox is not checked, so only those codecs are listed that have been certified by Pinnacle Systems for use with Studio. If you check the option, all codecs installed on your PC will be listed, whether certified or not.

Using codecs that have not been certified by Pinnacle

Systems may produce undesirable results. Pinnacle

Systems cannot provide technical support for problems associated with the use of uncertified codecs.

Options: The Options button opens a codec-specific option panel if one is available.

Compression: Choose the compressor (codec) that is most suitable for your intended use. When making an

AVI file, you’ll want to choose your compression

settings for the capabilities of, and codecs supported by, the intended viewer’s computer platform.

Resolution: This is a dropdown list of presets providing standard Width and Height options. The

Custom preset lets you set the dimensions directly.

Width, Height: The frame size is measured in pixels.

The default setting is the resolution at which Studio captures. Decreasing the width and height greatly decreases file size.

Frame rate: The standard frame rate is 29.97 frames per second for NTSC, and 25 frames per second for

PAL. You may want to set the frame rate lower for applications such as Web video.

Quality, Data rate: Depending on the codec being used, you can adjust the quality percentage or data rate with the slider. The higher the percentage or rate you choose, the larger the resulting file.

Appendix A: Setup options 367

Audio settings

If you want to keep file sizes to a minimum, audio for many digital uses can be set to 8-bit mono at 11 kHz.

As a rule of thumb, try 8-bit 11 kHz for audio that is mostly speech, and 16-bit stereo at 22 or 44 kHz for audio that is predominantly music. As a benchmark,

CD-ROM music is 16-bit stereo sampled at 44 kHz.

Another convenient rule of thumb for audio compression is that 11 kHz is roughly equivalent to

AM radio quality; 22 kHz equates to FM radio quality; and 16-bit stereo, 44 kHz is audio CD quality.

Include audio: This option is on by default. Clearing the checkbox causes the output file to be silent.

Options: The Options button opens a codec-specific option panel if one is available.

Compression: The codecs listed here will vary with the file type.

Channels: Possible choices on this list include Mono,

Stereo and MultiChannel, depending on the file type.

File size increases when additional channels are used.

Sample rate: Digital audio is produced by taking regular instantaneous samples of the continuous analog waveform. The more samples, the better the sound. For example, audio CDs are recorded at 44 kHz, 16-bit stereo. Audio can be sampled at frequencies as low as

11 kHz for some digital uses, particularly for speech.

Data rate: This dropdown controls the data rate, and hence the compression ratio, for audio. Higher data rates yield higher quality at the cost of larger files.

Data settings

The Sony PSP Compatible file type provides an area named Data in which you can specify a title for your saved movie.

General settings

These are the same as described for the Make Disc tab on page 364.

Make Real Media file settings

The Make Real Media File options panel allows you to adjust Real Media file settings. These configure the creation of files that are to be played back with the popular RealNetworks® RealPlayer®, free for the download from www.real.com

.

Appendix A: Setup options 369

Title, Author, Copyright: These three fields are used to identify each Real Media movie, and are encoded into it so that they are not visible to the casual viewer.

Keywords: This field accepts up to 256 characters, and allows you to encode keywords into each movie. It is typically used to identify the movie for Internet search engines.

Video quality: These choices let you balance the rival requirements of image quality and frame rate.

No video: When this selection is made, the output file will contain audio only.

Normal motion video: Recommended for mixed content clips to balance video motion and image clarity.

• Smoothest motion video: Recommended for clips that contain limited action, such as newscasts or interviews, to enhance overall video motion.

Sharpest image video: Recommended for highaction clips to enhance overall image clarity.

• Slide show: The video appears as a series of still photos, providing the best overall image clarity.

Audio quality: This dropdown menu lets you choose the characteristics of your audio track. Studio uses this information to select the best audio compression for your Real Media file. Each successive option provides better audio quality but a larger resulting file.

• No audio: When this selection is made, the output file will contain video only.

• Voice only: This option provides adequate quality for spoken audio in clips without music.

Voice with background music: This option is designed for situations where, even though background music may be present, the spoken audio predominates.

• Music: Use this option for a monaural track in which music is prominently featured.

• Stereo music: Use this option for a stereo music track.

Web server: The RealServer option allows you to create a file that can be streamed from a RealNetworks

RealServer. The RealServer supports a special feature that senses the connect speed of the viewer’s modem, and adjusts its transmission rate to suit. The option allows you to select up to seven Target audience data rates. Because the file size, and your upload time, increase with each data rate you add, select only those target audiences you think are actually needed.

To make use of the RealServer option, the ISP hosting your web-site must have the RealServer software installed. If you are unsure, contact your ISP for confirmation, or use the standard HTTP option, which allows you to optimize playback for exactly one of the

Target audience options.

Target audience: This selects the target audience modem connect speed. The lower the speed, the lower the quality of the video. If you wish your viewers to be able to view your movie as it loads, you should select a target audience rate that their modems can handle.

When you select a target audience, you are actually specifying a maximum bandwidth for your RealMedia stream. Bandwidth, measured in kilobits per second

(Kbps), is the amount of data that can be sent through an Internet or network connection in a given time span.

Appendix A: Setup options 371

Standard modems (those that use ordinary telephone lines) are classified by the bandwidth they are able to process. Common values are 28.8 and 56 Kbps.

In addition to these standard audiences, you can record clips for connection speeds of 100 Kbps, 200 Kbps, or higher. These higher bandwidths are suitable for audiences that use corporate Local Area Networks

(LANs), cable modems or Digital Subscriber Line

(DSL) modems.

Make Windows Media file settings

The Make Windows Media File panel lets you adjust options for creating Windows Media Player files.

Title, Author, Copyright: These three fields are used to identify each Windows Media movie, and are encoded into it so they are not visible to the casual viewer.

Description: This 256-character field lets you enter keywords for encoding into the movie. It is typically used to identify the movie for Internet search engines.

Rating: Entering a rating in this field if it will be helpful to your viewers.

Profile: Choose the playback quality of your movie based on the capability of the target platform – the computer(s) that will play the movie. The exact audio and video parameters corresponding to the current choice are displayed in the space below the list. The

Custom option lets you fine-tune the settings by selecting from a list of possible combinations.

Markers for Media Player “Go To Bar”: You have the option of including Windows Media “file markers” in the movie file. These markers allow viewers to go directly to the beginning of any marked clip by choosing its name from a list.

No markers: The movie file will be created without markers.

• Markers for every clip: Markers are automatically created for every clip in the movie. If you have not given the clip a custom name, a default one will be generated for it based on the project name.

• Markers for named clips only: Markers are generated only for those clips to which you have given a custom name.

Appendix A: Setup options 373

Make tape settings

Studio automatically senses the hardware you have installed, and configures the Make Tape playback destination accordingly.

If you are printing (making tape) to a DV device, you can choose to have Studio start and stop the device automatically instead of having to do it yourself.

To control printing automatically:

1.

Click the Make Movie button on the main menu bar.

The upper half of the screen changes to display the

Make Movie window.

2.

Click the Tape tab.

3.

Click the Settings button. The Make tape options panel opens.

4.

5.

Check the Automatically start and stop recording box to enable the automatic function. This setting makes it unnecessary to manually start recording in step 6.

With most DV devices there is a small delay between receiving the command to record and the actual start of recording. In Studio, this is referred to as the “record delay time”. It varies from device to device, so you may need to experiment with the value for best results with your particular device.

Click OK .

6.

Click Create .

Studio renders your movie, then prompts you to press the play button on the Player. If you did not check the automatic option (step 4), you must manually start the device recording before pressing the play button; otherwise Studio itself sends the record command. Studio outputs the first frame of your movie (without audio) for the duration entered as the record delay time, giving the device time to bring the tape up to speed and begin recording.

Hint: When you play back your tape, if the first part of your movie was not recorded, you should increase the Record delay time setting. On the other hand, if your movie begins by holding onto the first frame as though it were a still photograph, you should decrease the setting.

Hint: If you wish to send black to your recording device during its record delay time, place a blank title in the video track just before the start of your movie (a blank title is video black). If you wish to record black at the end of your movie, place a blank title in the video track following the final frame of your movie.

Appendix A: Setup options 375

Analog output

If you are printing to an analog device, the choice of

Composite or S-Video format may be available if supported by your hardware.

Output to the screen

One of the options on the Video dropdown in the

Playback devices area is “VGA display”. With this option, your completed project will be played back onto your monitor screen rather than to an external device.

APPENDIX B:

Tips and tricks

Here are some hints from Pinnacle technical specialists on choosing, using and maintaining a computer system with video in mind.

Hardware

To use Studio effectively, your hardware should be optimally prepared and configured.

Preparing your hard drive

Prior to capturing video, consider working through the following steps, especially if you have an older system, if your capture drive is running low on space, or if you have already seen evidence of possible hard drive problems:

• Close down as many other applications and background programs as possible. This includes important security software such as anti-virus and anti-spyware utilities, so Pinnacle recommends strongly that you also disconnect from the Internet

Appendix B: Tips and tricks 377

(or set your firewall to block all Internet traffic) when taking this step. Software utilities are available to assist with closing background processes.

• Right-click on the name of your capture drive in

Windows Explorer, and select Properties on the popup menu. On the Tools tab of the Disk Properties dialog, click Check Now and run a detailed scan of the drive to make sure that it is error free. When this is complete, click Defragment Now ; the system defragmenter utility will arrange your drive contents to leave the largest possible contiguous free area for your capture files.

Scanning and defragmenting a drive are both lengthy operations, so you may wish to let them run during times when you are planning to be away from the computer.

• Temporarily turn off your screen saver and any power management features you have set up on the

Windows Screen Saver dialog box.

Note: Video-editing programs do not multitask very well. Do not use any other program while outputting your movie to videotape or optical disc, or when capturing. You can multitask while editing.

RAM

The more RAM you have, the easier it is to work with

Studio. You will need at least 512 MB of RAM to work with the Studio application, and we highly recommend

1 GB (or more). If you work with HD video, or are running Windows Vista, the recommendation rises to minimum.

Motherboard

Intel Pentium or AMD Athlon 1.4 GHz or higher – the higher the better. Windows Vista and AVCHD editing both demand a more powerful CPU. The minimum recommendation ranges up to 2.66 GHz for editing

1920-pixel AVCHD video.

Graphics card

To run Studio, your DirectX-compatible graphics card needs:

For typical use, at least 64 MB of onboard memory

(128 MB preferred).

For Windows Vista, at least 128 MB (256 MB preferred).

• For HD and AVCHD, at least 256 MB (512 MB preferred).

Graphics card settings

If you need to minimize system load while maintaining acceptable color performance, Pinnacle recommends setting your display to use 16-bit color.

To adjust the display in Windows XP:

1.

2.

3.

Position your mouse over your Desktop, right click, and select Properties , When the Display Properties dialog box appears, click on the Settings tab.

If you have multiple monitors, select the one to which the new setting should apply.

Under Color Quality , choose “Medium (16 bit)”.

Appendix B: Tips and tricks 379

To adjust the display in Windows Vista:

1.

2.

3.

Position your mouse over your Desktop, right click, and select Personalize . In the “Personalize appearance and sounds” window click the “Display settings” link.

The Display Settings dialog box appears.

If you have multiple monitors, select the one to which the new setting should apply.

Under Colors , choose “Medium (16 bit)”.

The color setting affects only the display on the computer monitor. Recorded sequences will appear in full color and resolution at the video output.

Studio and computer animation

If you are editing computer animation with Studio or wish to combine animation with digital video, remember to create your animations using the same frame size and image refresh rate as your original video:

Quality TV-Cropping PAL NTSC Audio

DV Yes 720 x 576 720 x 480 44 kHz 16-bit stereo

Failure to do this will result in unnecessarily long rendering times and the possibility of visible flaws when the animation is played back.

APPENDIX C:

Troubleshooting

Before you begin troubleshooting, take some time to check your hardware and software installation.

Update your software: We recommend installing the latest operating system updates for Windows XP and

Windows Vista. You can download these updates from: windowsupdate.microsoft.com/default.htm

Make sure you have the latest version of the Studio software installed by clicking the Help

¾

Software

Updates menu from within the program. Studio will use the Internet to check for possible updates.

Check your hardware: Ensure that all installed hardware is functioning normally with the latest drivers, and is not flagged as having a problem in the

Windows Device Manager (see below). If any devices are flagged you should resolve the issue before starting installation.

Get the latest drivers: We also highly recommend installing the latest drivers for your sound card and graphics card. During the Studio software launch process we do verify that your sound card and video card support DirectX. See “Update audio and video drivers” on page 387 for help with this process.

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 381

Opening Device Manager

The Windows XP and Windows Vista Device

Manager, which lets you configure your system’s hardware, has an important role in troubleshooting.

The first step in accessing Device Manager is to rightclick on My Computer, then select Properties from the context menu. This opens the System Properties dialog.

The Device Manager button is on the Hardware tab in

XP, and is listed on the left side panel in Vista.

Ensure that all installed hardware is functioning normally with the latest drivers, and that nothing has been flagged in the Device Manager with the yellow exclamation mark icon indicating an error condition.

In the case of a driver problem that you cannot resolve yourself, contact the device manufacturer or your computer vendor for assistance.

™

T

ECHNICAL HELP ON

-

LINE

The Pinnacle Support Knowledge Base is a searchable archive of thousands of regularly-updated articles about the most common questions and issues users have regarding Studio and other Pinnacle products. Use the knowledge base to find answers to any questions you may have about installing, using or troubleshooting

Pinnacle Studio.

Access the knowledge base with your web browser by visiting: http://www.pcle.com/selfhelp

The knowledge base home page will appear. You don’t have to register to browse the knowledge base, but if you want to send a specific question to technical support staff you will need to create a knowledge base account. Please read any knowledge base articles relevant to your inquiry before contacting technical support.

Using the knowledge base

In the Product dropdown, select “Studio Version 14”.

If appropriate, you can also select a Sub-Product , a

Category , or both. Selecting a sub-product or category may reduce the number of irrelevant hits you will get from your search, but may also eliminate helpful articles of a more general nature. If you’re not sure what category to pick, leave the selection at All

Categories .

To search for an article, type a short phrase or group of keywords in the text box. Don’t get too wordy; the search works best when given just a few words.

Search example

In the list below of common troubleshooting issues, the first item is, “Studio crashes or hangs in Edit mode”.

Type “Crash in edit mode” in the search box and click the Search button. You should get back somewhere between 60 and 150 hits. The very first one, “Studio

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 383

crashes in Edit”, lists the known causes for this issue and their remedies.

If you search instead on the single keyword “Crash”, you will get far fewer hits, all relating to crashes in

Studio.

If one search does not turn up an article that seems relevant to your problem, try modifying the search by choosing a different set of keywords. You can also use the Search by and Sort by options to select for specific or popular articles.

Searching by Answer ID

If you know the Answer ID number of the answer you’re looking for, you can access the item directly.

For example, if you are getting a capture error when you press the Capture button, someone might refer you to knowledge base article 2687, “I am getting a capture error with Studio”. In the Search by dropdown, select

“Answer ID”, enter the ID number in the text box, and click Search .

™

T

OP SUPPORT ISSUES

The remainder of this chapter draws on some of the knowledge-base articles most consulted by users. The text presented here is generally less detailed than that provided on-line. For the full text available under each

Answer ID, please refer to the on-line knowledge base.

Errors or crashes during installation

Answer ID 13122

Errors during the installation of Studio may appear as a dialog box with the title “CRC Error”, “Feature

Transfer Error” or “I/O Error”. In other circumstances, the install routine may crash or appear to freeze. In all such cases, try the following steps in turn until the problem is resolved:

• Inspect the discs: Check each disc’s surface for dirt, smudges and fingerprints. Clean off the disc with a soft cloth if necessary. Avoid using paper towels or any other material that could be abrasive and scratch the disc. Wipe from the center of the disc to the outer edge. Don’t use a circular motion. Once the disc is clean, retry the installation.

If the disc is damaged with deep scratches or cracks so that it won’t install, please contact Pinnacle support for a replacement.

Try another drive: If you have a second optical drive of a compatible type, try installing from it.

• Prune your startup: If you are familiar with the msconfig utility, follow the procedure to eliminate programs run at Windows startup that could interfere with the Windows installer. See “Editing startup applications” on page 396 for details.

• Install from the hard drive: In this procedure, you boot into Window Safe Mode, copy the contents of the Studio installation disc onto your hard drive, then execute the install from there. We recommend consulting Answer ID 13122 on the Pinnacle website for the latest advice on this approach.

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 385

Studio crashes in Edit mode

Answer ID 6786

If Studio is crashing, the cause is most likely either a configuration issue or a problem with a project or content file. This type of issue can often be fixed with one of the following methods:

Uninstalling and reinstalling Studio.

Optimizing the computer.

Rebuilding a corrupt project.

Recapturing a corrupt clip.

To help troubleshoot the problem, determine which of the failure modes listed below best matches the symptoms you are experiencing, then refer to the corresponding set of instructions:

• Case 1: Studio crashes randomly. There doesn’t seem to be any one thing that will cause the crash, but crashes happen frequently.

• Case 2: Studio crashes every time you click on some particular tab or button within Edit mode.

• Case 3: Studio crashes each time you carry out some specific sequence of steps.

Case 1: Studio crashes randomly

Try each of the following solutions in turn:

Get the latest version of Studio: Make sure that you have the latest version of Studio 14 installed. The latest version can be found on our website at: www.pinnaclesys.com/support/studio14

Be sure to close all other programs before installing a new version.

Adjust Studio settings: Choose No background rendering in the Rendering dropdown list, and clear the

Use hardware acceleration checkbox. Both options are found on the Edit options panel (see page 352).

End background tasks: Close other applications and unload any background processes before using Studio.

Press Ctrl+Alt+Delete to open the Task Manager. You probably won’t see much under the Applications tab, but the Processes tab will show you the software that is currently running. It can be difficult to be sure which processes should not be closed, but software utilities are available that can assist with this procedure.

Defragment your hard drive: Over time, the files on your hard drive can become fragmented (stored in multiple parts in different areas of the drive), which slows down access and may lead to performance problems. Use a disk defragmenter utility like the one supplied with Windows to prevent or correct this problem. Access the built-in defragmenter with the

Disk defragmenter command on your Programs ¾

Accessories

¾

System tools menu.

Update audio and video drivers: Make sure that you have obtained the latest drivers for your sound and video cards from their manufacturers’ web-sites. Even a brand-new computer may be sold with outdated drivers installed, and should be checked for updates.

You can see what sound and video cards you have in the Windows Device Manager.

To determine what video card you have, click the plus sign in front of Display Adapters in the Device

Manager list. The name of your video card is now

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 387

displayed. Double-clicking the name opens another dialog, where you choose the Driver tab. Now you can view information about the driver’s manufacturer, and the names of the driver’s constituent files.

The sound card is displayed in the Sound, video and game controllers section of Device Manager. Again, double-clicking the name lets you access the driver details.

Go to the manufacturers’ web-sites to get the latest drivers for your sound and graphics cards. Many users have NVIDIA or ATI graphics cards, for which the latest drivers are available at: www.nvidia.com

and www.atitech.com

Those with Sound Blaster audio cards can get updates here: us.creative.com

Update Windows: Make sure you have all the latest

Windows updates that are available.

“Adjust for best performance”: Use this system option to turn off visual extras that consume additional

CPU time. Right-click My Computer , select Properties from the context menu, then click on the Advanced tab.

Under Performance , click the Settings button to open the Performance Options dialog. Select the Adjust for best performance option and click OK .

Update DirectX: Update to the latest version of

DirectX. You can download it from Microsoft here: www.microsoft.com/windows/directx

Open up space on your boot drive: Make sure you have 10 GB or more free space on your boot drive for paging.

Uninstall, reinstall and update Studio: In case your

Studio installation has become corrupted, try this procedure:

1.

2.

3.

Uninstall Studio: Click on Start

¾

Programs

¾

Studio 14

¾

Tools

¾

Uninstall Studio 14 , then follow any on-screen instructions until the process is complete. If the uninstaller asks whether you want to delete a shared files, click Yes to all .

Disconnect the camera and cable from your DV board, if you have one.

Reinstall Studio: Insert your Studio CD and reinstall the software. Make sure you are logged in as the Administrator (or as a user with Admin privileges) when installing Studio. It is strongly recommended that Studio be installed in its default directory on the main OS drive.

Download and install the latest version of Studio:

Click the Help

¾

Software Updates menu command to check for updates. If a new version of

Studio is detected on our web-site, you will be asked to download it. Download this patch file to a location where you can find it easily (such as the

Desktop), then exit Studio. Finally, double-click the downloaded file to update Studio.

Rebuild corrupt project: Try rebuilding the first few minutes of your project. If no problems occur, gradually add to the project, checking periodically to ensure that system stability is maintained.

Fix corrupt video or audio: Sometimes the instability may occur only when you manipulate certain audio or video clips. In such cases, you should recapture the audio or video. If the audio or video was created by another application, recapture it with Studio if possible.

While Studio supports many video formats, the

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 389

particular clip you have may be corrupt or in an uncommon format. If you have a wav or mp3 file that seems to be problematic, convert the file to the other format before importing the file. Many wav and mp3 files on the Internet are corrupt or non-standard.

Reinstall Windows: This is quite a drastic step, but if the previous steps have not helped, Windows itself may be corrupt. Even though your other applications may appear to be running properly, the size of the video files used in Studio may well tax your system to the point that a latent instability is revealed.

Case 2: Clicking a tab or button crashes Studio

Please start by trying the steps given above for Case 1.

This kind of problem often means that Studio was not installed properly or has become corrupt. Uninstalling

Studio, reinstalling it, and patching to the latest version will generally solve the difficulty.

Otherwise, try creating a new project called

“test01.stx” to try to determine if the failure is specific to a particular project. Open the demo video file and drag the first few scenes onto the Timeline. Now click on the tab or button that seems to cause the failure. If this test project does not crash, it may be that the problem is with the project you are working on rather than with Studio or your system. If the test project does fail, please contact our support staff and provide us with details on the exact failure mode. We will try to recreate and solve the problem.

Case 3: Performing certain steps crashes Studio

This is just a more complicated version of Case 2, and the same troubleshooting steps apply. Since it may be

quite difficult to determine the exact sequence of steps that produces the failure, you will need to be methodical in your approach. Creating a small test project, as described for Case 2, helps eliminate variables that may confuse your test results.

Studio hangs when rendering

Answer ID 6386

With this type of problem, Studio “gets stuck” during rendering (preparing your video for output in Make

Movie mode). To identify the solution in a particular case, try the troubleshooting steps for whichever of the following failure modes best matches your situation:

Case 1: Rendering stops immediately after it starts.

• Case 2: Rendering stops randomly in a project. It typically does not stop in the same spot if rendering is attempted multiple times.

• Case 3: Render stops at the same spot in a project no matter how many times rendering is attempted.

Case 1: Rendering stops immediately

If the hang occurs immediately upon clicking the

Create button, there is some configuration problem on your system. Try rendering the supplied demo video. If this fails, the problem is confirmed as a system issue, since we have not been able to reproduce a render problem with the demo file during our in-house testing.

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 391

Possible solutions:

Uninstall and reinstall Studio.

Uninstall other software that might conflict with

Studio (other video editing software, other video codecs, etc.).

• Try rendering to other file or disc types in Studio.

Try creating MPEG 1 and MPEG 2 files, and an AVI file in DV format. Can you create VCDs and DVDs?

Knowing what works, and what does not, may be crucial in identifying and solving the problem.

• Make sure that you have installed any available

Windows service packs.

Reinstall Windows over itself (that is, without uninstalling first). In Windows XP, this procedure is called Repair .

Case 2: Rendering stops randomly

If the render hangs at random points even within the same project, the failures may be due to background tasks, power management or a thermal problem in the computer.

Possible solutions:

Check your hard drive for errors and defragment it.

End any background tasks, such as virus checkers, drive indexers and fax modems.

Turn off any power management.

Install cooling fans in the computer case.

Case 3: Render always stops at the same point

If rendering always hangs at the same spot in a particular project, see if other projects have the same

problem. If not, the problem project could be corrupt; if they do, try to isolate a common factor.

Finding a solution to this type of failure is much easier if you can identify a particular item in the project that is causing the rendering to stop. Removing the item or trimming it may allow the rendering to complete, though in some cases the failure may simply turn up elsewhere in the project.

Other possible solutions and workarounds:

• Look at the clips in the project for corrupt video frames. These may show up as gray, black, blocky or distorted frames. If you find any, trim the clip to exclude the offending frames. You could also try recapturing the footage.

Defragment your hard drive.

Ensure that you have ample free space – preferably tens of gigabytes – on the hard drive you use for video. Rendering may use large amounts of storage, and can be disrupted if space is insufficient.

• If you have a separate capture drive, make sure to move the auxiliary files folder to that drive.

• Copy the section where the render stops and paste it into a new project. Include 15 to 30 seconds on either side of the error. Try rendering this excerpt to an AVI file and, if successful, use the file to replace the offending section of the original project.

• If you are creating a DVD or other optical disc type, remove all menus from the project and render the rest to an AVI. If this succeeds, create a new project, import the AVI file, and add your menus. Rendering will now consume fewer resources, and thus be more likely to succeed.

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 393

Studio hangs on launch or does not launch

Answer ID 1596

Problems on launch can manifest in various ways.

Studio may give an error message when launching, or it may freeze in mid-launch, or it may “hang” – fail to return control to you – after what had seemed an uneventful launch.

In all such cases, try any or all the following:

Restart the computer. After the reboot, double-click the Studio icon.

• Wait a few minutes to confirm that the application is really hung. Even when you suspect Studio has failed to launch, wait a few minutes more just in case. On some computers, the launch process may take longer to complete than you anticipate.

• Uninstall and reinstall Studio. (See page 389 for instructions.)

Start Windows in Safe mode. If Studio still won’t launch under Safe mode, your installation may be corrupt. An uninstall and reinstall of Studio should deal with this.

If Studio does launch under Safe mode, the issue probably relates to a faulty device driver or an application conflict.

Try to narrow it down further:

• Disconnect capture hardware. Start with Pinnacle external devices such as Dazzle or MovieBox. If

Studio now launches, reconnect the device and reopen Studio. If it fails anew, continue to the next step.

• If you have a webcam, try launching Studio with the device unplugged, and again with it plugged in. If the launch succeeds in one of these states but not the other, make sure to use the same set-up whenever you launch Studio in the future.

• Next, investigate capture cards mounted in your computer. To see what capture devices are present, use the AM Capture utility ( Start ¾ All Programs

¾

Studio 12

¾

Tools

¾

AM Capture ), and click on the Devices pull-down menu. One by one, try physically disconnecting the devices listed. You can also try uninstalling the applicable drivers.

• Download and install the latest drivers for your sound and graphics cards from the manufacturers’ web-sites. Both must support DirectX. Many users have either NVIDIA or ATI graphics cards, for which the latest drivers are available at www.nvidia.com

and www.atitech.com

.

• If you have a sound card (rather than a motherboardbased sound device), try removing it from the system. Some older sound cards may not work well with newer versions of Windows. This can be verified by shutting down the computer, removing the sound card and restarting. If Studio now launches, you probably need to replace the sound card.

End background tasks. You can use either the End

Process button in the Windows Task Manager, or one of the available software utilities designed to assist with this procedure. Alternatively, you can prevent unnecessary (and possibly conflicting) tasks

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 395

from ever being run by editing your list of startup programs.

Editing startup applications

To keep applications from loading when your PC is started (or rebooted):

1.

2.

3.

Click on Start

¾

Run

In the Open box, type: msconfig

Click OK

In the System Configuration Utility window, click on the far right tab called Startup . Remove all checks from the boxes except for Explorer and

System Tray (SysTray.exe).

“Burning failed” error appears in Make Movie

Answer ID 13438

If Studio reports “Burning failed” when you are trying to create an optical disc such as a DVD, try each of the following in turn until the problem is resolved.

• Update to the latest patch: Use the Help

¾

Software Updates menu command to make sure you have the latest updates to the Studio program.

• Use the Safe mode burn option in Make Disc settings: In Studio, click on Setup

¾

Make Disc .

Under the box marked Burn Options , select “Safe mode: create disc content and then burn”, by clicking first on the radio button for the setting, then OK .

Stay with this setting until finished troubleshooting.

Restart Studio: Shut down Studio, then relaunch it.

Now try to create the disc again using the safe mode setting as above.

• Restart the computer: Try opening the door of the

DVD burner. If it won’t open, shut down Studio, then restart the computer. After relaunching Studio, try to create the DVD using the safe mode setting.

Verify media: Make sure that there blank, writeonce media or rewriteable media in the DVD burner, and that your DVD burner supports the media type you are using. During troubleshooting we normally recommend using rewriteable media to reduce the number of wasted discs. However, if you have only used rewriteable media (RW), we would also recommend experimenting with write-once (-/+ R)

DVDs. For dependability, Pinnacle suggests using a name brand of DVD, such as Sony, Apple or

Memorex. When troubleshooting, we recommend trying a DVD from one or more different manufacturers.

• Edit the registry: This step should only be attempted if all of the following are true: You have backed up your registry before making any changes and know how to restore the registry to the previous state; you have successfully edited the registry before; and you are comfortable with the risks associated with editing the registry. If you wish to proceed, delete the Recorder key in the following registry path (capitalization may vary):

HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Software\VOB\CDRApp\

Recorder

This change will force the burn engine to completely redo the drive scanning.

Appendix C: Troubleshooting 397

DVDs do not play back, or appear blank

Answer ID 13092

In some cases, a DVD created by Studio may not play back in your DVD player. Try these steps:

• Check the disc for cleanliness. Ensure that there are no obvious smudges or scratches on the disc surface.

Verify that the expected folders and files have actually been created on the burned DVD. Insert the

DVD into a DVD ROM drive. Under My Computer , right-click the DVD drive and choose Explore . There should be two folders on the DVD, named

“AUDIO_TS” and “VIDEO_TS”. The audio folder should be empty. The video folder should contain

.bup

, .ifo

and .vob

files. If the disc is in fact blank, you are dealing with a burn problem rather than a playback problem. In that case, please check out

Answer ID 13874 in the on-line knowledge base.

• Try playing back the DVD on your computer. The disc should play back with a software DVD player like PowerDVD or WinDVD. It should also play back in an application like Windows Media Player.

• Ensure that your DVD player is designed to play the type of media you are using. Not all DVD players will play every DVD disc format. The DVD player manufacturer’s web-site should list the types of disc formats your particular device supports. Another good place to check for compatibility is: http://www.videohelp.com/dvdplayers

Tip: When troubleshooting burn or playback issues, use rewritable media to avoid wasting discs.

APPENDIX D:

Videography tips

To shoot good video, then create from it an interesting, exciting or informative movie, is something anyone with a little basic knowledge can achieve. Starting from a rough script or shooting plan, the first step is to shoot your raw video. Even at that stage, you should be looking ahead to the editing phase by making sure you will have a good set of shots to work from.

Editing a movie involves juggling all your fragments of footage into some kind of harmonious whole. It means deciding on the particular techniques, transitions and effects that will best express your intent.

An important part of editing is the creation of a soundtrack. The right sound – dialog, music, commentary or effect – can work with the visuals to create a whole greater than the sum of its parts.

Studio has the tools to create professional-quality home video. The rest is up to you – the videographer.

Creating a shooting plan

It is not always necessary to have a shooting plan, but it can be very helpful for large video projects. The plan

Appendix D: Videography tips 399

can be as simple or as complex as you like. A simple list of planned scenes might be enough, or you might also want to include some notes regarding detailed camera directions or prepared dialog. The really ambitious can go all the way to a full-fledged script in which every single camera angle is described in detail along with notes about duration, lighting and props.

Title: “Jack on the kart track”

No. Camera angle

1 Jack's face with helmet, camera zooms out

2 On the starting line, driver's perspective; low camera position.

Text / Audio

“Jack is driving his first race...”.

Noise of engines in the background.

Music is played in the hall, noise of engines.

Duration Date

11 sec

8 sec

Tue.

06/22

Tue.

06/22

3 Man with a starting flag is accompanied into the scene to the start position. Camera stays, man goes out of the scene after start.

“Let's go...”.

Carry out the start, add starting signal.

12 sec

4 Jack on the start position from the front, camera follows, shows Jack up to the bend, now from behind.

Music from the hall no longer audible, fade up same music from CD over noise of engines.

5 ...

9 sec

Draft of a simple shooting plan

Tue.

06/22

Tue.

06/22

Editing

Using varying perspectives

An important event should always be shot from varying perspectives and camera positions. Later, during

editing, you can use the best camera angles alone or in combination. Make a conscious effort to tape events from more than one camera angle (first the clown in the circus ring, but then also the laughing spectator from the clown’s point of view). Interesting events can also take place behind the protagonists or the protagonists may be seen in a reverse angle. This can be helpful later when trying to establish a sense of balance in the movie.

Close-ups

Don’t be stingy with close-ups of important things or persons. Close-ups usually look better and more interesting than long shots do on a television screen, and they work well in post-production effects.

Long shots / Semi-long shots

Long shots provide the viewer with an overview and establish the scene of the action. However, these shots can also be used to tighten longer scenes. When you cut from a close-up to a long shot, the viewer no longer sees the details, and it is thus easier to make a chronological jump. Showing a spectator in a semi-long shot can also provide visual relief from the main action, and the opportunity of a transition away from the action if desired.

Complete actions

Always shoot complete actions with a beginning and an end. This makes editing easier.

Transitions

Cinematic timing requires some practice. It is not always possible to film long events in their entirety,

Appendix D: Videography tips 401

and in movies they often have to be represented in severely abbreviated form. Nonetheless, the plot should remain logical and cuts should almost never call attention to themselves.

This is where the transition from one scene to the next is important. Even if the action in neighboring scenes is separated in time or space, your editorial choices can make the juxtaposition so smooth that the viewer bridges the gap without conscious attention.

The secret to a successful transition is establishing an easily-felt connection between the two scenes. In a plot-related transition, the connection is that of successive events in an unfolding story. For example, a shot of a new car might be used to introduce a documentary about its design and production.

A neutral transition doesn’t in itself imply a story development or a change of time or place, but can be used to smoothly connect different excerpts from a scene. For example, cutting away to an interested audience member during a podium discussion lets you then cut back unobtrusively to a later point in the same discussion, omitting the part between.

External transitions show something apart from the action. For example, during a shot inside the marriage registry, you might cut to the exterior of the marriage registry, where a surprise is already being set up.

Transitions should underscore the message of the film and must always fit the respective situation, in order to avoid confusing viewers or distracting from the actual storyline.

Logical sequence of action

The shots strung together during editing must interact appropriately in relation to the action. Viewers will be

unable to follow the events unless the storyline is logical. Capture viewer interest from the very beginning with a fast-paced or spectacular start and maintain that interest until the very end. Viewers can lose interest or become disoriented if scenes are strung together in a manner that is illogical or chronologically false, or if scenes are too hectic or short (under three seconds). There should be some continuity of motif from one scene to the next.

Bridging the gaps

Make an effort to bridge the gaps from one filming location to another. You can use close-ups, for example, to bridge chronological jumps, zooming in on the face, then back out after a few seconds onto a different scene.

Maintain continuity

Continuity – consistency of detail from one scene to the next – is vital in providing a satisfying viewing experience. Sunny weather does not fit with spectators who opened their umbrellas.

Tempo of cuts

The tempo at which a film cuts from one scene to the next often influences the message and mood of the film. The absence of an expected shot and the duration of a shot are both ways of manipulating the message of the film.

Avoid visual disjunctions

Stringing together similar shots in succession may result in visual disjunctions. A person may be in the left

Appendix D: Videography tips 403

half of the frame one moment and in the right half of the frame the next, or may appear first with and then without eyeglasses.

Do not string together pan shots

Pan shots should not be strung together unless they have the same direction and tempo.

Rules of thumb for video editing

Here are some guidelines that may be helpful when you come to edit your movie. Of course, there are no hard and fast rules, especially if your work is humorous or experimental.

• Do not string together scenes in which the camera is moving. Pans, zooms, and other moving shots should always be separated by static shots.

• Shots that follow one another should be from different camera positions. The camera angle should vary by at least 45 degrees.

Sequences of faces should always be shot alternately from varying angles of view.

Change perspectives when shooting buildings. When you have similar shots of the same type and size, the picture diagonal should alternate between front left to rear right and vice versa.

• Make cuts when persons are in motion. The viewer will be distracted by the ongoing motion and the cut will go almost without notice. In particular, you can cut to a long shot from the middle of the motion.

Make harmonious cuts; avoid visual disjunction.

The less motion there is in a shot, the shorter it should be. Shots with fast movements can be longer.

Long shots have more content, so they should also be shown longer.

Ordering your video sequences in a deliberate manner not only permits you to produce certain effects, but even enables you to convey messages that cannot or should not be shown in pictures. There are basically six methods of conveying messages through cuts. Let’s look at each in turn.

Associative cuts

Shots are strung together in a certain order to trigger associations in the mind of the viewer, but the actual message is not shown. Example: A man bets on a horse race and, in very next scene, we see him shopping for an expensive new car at a car dealership.

Parallel cuts

Two actions are shown in parallel. The film jumps back and forth between the two actions; making the shots shorter and shorter until the end. This is a way of building suspense until it peaks. Example: Two different cars drive from different directions at high speed toward the same intersection.

Contrast cuts

The film purposely cuts unexpectedly from one shot to another, very different shot, in order to point up the contrast to the viewer. Example: A tourist lying on the beach; the next shot shows starving children.

Appendix D: Videography tips 405

Substitutionary cut

Events that cannot or should not be shown are replaced by other events (a child is born, but instead of childbirth, the blossoming of a flower bud is shown).

Cause and effect cuts

Shots are related by virtue of cause and effect: without the first shot, the second would be incomprehensible.

Example: A man fights with his wife and, in the very next shot, winds up sleeping under a bridge.

Formal cuts

Shots that vary in content can be strung together if they have something in common – the same shapes, colors, or motions, for example. Examples: A crystal ball and the earth; a yellow raincoat and yellow flowers; a falling skydiver and a falling feather.

Soundtrack production

Soundtrack production is an art, but it is an art one can learn. Of course, it is no easy task to create a superb narration, but short, informative comments are often very helpful for the viewer. Whatever narration there is should sound natural, expressive and spontaneous, not wooden or stiff.

Keep comments brief

A general rule applicable to all commentary is that less is more. Pictures should speak for themselves, and things that are evident to viewers from the pictures require no comment.

Preserve original sounds

Spoken commentary should be mixed with both the original sounds and the music in such a way that the original sounds can still be heard. Natural sound is part of your video footage and should not be cut away altogether if at all possible, because video without natural sound can easily seem sterile and lacking in authenticity. Frequently, however, the recording equipment captures noises from aircraft and cars that do not appear in the scene later. Sounds such as these, or loud wind noises, which can be distracting or annoying, should be masked, filtered or replaced with appropriate narration or music.

Select appropriate music

Appropriate music adds a professional finishing touch to your movie and can do a lot to reinforce the message of a video. The music selected, however, should always be appropriate to the message of the film. This is sometimes a time-consuming matter and a challenge, but greatly appreciated by the viewer.

Title

The title should be informative, describe the contents of the movie, and arouse interest. With the built-in title editors there are no limits to how creative you can be.

As a rule, you can let your fancy run free when designing a title for your video.

Use a short, clear title

Titles should be short and in a large, legible font.

Appendix D: Videography tips 407

Title colors

The following combinations of background and text are easy to read: white with red, yellow with black, and white with green. Exercise caution with very white titles on a very black background. Some video systems are unable to handle contrast ratios in excess of 1:40 and are unable to reproduce such titles in detail.

Time on screen

As a rule of thumb, a title should be displayed long enough to be read twice. Allow about three seconds for a title with ten letters. Allow an additional second of on-screen time for every five additional letters.

“Found” titles

Besides postproduction titles, natural titles like directional signs, street signs or title pages of local newspapers also create interesting possibilities.

APPENDIX E:

Glossary

Multimedia terminology contains computer and video terminology. The most important terms are defined below. Cross-references are indicated by .

720p: A high-definition (HD) video format with a resolution of 1280x720 and progressive (noninterlaced) frames.

108i: A high-definition (HD) video format with a resolution of 1440x1080 and interlaced frames.

ActiveMovie: Software interface by Microsoft for the control of multimedia devices under Windows.

DirectShow, DirectMedia

ADPCM: Acronym for Adaptive Delta Pulse Code

Modulation, a method of storing audio information in a digital format. This is the audio encoding and compression method used in CD-I and CD-ROM production.

Address: All available saving positions in a computer are numbered (addressed). By means of these addresses each saving position can be occupied. Some addresses are reserved for the exclusive use of particular hardware components. If two components are using the same address, this is called an “address conflict”.

Appendix E: Glossary 409

Aliasing: An inaccurate display of an image due to the limitations of the output device. Typically, aliasing appears in the form of jagged edges along curves and angled shapes.

Anti-aliasing: A method of smoothing out jagged edges in bitmap images. This is usually accomplished by shading the edges with pixels intermediate in color between the edge and the background, making the transition less apparent. Another method of antialiasing involves using higher resolution output devices.

Aspect ratio: The ratio of width to height in an image or graphic. Keeping the aspect ratio fixed means that any change to one value is immediately reflected in the other.

AVI: Audio Video Interleaved, a standard format for digital video (and Video for Windows ).

Batch capture: An automated process that uses an edit decision list to locate and recapture specific clips from a videotape, usually at a higher data rate than the clip was originally captured.

BIOS: Acronym for Basic Input Output System, which refers to basic input and output commands saved in a

ROM , PROM or EPROM . The essential task of the BIOS is the control of input and output. When the system is started, the ROM-BIOS carries out some tests. Parallel port , IRQ , I/O

Bit: Abbreviation of “BInary digiT ” , the smallest element of a computer’s memory. Among other things, bits are used to store the color values of pixels in an image. The more bits used for each pixel , the greater the number of available colors. For example:

1-bit: each pixel is either black or white.

4-bit: allows 16 colors or gray shades.

8-bit: allows 256 colors or gray shades.

16-bit: allows 65,536 colors.

24-bit: allows about 16.7 million colors.

Bitmap: An image format made up of a collection of dots or “pixels” arranged in rows. Pixel

Blacking: The process of preparing a videotape for insert editing by recording video black and continuous control track on the entire tape. If the recording deck supports timecode, continuous timecode will be recorded simultaneously (also called “striping”).

Brightness: Also “luminance”. Indicates the brightness of video.

Byte: One byte corresponds to eight bits . With one byte, exactly one alphanumeric character can be displayed (i.e. a letter, number).

CD-ROM: Mass storage media for digital data, such as digital video. CD-ROMs can be read from but not written (recorded) onto: ROM is an acronym for

Read-Only Memory.

Channel: Classifications of information within a data file to isolate a particular aspect of the file. For example, color images use different channels to classify the color components in the image. Stereo audio files use channels to identify the sounds intended for the left and right speakers. Video files use combinations of the channels used for image and audio files.

Clip: In Studio, any media type that goes on the Movie

Window Storyboard or Timeline, including video images, trimmed video scenes, images, audio files and disc menus.

Clipboard: A temporary storage area shared by all

Windows programs, used to hold data during cut, copy,

Appendix E: Glossary 411

and paste operations. Any new data you place onto the clipboard immediately replaces the existing data.

Closed GOP: GOP

Codec: Contraction of compressor/decompressor – an algorithm that compresses (packs) and decompresses

(unpacks) image data. Codecs can be implemented in either software or hardware.

Color depth: Number of bits delivering the color information for each pixel. A 1-bit color depth allows

2

1

=2 colors, an 8-bit depth allows 2

24-bit depth allows 2

24

8

=256 colors, and a

=16,777,216 colors.

Color model: A way to mathematically describe and define colors and the way they relate to each other.

Each color model has its own strengths. The two most common color models are RGB and YUV .

Color saturation: Intensity of a color.

Complementary color: Complementary colors are opposite in value to primary colors. If you were to combine a color with its complement, the result would be white. For example, the complementary colors of red, green and blue are cyan, magenta and yellow respectively.

COM Port: A serial port located on the back of your computer for attaching a modem, plotter, printer or mouse to the system.

Composite video: Composite video encodes luminance and chrominance information into one signal. VHS and 8mm are formats that record and play back composite video.

Compression: A method for making files smaller in size. There are two types of compression: lossless and

lossy . Files compressed with a lossless scheme can be restored unchanged from their original state. Lossy schemes discard data during compression, so some image quality is sacrificed. The loss of quality may be negligible or severe depending on the amount of compression.

Cropping: Choosing the area of an image to be displayed.

Data rate: The quantity of data transmitted per unit time; for example, the number of bytes read from or written to a hard drive per second, or the amount of video data processed per second.

Data transfer rate: The measurement of the speed at which information passes between the storage device

(e.g. CD-ROM or hard drive) and the display device

(e.g. monitor or MCI device). Depending on the devices used, some transfer rates may offer better performance than others.

DCT: Discrete Cosine Transformation – part of

JPEG image data compression and related algorithms. The brightness and color information is saved as a frequency coefficient.

DirectShow: System extension by Microsoft for multimedia applications under Windows.

ActiveMovie

DirectMedia: System extension by Microsoft for multimedia applications under Windows.

ActiveMovie

DirectX: A bundle of several system extensions developed by Microsoft for Windows 95 and its successors to make possible video and game acceleration.

Appendix E: Glossary 413

Dissolve: A transitional effect in which the video is faded from one scene to the next.

Dithering: Increasing the number of apparent colors in an image by the application of color patterns.

Decibel (dB): A unit of measurement of the loudness of sound. An increase of 3 dB doubles the loudness.

Digital8: Digital videotape format that records DV coded audio and video data on Hi8 tapes. Currently sold only by Sony, Digital8 camcorders and VCRs can play both Hi8 and 8mm cassettes.

Digital video: Digital video stores information bit by bit in a file (in contrast to analog storage media).

DMA: Direct Memory Access.

Driver: A file containing information needed to operate peripherals. The video capture driver operates a video capture board, for example.

DV: Digital videotape format for recording digital audio and video on ¼”-wide metal evaporated tape.

Mini-DV tapes hold up to 60 minutes of content, while standard DV tapes can hold up to 270 minutes.

ECP: “Enhanced Compatible Port”. Enables accelerated bi-directional data transfer via the parallel port . EPP

Edit decision list (EDL): A list of clips and effects in a particular order that will be recorded onto your output tape, disc or file. Studio allows you to create and edit your own edit decision list by adding, deleting and reordering clips and effects in the Movie Window.

EPP: “Enhanced Parallel Port”. Enables accelerated bidirectional data transfer via the parallel port ; recommended for Studio DV. ECP

EPROM: “Erasable Programmable Read-Only

Memory”. Memory chip that after programming retains its data without power supply. The memory contents can be erased with ultraviolet light and rewritten.

Fade to/from black: A digital effect that fades up from black at the beginning of a clip or down to black at the end.

Field: A frame of video consists of horizontal lines and is divided into two fields. The odd lines in the frame are Field 1; the even-numbered lines are Field 2.

File format: The organization of information within a computer file such as an image or word processor document. The format of a file is usually indicated by its “file extension” (e.g. doc , avi or wmf ).

Filters: Tools that alter data to produce special effects.

FireWire: Apple Computer’s trademarked name for the IEEE-1394 serial data protocol.

Frame: A single image in a video or animation sequence. If using full NTSC or PAL resolution, one frame consists of two interlaced fields. NTSC , PAL , field , resolution

Frame rate: The frame rate defines how many frames of a video sequence are played in one second. The frame rate for NTSC video is 30 frames per second.

The frame rate for PAL video is 25 frames per second.

Frame size: The maximum size for displaying image data in a video or animation sequence. If an image intended for the sequence is larger than the frame size, it must be cropped or scaled to fit.

Frequency: The number of repetitions in a periodic process (like a sound wave or an alternating voltage)

Appendix E: Glossary 415

per unit of time. Usually measured in repetitions per second, or Hertz (Hz).

GOP: In MPEG compression the data stream is first divided into “Groups Of Pictures” – sections of several frames each. Each GOP contains three types of frames: I-Frames, P-Frames (pictures) and B-Frames.

GOP size: The GOP size defines, how many I-Frames,

B-Frames and P-Frames are included in one GOP .

For example, current GOP sizes are 9 or 12.

Hardware codec: Compression method that uses special hardware to create and play back compressed digital video sequences. A hardware codec may offer better encoding speed and image quality than a codec implemented completely in software. Codec ,

Software codec

HD: High Definition video. Most HD formats in use have a resolution of either 1920x1080 resolution or

1280x720 resolution. A substantial difference exists between the 1080 and 720 standards: the larger format uses 2.25 more pixels per frame. This difference substantially increases requirements for processing

1080 content in terms of encoding time, decoding speed, and storage. The 720 formats are all progressive.

The 1080 format has a mixture of progressive and interlaced frame types. Computers and their displays are inherently progressive, whereas television broadcasting has been based on interlaced techniques and standards. For HD terminology, we indicate progressive with the letter "p" and interlaced with the letter "i"

HDV: A format for the recording and playback of high-definition video on a DV cassette tape. has been established as the "HDV" format". Instead of the "DV"

codec, HDV uses a flavor of MPEG-2 . There are two varieties of HDV: HDV1 and HDV2. HDV1 is

1280x720 resolution with progressive frames (720p).

The MPEG transport stream is 19.7 Mbps/s. HDV2 is

1440x1080 resolution with interlaced frames (1080i).

The MPEG transport stream is 25 Mbps/s.

Hi8: Improved version of Video8 using S-Video recorded on metal particle or metal evaporated tape.

Because of higher luminance resolution and wider bandwidth, the result is sharper pictures than Video8.

HiColor: For images, this normally means a 16-bit

(5-6-5) data type that can contain up to 65,536 colors.

TGA file formats support images of this type. Other file formats require prior conversion of a HiColor image into TrueColor . For displays, HiColor normally refers to 15-bit (5-5-5) display adapters that can display up to 32,768 colors. Bit

Huffman coding: Technique used in JPEG and other data compression methods in which seldom occurring values receive a long code, while frequentlyoccurring values receive a short code.

IDE: “Integrated Device Electronics” – a hard-drive interface that combines all drive control electronics on the drive itself, rather than on the adapter connecting the drive to the expansion bus.

IEEE-1394: Developed by Apple Computers and introduced as FireWire, this is a serial data transmission protocol with rates up to 400 Mbits/sec.

Sony offers a slightly modified version for transmitting

DV signals named i.LINK, providing transmission speeds up to 100 Mbits/sec.

Image: An image is a reproduction, or picture of something. The term is often applied to digitized

Appendix E: Glossary 417

pictures, consisting of pixels, that can be shown on a computer display and manipulated by software.

Image compression: Method of reducing the amount of data required to store digital image and video files.

Interlaced: The screen refresh method used by television systems. The PAL TV image consists of two interleaved image halves ( fields ) of 312½ lines each. The NTSC TV image consists of two image halves of 242½ lines each. The fields are displayed alternately to produce a blended image.

Interleave: An arrangement of audio and video to promote smoother playback and synchronization or compression. The standard AVI format equally spaces audio and video.

I/O: Input/Output.

IRQ: “Interrupt Request”. An “interrupt” is a temporary break in the main processing stream of a computer so that housekeeping or background tasks can be performed. Interrupts can be requested by either hardware (e.g. keyboard, mouse) or software.

JPEG: Joint Photographic Experts Group, and the standard developed by them for compressing digital frames based on DCT .

Kbyte (also KB): One Kbyte (kilobyte) contains 1024 bytes . The “K” here stands for the number 1024

(2

10

), and not 1000 as in the metric prefix.

Key color: A color whose display is suppressed so that a background image can show through. Most commonly used when overlaying one video sequence on top of another, allowing the underlying video to display wherever the key color appears.

Key frames: In some compression methods, such as

MPEG , the video data of certain frames – the key frames – is stored completely in the compressed file, while any intervening frames are only partially saved.

On decompression these partial frames reconstruct their data from the key frames.

Laser disc: Medium that stores analog video.

Information on laser discs cannot be modified.

LPT: Parallel port

Luminance: Brightness

M1V: (File extension for) an MPEG file that contains video data only. MPA , MPEG , MPG

Mbyte (also MB): One Mbyte (megabyte) corresponds to 1024 Kbytes – 1024 x 1024 bytes.

Mark In / Mark Out: In video editing, the mark in and mark out times refer to the starting and ending timecodes that identify the portions of clips to be included in the project.

MCI: Media Control Interface. Programming interface developed by Microsoft recording and playing back audio and video data. It is also used to connect a computer to an external video source such as a VCR or laser disc.

Modulation: The encoding of information upon an empty carrier signal.

Motion-JPEG (M-JPEG): A Video for Windows format, specified by Microsoft, for encoding video sequences. JPEG compression is used to compress each frame individually.

MPA: (File extension for) an MPEG file that contains audio data only. M1V , MPEG , MPG

Appendix E: Glossary 419

MPEG: Motion Picture Experts Group, and the standard developed by them for the compression of moving images. Compared to M-JPEG, it offers 75-

80% data reduction with the same visual quality.

MPG: (File extension for) an MPEG file that contains both video and audio data. M1V , MPEG , MPA

MPV: (File extension for) an MPEG file that contains video data only. MPA , MPEG , MPG

Non-interlaced: Describes an image refresh method in which the complete image is generated as a single field without skipping lines. A non-interlaced image (most computer monitors) flickers much less than an interlaced image (most TVs).

NTSC: National Television Standards Committee, and the color TV standard created by them in 1953. NTSC video has 525 lines per frame and 60 image fields per second. It is used in North and Central America, Japan and other countries. PAL , SECAM

PAL: “Phase Alternation Line”, a color TV standard developed in Germany and used throughout most of

Europe. PAL video has 625 lines per frame and 50 image fields per second. NTSC , SECAM

Parallel port: Parallel port data is transmitted via an

8-bit data line. This means that eight bits (one byte ) can be transmitted at once. This kind of transmission is much faster than serial transmission, but is not appropriate for long-distance connections.

Parallel ports are often named “LPT n ”, where n is a number (e.g. “LPT1”). Serial port

Pixel: The smallest element of a monitor image. The word is an abbreviation of “picture element”.

Port: Electrical transfer point for the transmission of audio, video, control or other data between two devices. Serial port , Parallel port

Primary colors: The colors that are the basis of the

RGB color model: red, green, and blue. It is possible to create most other colors on a computer screen by varying the blend of these primaries.

QSIF: Quarter Standard Image Format. An MPEG-1 format specifying a resolution of 176 x 144 under PAL and 176 x 120 under NTSC. MPEG , SIF

Quantization: One part of the JPEG image data compression strategy. Relevant details are represented precisely, while details that are less relevant for the human eye are represented with less precision.

Raster: The area of a video display that is covered by sweeping the electron beam of the display in a series of horizontal lines from upper left to lower right (from the viewer’s perspective).

Redundancy: This trait of images is exploited by compression algorithms. Superfluous information can be eliminated during compression and restored without loss during decompression.

Resolution: The number of pixels that can be displayed on the monitor horizontally and vertically. The higher the resolution, the more details can be displayed.

Pixel

RGB: Red, Green and Blue: the primary colors in additive color mixing. RGB designates the method used in computer technology of encoding image information in pixels, each containing some combination of the three primaries.

Appendix E: Glossary 421

ROM: Read Only Memory: Memory storage that, having been programmed once, retains its data without requiring electrical power. EPROM

Run Length Encoding (RLE): A technique used in many image compression methods, including

JPEG . Repeating values are not stored separately but with a counter to indicate how many times the value occurs in succession – the length of the “run”.

Scaling: Adaptation of an image to a desired size.

SCSI: Small Computers System Interface. SCSI was long preferred as the hard drive interface for some high-performance PCs because of its high data rate. Up to eight SCSI devices can be connected to a computer at the same time.

SECAM: “Séquentiel Couleur à Mémoire”, a color TV transmission system used in France and Eastern

Europe. Like PAL, SECAM video has 625 lines per frame and 50 image fields per second. NTSC , PAL

Serial port: Data transmitted via a serial port is processed one bit at a time; that is, “serially” – one after another. The transmission rate is much slower than that of a parallel port, where parallel data lines allow multiple bits to be sent simultaneously. Serial ports are named “COM n ”, where n is a number (e.g.

“COM2”). Parallel port

SIF: Standard Image Format. An MPEG-1 format specifying a resolution of 352 x 288 under PAL and

352 x 240 under NTSC. MPEG , QSIF

Single frame: A single frame is part of a series or sequence. When this series is viewed at sufficient speed, the illusion of a “moving picture” is created.

Software codec: Compression method that can create and play back compressed digital video sequences without special hardware. The quality of the sequences depends on the performance of the complete system.

Codec , Hardware codec

Still video: Still images (or “freeze-frames”) extracted from video.

S-VHS: Improved version of VHS using S-Video and metal particle tape to deliver higher luminance resolution, resulting in sharper pictures than VHS.

VHS , S-Video

S-Video: With S-Video (Y/C) signals, the brightness

(luminance or “Y”) and the color (chrominance or “C”) information are transferred separately using multiple wires, avoiding modulating and demodulating the video and the resulting loss of picture quality.

Timecode: Timecode identifies the position of each frame in a video sequence with respect to a starting point (normally the beginning of the shot). The usual format is H:M:S:F (hours, minutes, seconds, frames), e.g. “01:22:13:21”. Unlike a tape counter (which can be

“zeroed” or reset at any point in a tape), timecode is an electronic signal written onto videotape, and is permanent once it is assigned.

Transition: The visual connection between adjacent video clips, ranging from a simple “cut” to a showy animated effect. The common transitions like cuts, fades, dissolves, wipes and slides are part of the visual language of film and video. They can convey passages of time and changes of viewpoint concisely – and often subliminally.

TrueColor: The name indicates an image with enough color resolution to appear “true to life”. In practice,

Appendix E: Glossary 423

TrueColor normally refers to 24-bit RGB color, which allows about 16.7 million combinations of the red, green and blue primary colors. Bit , HiColor

TWAIN driver: TWAIN is a standardized software interface allowing graphics and capture programs to communicate with devices that supply graphical data. If the TWAIN driver is installed, the capture function of a graphics application can be used to load images directly from your video source into the program. The driver supports 32-bit programs only and captures images in

24-bit mode.

VCR: “Video cassette recorder”.

VHS: “Video Home System” – Popular video standard for home VCRs. Half-inch tape is used to store

“composite” signals incorporating both brightness and color information.

VISCA: Protocol used with certain devices for controlling external video sources from computers.

Video8: Analog video system using 8mm tape. Video8 recorders generate composite signals.

Video CD: CD-ROM standard that uses MPEG compressed videos.

Video decoder: Converts digital information into analog video signals.

Video encoder: Converts analog video signals into digital information.

Video for Windows: A Microsoft Windows system extension that can record digital video sequences to files on a hard drive and subsequently play them back.

Video scan rate: Frequency with which the video signal is scanned onto an image display. The higher the

video scan rate, the higher the image quality and the less noticeable the flicker.

WAV: (File extension for) a popular file format for digitized audio signals.

White balance: In an electronic camera, this is the adjustment of the amplifiers for the three color channels (red, green and blue) so that white areas of the scene do not show a color cast.

Y/C: Y/C is a color signal with two components: brightness information (Y) and color information (C).

YUV: The color model of a video signal where Y delivers the brightness information and U and V the color information.

Appendix E: Glossary 425

APPENDIX F:

Keyboard shortcuts

The terms Left , Right , Up and Down in these tables refer to the arrow (cursor) keys.

Standard shortcuts

Ctrl+N

Ctrl+O

New… project (main interface) or title

Open project or title

Ctrl+S Save project or title

Ctrl+Z Undo

Ctrl+Y Redo

Ctrl+C

Ctrl+V

Ctrl+X

Copy to clipboard

Paste from clipboard

Cut to clipboard

Delete Delete without copying to clipboard

Main Studio interface

Space bar

J

Play and stop

Fast reverse (hit multiple times for faster playback)

Appendix F: Keyboard shortcuts 427

L

X or Ctrl+Up

Y or Ctrl+Down

A or I

S or O

Ctrl+Left

Ctrl+Right

Alt+Left

Alt+Right

Alt+Ctrl+Left

Alt+Ctrl+Right

G

D

F

E or Home

R or End

Left

Right

Delete

Insert

Ctrl+Delete

Page up

Page down

Numeric pad +

Numeric pad -

C

V

M

Ctrl+Page up

Ctrl+Page down

Ctrl+E

Ctrl+D

Ctrl+F

Fast forward (hit multiple times for faster playback)

Step forward 1 frame

Step back 1 frame

Mark in

Mark out

Trim in point by -1 frame

Trim in point by +1 frame

Trim out point by -1 frame

Trim out point by +1 frame

Rolling trim out point by -1 frame

(trims following clip too)

Rolling trim out point by +1 frame

Clear mark in and mark out

Go to mark in (in trimmer tool)

Go to mark out (in trimmer tool)

Go to start

Go to end

Select previous clip

Select next clip

Delete selected clip(s)

Split clip at scrubber position

Delete clip and… close Timeline gap

(video track); leave Timeline gap

(other tracks)

Go to next page in Movie Window

Go to previous page in Movie Window

Zoom in the Timeline

Zoom out the Timeline

Set menu chapter

Clear menu chapter

Set return to menu

Go to previous menu chapter

Go to next menu chapter

Copy all effects in Timeline clip

Paste effects to Timeline clip

Open effects tool

Motion Titler

F11

F12

Alt+Plus

Alt+Minus

Ctrl+Plus

Ctrl+Minus

Cancel (exit titler)

Confirm (exit titler)

Bring to front

Send to back

Bring forward one layer

Send back one layer

Space bar With cursor in timeline area: Start and stop playback

Classic Title Editor

F11

F12

Alt+Plus

Alt+Minus

Ctrl+Plus

Ctrl+Minus

Ctrl+0

Ctrl+1

Cancel (exit titler)

Confirm (exit titler)

Bring to front

Send to back

Bring forward one layer

Send back one layer

Text justification off

Text justification: bottom left

Ctrl+3

Ctrl+4

Text justification: bottom right

Text justification: middle left

Ctrl+7

Ctrl+K

Shift+Right

Text justification: top left

Kern, leading and skew

Expand character selection right

Appendix F: Keyboard shortcuts 429

Ctrl+Left

Ctrl+Right

Ctrl+Down

Ctrl+Up

Reduce horizontal scale of, or squeeze (kern), text selection depending on current edit mode

(move/scale/rotate or kern/skew/leading)

Increase horizontal scale of, or stretch

(kern), text selection

Reduce scale or leading of text selection depending on current edit mode

Increase scale or leading of text selection

Shift+Ctrl+Right Same as Ctrl+Right (coarse)

Shift+Ctrl+Down Same as Ctrl+Down (coarse)

Shift+Ctrl+Up

Alt+Left

Alt+Right

Same as Ctrl+Up (coarse)

In text selection: Move characters left. No selection: Move left all text from cursor to end of line.

In text selection: Move characters right. No selection: Move right all text from cursor to end of line.

Shift+Alt+Right Same as Alt+Right (coarse)

Index

2

2D editor (video effect), 175

A

A/B editing, 183

Abbreviations, xiv

Activate

Explained, 13

Adding media to the Bin, 88

Album

Aspect ratio, 113

Classic Title Editor. See Classic

Title Editor Album

Clipboard operations, 110

Disc Menus section, 83, 224

Drag-and-drop editing, 110

Favorite folders, 60, 67

Folders, 60, 67

Image sections, 210

Interface features, 65

Menu usage, 66

Motion Titler. See Motion Titler

Album

Music section, 85

Overview, 57

Previewing, 5, 61

Project Bin, 86

Selecting video scenes, 72

Sound Effects section, 84

Index

Source folders, 62

Still Images section, 82

Themes section, 80, 140, 141, 143

Titles section, 81

Transitions section, 78, 199

Video Scenes section, 109

Videos section, 63

Album menu

Combine Scenes, 75

Comment view, 74

Details view, 73

Find Scene in Project, 66, 116

Icon view, 73

Scene detection commands, 78

Select By Name, 75

Set Thumbnail, 69

Subdivide Scenes, 76

Thumbnail view, 74

Album, Motion Titler, 262

Alpha Magic transitions, 201

Analog

Levels during import, 21

Outputting to, 347

Analog video and audio (Import),

47

Anatomy of a theme, 147

Animated pan-and-zoom, 215

Animation, 380, See Stop-motion animation

Stop motion, 21

With themes, 139

431

Animation, Stop-motion, 49

Answer IDs (technical support),

384

Aspect ratios (frame formats), 69

Mixing, 112

Audio

Adjusting on Timeline, 313

Analog import options, 21

Background music, 300

Insert editing, 130

Muting, 98

Original, 300

Overlay, 182

Overlay, original, 300

Scrubbing, 92

Settings (for File output), 368

Sound effects, 300

Surround, 316

Synchronized with video, 126

Synchronous, 96, 204, 300

Tracks on Timeline, 300

Transitions, 204, 315

Uses of, 297

Using in Studio, 298

Using without video, 111

Voice-overs, 300

Volume and mixing, 310, 316

Audio clips, 96

Interface details, 311

Trimming, 308

Audio compression, 368

Audio effects, 323

Applied to theme clips, 147

ChannelTool, 326

Chorus, 326

Copy and paste, 324

DeEsser, 327

Equalizer, 327

Grungelizer, 328

Icons, 323

In Studio Ultimate, 326

Leveler, 329

Noise reduction, 324

Reverb, 329

Standard vs. Ultimate, 324

Stereo Echo, 330

Stereo Spread, 330

Tool, 323

Unlocking, 157

Audio levels

In analog import, 21

Audio scrubbing button, 92

Audio toolbox, 107

Audio track

Linked to video track, 128

Audio tracks, 301

Auto color correction (video effect), 169

Automatic scene detection. See

Scene detection

AVCHD, xiv

Output movie to, 335

AVI files, 85

B

Background

In Classic Title Editor, 251

In Motion Titler, 277

Background music, 94, 96

CD, 302

Formats, 300

ScoreFitter, 303

Tool, 107, 303

Background rendering, 112

Enabling and disabling, 204

Of Hollywood FX, 204

Of moving menu thumbnails, 233

Of video effects, 166

Backgrounds section

Of Classic Title Editor Album, 251

Balance

Adjusting on Timeline, 314

Balance and volume, 107, 310

BD (Import), 48

Bin, Project, 86

Black and white (video effect),

177

Blur (video effect), 173

Blu-ray

Output movie to, 335

Blu-ray Disc (Import), 48

Buttons

Add Marker, 100

Audio scrubbing, 92

Chapter. See Disc menus

Clip, 91

Clip delete, 93

Clip marker, 91

Clip split, 91

Delete Marker, 100

DVD toggle, 5, 6

Edit menu, 105

Highlighting, 255

Mode, 2

Playback, 9

Project Bin, 91

Razorblade, 125

Reset (pan-and-zoom), 214

Split clip, 125, 128

Split clip/scene, 93

Tool selector, 103

Toolbox, 102

Track-locking, 126

Undo, Redo, Help, Support and

Activate, 2

View selection, 91

Buttons section

Of Classic Title Editor Album, 254

C

Camcorder Controller, 220

Cameras

Analog (Import), 47

DV, HDV (Import), 42

Capture. See Import

Audio and video levels, 21

Overview, 17

Preparing hard drive, 377

Scene detection, 31

To multiple files, 111

Capture mode

Introduced, 1

Captured video. See Video

Card, memory. See Memory card

CD audio clips

Index

Properties of, 309

CD audio tool, 107, 302

ChannelTool (audio effect), 326

Chapter links. See Links

Chapters

On menu track, 228

Chorus (audio effect), 326

Chroma key

Background cloth for, 196

Tips, 195

Tool, 190

Video effect, 193

Classic Title Editor, 237

Advanced text editing, 243

Launching, 238

Multiple selection in, 246

Classic Title Editor Album, 249

Backgrounds section, 251

Buttons section, 254

Looks Browser, 249

Pictures section, 253

Classic Title Editor controls

Clipboard and delete buttons, 247

Mode selection buttons, 243

Object layout buttons, 245

Object toolbox, 240

Selection tool, 240

Text styling, 247

Title-type buttons, 239

Classic Title Editor objects, 240

Reordering layers, 241

Text, 242

Clip markers, 99

Adding, deleting, naming, 100

Controls, 101

Clip properties

Duration, 212

Name, 212

Clip properties tool, 99, 104, 107

For audio clips, 308

For disc menus, 230

For still images, 212

For transitions, 207

For video clips, 123

Trimming with, 122, 207

Clipboard

433

With Album and Movie Window,

110

Clips

Audio, 96

Changing name, 122

Combining, 126

Deleting, 93

Splitting, 93, 125

Theme, 141, 143, 145

Trimming on the Timeline, 117

Trimming tips, 121

Video, 96

Close-ups, 401

Color correction (video effect),

177

Color effects

White balance, 180

Color map (video effect), 178

Colors

Selecting, 196

Combine Clips menu command,

126

Compression

Audio, 368

Options (Import), 30

Video, 366

Configuration. See Options

Content

Importing, 15

Continuity (videography tip), 403

Controls

Clip marker, 91

Conventions, xiv

Copy and paste effects

Copy and paste, 156

Copyright protection in DVD, BD import, 48

Counter, 10

Create between markers, 333

Cross fade

In audio, 204

Cut (transition), 201

Cuts

Associative, 405

Cause and effect, 406

Contrast, 405

Formal, 406

Parallel, 405

Substitutionary, 406

Tempo of (videography tip), 403

D

DeEsser (audio effect), 327

Delete clip button, 93

Deleting clips, 93

Deleting scenes, 93

Dialog boxes

Main Options, 351

Make Movie Options, 351

Options, 351

Digital photo cameras (Import), 49

DirectX, xii

Disc

Image on hard drive, 334

Previewing, 226

Saving movie to, 334

Disc chapter command, 226

Disc menu tool, 105, 235

Disc menus, 221

Automatic link creation, 225

Button captions, 225

Chapter editing, 234

Creating, 237

Described, 221

Editing, 237

Editing links, 230

Editing on Timeline, 228

Link numbers during editing, 231

Loop during playback, 222

Menus vs. titles, 224

Motion backgrounds, 252

Motion Thumbnails option, 233

Name and duration, 230

Obtaining, 84

Opening in Classic Title Editor,

230

Placing on Timeline, 225

Sample movie layout, 222

Section (of Album), 83, 224

Setting thumbnail, 233

Supplied, 224

VCD, S-VCD limitations, 225

Discs

Authoring, 1, 60, 83, 209, 223,

254, 310

Dissolve (transition), 202

Drag-and-drop

Editing, 110

From Album, 110, 199

Setting menu links, 234

Dream glow (video effect), 169

Drop zones

Adding effects, 153

Aligning subclips, 152

Clearing, 152

Muting, 152

Durations (of transitions etc.), 353

DV, xiv

Outputting to, 347

DV/HDV camera (Import), 42

DVD

Image on hard drive, 334

Menus, 83, See Disc menus

Output movie to, 335

Playback controls, 6, 11, 223

Player control, 226

Previewing, 226

DVD (Import), 48

E

Earthquake (video effect), 175

Edit

Video clips, 109

Edit line

Clips inserted at, 110

Edit menu button, 105

Edit mode

Interface, 4

Introduced, 1

Edit Theme command, 142

Edit window (Motion Titler), 279

Editing, 400

A/B, 183

Advanced, 97, 181

Index

Disc menus, 228

Insert, 128

Split, 130

Still images, 211

Editing photos and other images,

213

Editor, Menu and Title, 237

Editors, Menu and Title, 257

Effects

Audio. See Audio effects

Copy and paste, 156

Video. See Video effects

Emboss (video effect), 173

Equalizer (audio effect), 327

Equipment requirements, xii

F

Fade

Adjusting balance on Timeline,

314

Fade (transition), 202

Fades

Default duration of, 353

File

Saving movie to, 338

File name

Project, 91

File type

3GP, 340

AVI, 341

DivX, 342

Flash Video, 342 iPod compatible, 343

MOV, 343

MP2, 340

MP3, 340

MPEG, 344

Real Media, 345

Sony PSP compatible, 345

WAV, 340

Windows Media, 346

File types

AVI, 85

Image, 82

435

MP3, 85

Music, 85

Sound, 85

WAV, 84

Filename panel (Import Wizard),

32

Find Scene in Album command,

66

Find Scene in Project command,

66

Flags

Placing on menu track, 229

Folders

Album, 60

Favorite, 60, 67

Music, 86

Source, 62

Still images, 82

Titles, 82

Fonts, 248

Frame formats. See Aspect ratios

Frame grabber, 219

Tool, 105, 210

Tool, described, 219

Full-screen images

Described, 210

G

Glossary, 409

GOP

Closed, 412

Size, 416

Grab frames tool

Described, 219

Graphics

Editing, 213

Groups

Temporary, In Classic Title Editor,

246

Grungelizer (audio effect), 328

H

Hard drive

Preparing for capture, 377

HD, 416

HD DVD

Output movie to, 335

HDV, xiv, 417

HDV camera (Import), 42

Help button, 2

Highlighting

Of menu buttons, 255

Hollywood FX

And background rendering, 204

Editing, 203, 207

Previewing, 204

Transitions, 201, 203

I

Icons for effects

Audio, 323

Video, 116

IEEE 1394 (FireWire)

Devices (Import), 42

IEEE-1394, xv

Cable, 347

Images. See Still images

Import

All media, 35

Analog video and audio, 47

Audio and video levels, 21

BD (Blu-ray Disc), 48

Copyright protection (DVD, BD),

48

Digital cameras, 49

DVD, 48

From DV or HDV camera, 42

From IEEE 1394 (FireWire), 42

From local disk, 35

Manually-controlled recording, 45

Mark-In, Mark-Out, 44

Photos, 49

Record video/audio, 45

Record with Mark In/Out, 45

Single-frame, 21

Snapshot, 52

Source, 35

Stop-motion animation, 49

Import From panel (Import

Wizard), 20

Import mode

Introduced, 1

Import To panel (Import Wizard),

23

Import Wizard

Compression options, 30

Filename panel, 32

Import From panel, 20

Import To panel, 23

Mode panel, 27

Options, 19

Overview, 18

Scene detection options, 31

Selecting media, 34

Importing

Overview, 17

Importing content from past versions, 15

Insert edit

A/B, 183

Insert editing, 128

Audio, 130

Introduced, 128

Method, 128

Internet

Saving movie to, 349

Invert, 178

J-cut

A/B, 183

Defined, 130

Explained, 133

Jog buttons, 9

J

K

Ken Burns, 213

Keyboard conventions, xv

Keyframing (of video effects parameters), 160, 163

Knowledge base, 382

Index

L

Layers

In Classic Title Editor, 241

L-cut

A/B, 183

Defined, 130

Explained, 131

Lens flare (video effect), 176

Letterboxing, 113

Leveler (audio effect), 329

Levels, Audio and video

In analog import, 21

Lighting, 179

Links

Adjusting, 229

Automatic creation of, 225

Creating, 229

Deleting, 230

Editing, 230

In disc menu tool, 234

On disc menus, 221

Repositioning, 230

Return to menu, 229

Setting with drag-and-drop, 234

Show numbers while editing, 231

Local disk (Import), 35

Locked content

Activating, 12

Locking tracks, 98

Indication of, 127

Long shots (videography tip), 401

Luma key (video effect), 175

M

Magnify (video effect), 176

Make Movie

Partial, 333

Make Movie mode, 331

Introduced, 2

Making movies, 331

Markers. See Clip markers

Create between markers, 333

Mark-In, Mark-Out

437

Recording, 45

Mark-In, Mark-Out (Import), 44

Media

Selecting for import, 34

Media Player, 346

Memory card, importing from. See

File-based media

Menu and Title Editor, 237

Menu and Title Editors, 257

Menu buttons

Highlighting, 255

Menu commands, xv

Menu Editor. See Title Editor

Menu links. See Links

Menu track, 228

Editing, 229

Flags, 228

Menus, Disc. See Disc menus

Microphone

Connecting, 307

MMC. See File-based media

Mode panel (Import Wizard), 27

Modes

Edit, 4

Introduced, 1

Make Movie, 331

Setting, 2

Monitors

Dual, 355

Montage. See Themes

Motion blur (video effect), 176

Motion Titler

Background panel, 277

Closing, 260

Create and editing titles, 275

Edit window, 279

File operations, 261

Launching, 259

Layer groups, 293

Layer List, 286

Multiple selection, 293

Multiple selection in, 294

Text operations, 282

Motion Titler Album, 262

Adding resources to title, 263

Looks section, 267

Motions section, 272

Objects section, 266

Photos section, 265

Videos section, 264

Movie

Previewing, 5

Movie Window, 91

Clipboard operations, 110

Drag-and-drop editing, 110

Find scene in Album, 66, 116

Interface features, 115

Positioning, 94

Status message area, 91

Trimming on the Timeline, 117

Views, 95

MP2 files, 340

MP3 files, 85, 340

MPEG

Rendering for output, 333

Multiple capture files

Using, 111

Multiple selection

In Classic Title Editor, 246

In Motion Titler, 294

Multiple selection (in Motion

Titler), 293

Multitrack editing, 181

With themes, 139

Music, 297, See Background music

Folder, 86

Section (of Album), 85

Selecting (videography tip), 407

Music video. See SmartMovie

Muting audio tracks, 98

N

Names

In Text and Storyboard view, 122

Of clips - changing, 122

Network. See File-based media

Network, importing from. See

File-based media

Noise reduction (audio effect), 324

Noise reduction (video effect), 170

O

Objects

In Classic Title Editor, 240

Objects section (of Motion Titler

Album), 266

Obtaining

Disc menus, 84

Sound effects, 85

Themes, 80

Transitions, 79

Old film (video effect), 173

Optical disc. See Disc

Image on hard drive, 334

Optical disc summary, 338

Options, 351

Audio for file output, 368

Compression (Import), 30

Data rate and quality, 367

Frame rate, 367

Import, 19

Include audio, 368

Include video, 366

List all codecs, 366

Main dialog, 351

Make audio file, 365

Make AVI file, 365

Make Disc, 360

Make Movie, 351

Make MPEG file, 365

Make Real Media file, 369

Make tape, 374

Make Windows Media file, 372

Organization of, 351

Output to VGA display, 376

Project preferences, 352

Scene detection, 31

Setting, 3

Video and audio preferences, 355

Video compression, 366

Video for file output, 366

Video preview, 355

Original audio

Index

Properties, 309

Synchronized with video, 126

Original sounds

Preserving (videography tip), 407

Output

Audio only, 340

Browser, 331

Media type, 331

To 3GP file, 340

To AVI file, 341

To DivX file, 342

To file, 338

To Flash Video file, 342

To iPod compatible file, 343

To MOV file, 343

To MPEG file, 344

To optical disc, 334

To Real Media file, 345

To Sony PSP compatible file, 345

To Tape, 346

To videotape, 348

To Windows Media, 346

To world-wide web, 349

Overlay effects, 181

Overlay images

Described, 210

Overlay track, 181

Always show option, 182

Audio, 300

Audio, original, 182

Displaying, hiding, 182

Introduced, 181

Opening, 181

Overlays track

And still images, 209

P

Pan and scan, 113

Pan and zoom

Video effect, 218

Pan-and-zoom

Animated, 215

Complex animations, 216

Photos, 214

Tool, 213

439

Parameters for effects

Resetting, 160

Parameters for plug-in effects

Presets, 159

Parameters for video effects

Editing, 158

Passport, 13

Perspectives

Varying, 400

Photo cameras. See Cameras, digital

Photos

Editing, 213

Panning and zooming, 214

Red-eye reduction, 214

Rotating, 214

Photos section (of Motion Titler

Album), 265

Photos, digital (Import), 49

Picture-in-picture

Tool, 184

Video effect, 188

Playback controls, 5

DVD, 6, 11, 223

Fast forward/reverse, 9

Go to beginning, 9

Jog buttons, 9

Loop, 9

Play/Pause, 9

Standard, 5, 9

Playback speed

Changing, 171

Player

During Timeline trimming, 117

Introduced, 5

Previewing transitions, 79, 204

Scrubber, 9

Player control

DVD, 226

Plug-in effects

Unlocking, 157, 168

Posterize (video effect), 179

Premium button, 2

Premium content and features, 14

Presets for effects, 159

Preview window, 5, 120

Preview Window, 7

Previewing

Discs, 226

Hollywood FX, 204

Menus, 6

Transitions, 79, 204

Video effects, 166

Problems and solutions, 381

Product names, xiv

Progressive encoding (advanced output setting), 361

Project. See Movie

Project Bin

Adding media, 88

Button, 91

Removing media, 89

Using, 86

Project preferences (options panel), 352

Project video format, 112

Push (transition), 202

R

Razorblade button, 93

Real Media

Files, 345

RealNetworks® RealPlayer®, 345

RealNetworks® RealPlayer®

Viewing files with, 340

Record video/audio (Import), 45

Recording voice-overs, 305

Quality, 307

Recording, manually-controlled

(Import), 45

Red-eye reduction

Explained, 214

Removing, 215

Redo button, 2

Removing media from the Bin, 89

Rendering, 333

Reordering objects

In three dimensions, 241

Requirements, equipment, xii

Return to menu link, 229

Reverb (audio effect), 329

RGB color balance (video effect),

179

Ripple transition, 205, 211, 224

Rotate (video effect), 170

S

Save to disc, 334

Save to file, 338

3GP, 340

Audio only, 340

AVI, 341

DixX, 342

Flash Video, 342 iPod compatible, 343

MOV, 343

MPEG, 344

Real Media, 345

Sony PSP compatible, 345

Soundtrack, 340

Windows Media, 346

Save to tape, 346

Save to world-wide web, 349

Scanning, progressive vs. interlaced, 361

Scene detection, 31, 69

Menu commands, 78

Scenes. See Video scenes

Scenes (videography tip), 404

ScoreFitter

Clip properties, 310

Duration of clips, 308

Scrubber, 9

Scrubbing audio, 92

SCSI, xiii

SD card, importing from. See Filebased media

Selecting media for import, 34

Sepia (video effect), 180

Set Thumbnail menu command, 69

Settings. See Options

Index

Setup menu, 3

Setup options, 351

Slide (transition), 202

Slideshow, 205, 211, 224

Slow motion, 171

Snapshot, 21

Snapshot (Import), 52

Soften (video effect), 174

Sound effects, 96, 297

Obtaining, 85

Properties, 309

Section (of Album), 84

Sound files, 85

Source (for Import), 35

Speed (video effect), 171

Split Clip menu command, 125

Split clip/scene button, 93, 125

In insert editing, 128

Split edit

A/B, 183

Split editing

Introduced, 130

Splitting clips, 125

Restoring from, 125

Stabilize (video effect), 171

Stained glass (video effect), 174

Stereo

Adjusting balance on Timeline,

314

Stereo Echo (audio effect), 330

Stereo Spread (audio effect), 330

Still cameras. See Cameras, digital

Still images

Creating, 210

Default duration of, 353

Described, 209

Editing, 213

Folder, 82

Full-screen, 210

Full-screen vs. overlay, 209

Overlay, 210

Section (of Album), 82

Trimming, 212

Trimming and editing, 211

Types, 209

441

Still Images

Rotating, 214

Stop motion, 21

Stop-motion animation, 49

Storyboard view, 95

Studio Import Wizard, 18

Studio Ultimate

Audio effects, 324, 326

Keyframing, 160, 163

Video effects, 172

Subclips

Adding effects, 153

Aligning to drop zone, 152

Exporting to Movie Window, 152

Muting, 152

Support button, 2

Surround sound, 316

S-VCD

Menus, 83, See Disc menus

Output movie to, 334

Synchronization (of video and audio)

Overriding, 126

T

Tape

Saving movie to, 346

Technical support, 382

Templates. See Themes

Text editing

Advanced, 243

Text view, 95, 102, 122

Theme clips

Creating, 143

Insert vs. replace, 144

Track selection, 143

Transitions and effects, 147

Trimming and editing, 145

Theme Editor

Mini-Album, 142

Theme Editor tool, 105, 150

Themes

Adding to movie, 141

Anatomy, 147

Backgrounds, 142

Clips. See Theme clips

Customizing, 140

Drop zones, 152

Introduced, 139

Obtaining, 80

Section (of Album), 80, 141, 143

Subclips, 152

Templates, 139, 141, 143, 147,

151

Thumbnail frames

In Album, 69

Setting in disc menus, 233

With moving video, in menus, 233

Timeline

Adjusting volume on, 313

Audio tracks, 300

Editing disc menus on, 228

Locking tracks, 126

Overlay video, 181

Placing disc menus on, 225

Tracks, 96

Trimming clips on, 117

Timeline view, 95, 96

Advanced editing in, 126

Insert editing, 128

Splitting clips in, 125

Timescale, 96

Title

Choosing (videography tip), 407

Colors (videography tip), 408

Title Editor, Classic. See Classic

Title Editor

Title Editor, Motion. See Motion

Titler

Title editors

Introduced, 103

Title track

Locking, 127

Titles

Classic, 237

Crawls, 239

Creating, 237, 257

Editing, 237, 257

Folder, 82

Motion, 257

Rolls, 239

Section (of Album), 81

Titles and overlays track

And still images, 209

Titles tool, 105

Toolbox, 91

Audio, 107

Video, 104

Toolboxes, 102

Tools

Audio effects, 108, 323

Automatic background music, 107

Background music, 303

CD audio, 107, 302

Chroma key, 190

Clip properties, 99, 104, 107, 122,

230, 308

Disc menu, 105, 235

Frame grabber, 105

Pan-and-zoom, 213

Picture-in-picture, 184

PIP and chroma key, 106

SmartMovie, 105, 134

Theme Editor, 105, 142, 150, 151

Titles, 105

Video effects, 106, 155

Voice-overs, 107, 305

Volume and balance, 107, 310,

316

Track lock buttons, 126

Tracks

Audio, 300, 301

Background music, 300

Indication when locked, 127

Locking, 98

Menu, 228

Muting and hiding, 98

Original audio, 300

Overlay, 181

Sound effect and voice-over, 300

Title, 127

Video, 97, 126

Video linked to audio, 128

Transitions

Adding to movie, 199

Alpha Magic, 201

Criteria for selecting, 201

Cut, 201

Default duration of, 353

Described, 199

Displaying type, 79

Dissolve, 202

Effect on clip duration, 200

Fade, 202

Groups, 78

Hollywood FX, 201, 203

In audio, 204

Looping in preview, 208

Naming, 207

Obtaining, 79

On audio tracks, 315

On theme clips, 147

On Timeline, 199

Previewing, 79, 204, 208

Reversing direction, 207

Ripple transition, 205, 211, 224

Section (of Album), 78

Setting duration of, 207

Standard (2D), 201

Three-dimensional, 203

Trimming, 206

Types of, 201

Videography tip, 401

Wipe, slide, push, 202

Trashcan button, 93

Trim scrubber, 99

Trimming

Audio clips, 308

Described, 117

Introduced, 109

On the Timeline, 117

Still images, 211, 212

Tips, 121

Transitions, 206

Undoing, 124

Video clips, 117

With Ctrl key, 120

Troubleshooting, 381

TV set

Simultaneous output to, 347

Index 443

U

UDMA, xiii

Ultimate audio effects pack, 326

Ultimate RTFX video effects pack,

172

Undo button, 2

Unlocking

Plug-in effects, 157, 168

Premium content, 12

USB stick, importing from. See

File-based media

Use keyframes (checkbox), 163

V

VCD

Menus, 83, See Disc menus

Output movie to, 334

VGA

Output movie to, 376

Video

Album interface features, 65

Analog import options, 21

Aspect ratios. See Aspect ratios

Capture. See Capture

Folders, 67

Frame format. See Aspect ratios

Hiding, 98

Opening file, 67

Output hardware, xiii

Settings (for File output), 366

Video and audio preferences

(options panel), 355

Video clips, 96

Applying effects to, 155

Changing name, 122

Changing playback speed, 171

Combining, 126

Editing, 109

Finding Album scene, 116

Interface features, 115

Properties tool, 123

Shortened by transition, 200

Splitting, 125

Synchronization with audio, 126

Trimming, 117

Trimming on the Timeline, 117

Trimming tips, 121

Undoing trim, 124

Using audio portion only, 111

Video compression, 366

Video effects, 155

2D editor, 175

Adding, 167

Adding and deleting, 157

Applied to theme clips, 147

Auto color correction, 169

Basic, 166

Black and white, 177

Blur, 173

Changing parameters, 158

Chroma key, 193

Cleaning effects, 168

Color correction, 177

Color map, 178

Copy and paste, 156

Dream glow, 169

Earthquake, 175

Emboss, 173

Icons, 116

Invert, 178

Keyframing, 160, 163

Lens flare, 176

Lighting, 179

Luma key, 175

Magnify, 176

Motion blur, 176

Noise reduction, 170

Old film, 173

Pan and zoom, 218

Picture-in-picture, 188

Posterize, 179

Presets, 159

Previewing and rendering, 166

RGB color balance, 179

Rotate, 170

Sepia, 180

Soften, 174

Speed, 171

Stabilize, 171

Stained glass, 174

Standard, 168

The effects list, 156

Tool, 155

Ultimate RTFX, 172

Unlocking, 157

Water drop, 177

Water wave, 177

Video formats, 112

Video levels

In analog import, 21

Video monitor

Simultaneous output to, 347

Video preview

External, 355

Full-screen, 355

Options, 355

Video scene catalog, 223

Video scenes

Adding to movie, 109, 110

Combining and subdividing, 75

Comments, 74

Displaying length of, 73

Finding in Album, 66

In-use indicator, 65, 115

Neighboring, 116

Order of, 63

Redetecting, 77

Selecting, 72

Splitting, 93

Thumbnail frames, 69

Viewing, 71

Video toolbox, 104

Video track, 97, 111, 126

And still images, 209

Linked to audio track, 128

Videography, 399

Videos

Section (of Album), 63

Videos section

Views, 74

Videos section (of Motion Titler

Album), 264

Videotape

Output to, 348

Views, Movie Window

Storyboard, 95

Text, 95, 102

Timeline, 95, 96

Voice-over tool, 305

Voice-overs, 96

Properties, 309

Recording, 305

Recording quality options, 307

Volume, 306

Voice-overs tool, 107

Volume

Adjusting on Timeline, 313

Fades, Default duration of, 353

Mixing, 310, 316

Voice-over levels, 306

Volume and balance tool, 107,

310, 316

W

Water drop (video effect), 177

Water wave (video effect), 177

WAV files, 84, 340

Web

Saving movie to, 349

White balance, 180

Windows Media

Files, 346

Player, 346

Windows Media Player

Viewing files with, 340

Wipe (transition), 202

Wizard

Import, 18

Y

Yahoo! Video, 349

YouTube, 349

Index 445

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals